Fourth National Plan
Fourth National Plan
Fourth National Plan
To maximize output:
Increase of public welfare is co-terminus with a higher level of economic development which, in turn,
results in increased production. In order to end economic exploitation, suitable changes in the system and
organization of both distribution and exchange should accompany increases in production. Since the dangers of
exploitation and undue economic pressure are great in a poverty stricken society like ours, our initial effort must
strike at the very root of poverty. Since low productivity is the root cause of poverty, in order to create a society free
from exploitation, it is first necessary to increase production to maximum extent.
This objective is essential, not only from the point of view of modernizing our economy on a sound basis,
but also from the point of view of inspiring public confidence in the development efforts by providing tangible
improvement in the work-a-day lives of the people.
Due to lack of necessary data, it is not possible to calculate the actual rate of growth of gross domestic
product during the Fourth Plan period. However, on the basis of the data that was available during the drafting of the
Fourth Plan, the proposed investment and projects to be completed during the Plan period are likely to generate an
increase in GDP of 4% per annum during the Plan period.
2.
To establish the base for sustained and long-term economic growth (viz. Transport, Communications,
Power etc.):
The building of infrastructure like transport, communications, and electricity warrants great attention in the
preliminary phases of development because it helps to accelerate development, as well as helps to equally distribute
produced goods. It is equally necessary to provide a base for the long-term development, as well as to provide
minimum increases in the living standard of the people. While selecting projects and programmes for investment in
the Fourth Plan, effort has been made to strike a balance between the two objectives: to increase per capita income
by immediate increases in production and to build the necessary base for long-term development.
3.
To secure accelerated pace of development with maximum economic stability by controlling price
Economic development and stability should be considered together in order to avoid any adverse effect of
development which might result in the economy. Hence economic stability along with economic development should
be regarded as an additional goal. During the Fourth plan period, it will be essential to maintain general economic
stability by control of the price level and improvement in the terms of international trade. Economic stability is not
limited to price stability. Rather, it would encompass all the economic policies adopted by the government in keeping
with the aims and objectives of the Plan. Frequent irregular changes in economic policies can adversely affect the
planned process of development. Hence, it is essential that economic stability is maintained for the steady growth of
the economy.
5.
While setting the goals of economic development, it has become necessary to consider the effective
utilization of available manpower resources and the control of population growth within desirable limits. Although
the rate of growth of population in Nepal appears to be low in comparison with the growth rate of in many other
countries, it is not a desirable rate in relation to available resources, especially cultivable land. The family planning
programme will help improve the situation and thereby uplift the standard of living of the people. By the use of
labour intensive techniques and indigenous resources as far as is economically practical, employment will increase
due to the multiplier effect. At the same time, the objective of maximum use of manpower resources will also be
fulfilled. More over, during the Plan period, increases in agricultural productivity and in private and public
investment in the industrial trade, and construction sectors will result in a considerably more effective utilization of
the labour force. In order to transfer surplus man-power on a large scale from agriculture to non-agricultural sector, it
requires diversification in the structure of the national economy. Obviously it will not be possible to achieve this
within the short period of five years.
6.
The Panchayat System has envisaged a social order which is free of undue economic exploitation of
individuals or class by any other individual or class. Truly speaking, the five year period of the Fourth Plan will be
too short to fulfill the long-term goals of the system. It is, however, important that the programmes of each
development plan are designed to push the country towards that ultimate goal. It was for the purpose of social justice
and economic progress that the land reform, Mulki Ain (code of civil and criminal laws) was adopted and that the
development programme in agriculture, industry, education, health, and roads were implemented on a county-wide
basis. In the Fourth Plan period these programmes will continue to expand in order to consolidate the base for the
establishment of a society free from exploitation.
Regarding policies to achieve the above mentioned national objectives, the following factors will definitely
get due consideration:
1.
It is imperative that the rates of investment are capital formation be increased to the maximum possible
extent in order to accelerate the pace of development and to create the required infrastructure. Obviously, availability
of investment capital is essential. Although foreign aid plays an important role in the Fourth Plan , increases in
development expenditure are dependent upon mobilization of internal resources. This is also essential in order to
decrease the countrys dependence upon foreign aid. Timely steps on the part of the Government would include
increases in taxation as well as austere measures regarding recurring expenditures. It has been observed that the
public sector and commercial organizations should also contribute to the mobilization of internal resources.
Another essential policy should be directed towards increasing the level of savings in the private sector.
Domestic savings from the private sector will have to be mobilized. The policy should be aimed at
encouraging the private sector to save more from its additional income, as well as making institutional reforms. In
addition, the channels of investing the mobilized savings must be made more attractive and effective.
In order to fulfill the aim of maximum increases in production, the investment rate must increase. There
should be simultaneous changes in the investment pattern and diversion of resources into more productive sectors. In
view of our present economic condition, emphasis must be placed on agriculture development so that maximum
increase in production can be accomplished even while utilizing limited investment funds. Improvement in existing
facilities, rather than establishment of new ones, is essential so that adequate assistance can be provided for
development in other field. The tendency to increase expenditure in the social sector on education and health should
not be encouraged. Greater emphasis will be made to re-enforce already existing facilities that to expand activities in
this field. In the industrial sector, attention has to be paid towards creating appropriate condition to attract private
sector investment. In order to give impetus to agro-based industries in accordance with the objectives set forth in the
Fourth Plan , the current policies will have to be reviewed and priorities (in industry) will have to be changed. In the
transport and communications sector, the determining criteria for additional facilities should be linked directly to the
needs of the various factorial programmes and to long-term development needs. Austerity has to be strictly followed
in different sector, including building construction. Attention must be paid to inter-linked projects making sure that
they are balanced since discrepancies in one sector may have adverse effects in another one. Due attention should
also be paid to regional and different geographic interlinkages and balance. If this pattern is followed, maximum
utilization of available resources can be ensured.
2.
The public sector has to play an active role in the economic development of countries in the preliminary
stages of economic development. Although the policy of creating basic infrastructure is intended to provide
incentives for investment in the private sector, if the provision of such facilities does not result in increase in the
quantity of productive investment the government will have to be active in directly establishing industrial projects.
While doing so, there might arise problems relating to management and operation in such industries. If the
management of public sector industrial enterprises is not satisfactory, the consumers will suffer unwarranted
difficulties.
Consequently, there will be a substantial rate of decrease in governmental income which may further discourage the
private sector.
Nepal does not lack private capital, although it does lack opportunities for productive investment. After
implementation of the land reform programme, capital in the hands of landlords has remained idle due to a lack of
investment opportunities in the economic sectors. There would be a considerable increase in the amount of private
investment from the landlords if the avenues to sound investment were opened up. It is, therefore, necessary to work
towards creating an environment favorable to industrial and business investment.
The following measures shall be taken during the Fourth Plan period for the purpose of augmenting private
sector investment:
(a) Nepal Industrial Development Corporation (NIDC) will be well organized and made more effective in
its functioning;
(b) Current industrial policies and priorities will be reviewed and the new priorities will be spelled out in
clear terms according to the objectives of the Fourth Plan in order to encourage industries by providing
incentives and necessary facilities;
(c) The need for various kinds of trained manpower for future industrial development will be assessed and
training programmes and facilities will accordingly be worked out;
(d) Existing financial institutions will be encouraged to advance loans to those landlords willing to sell
their lands to the tillers so that they may invest in selected industries;
(e) Incentives will be given to financial institutions to help expand and develop the industries already
established;
(f) The policies and programmes of cottage and small scale industries development thus far adopted shall
be evaluated. Future programmes encouraging this sector will be based upon a few selected industries
suitable to different regions. Assistance and facilities to be provided by the government will be decided
accordingly.
For the last few years government has involved itself directly or indirectly in commercial activities for two
obvious reasons:
(a) to regularly provide consumable goods of adequate quantity at fair prices to the consumers, and (2)
increase government revenue by earning a fair profit which can be invested on development works. Except for the
above two reasons, government interference and competition with the private sector is undesirable. Nor should the
government interfere in the private sector when it is operating within government regulations and in the social
interest. This will be the guiding consideration for the government before it takes any commercial steps during the
Fourth Plan period. In fact, the private and government sector are two integral parts of a single process, and
economic development is heavily dependent upon the progress and contributions of both.
4.
Trade policy:
According to the objectives of the Fourth Plan to expand and diversify foreign trade, production of
exportable goods will be stressed. Since processed goods fetch a higher price than unprocessed and raw goods, our
efforts should be directed towards the establishment of agro-based industries. Results of trade talks with India, due to
be concluded during 1970, and the subsequent trade treaty will be crucially important for the future expansion of
Nepalese foreign trade. It is, therefore, necessary to determine now the priorities, on the basis of which, the trade
relations with India should be discussed, as well as to review the economic relations of Nepal with India.
Appropriate revision in the current bonus system shall also be made in order to promote export trade. The foreign
exchange policy to be defined in this context will also indicate the most favourable level of foreign currency reserves
to maintain and the measures to better utilize our surplus reserves.
5.
Social justice:
In order to broaden the base of social justice and to lessen undue economic pressure during the Fourth Plan
period, genuine peasants will be given the opportunity to increase production by a more effective implementation of
land reform programme. Due consideration will also be given to the regulation of production costs and the quality of
produced goods in the interest of pubic welfare. To enable a majority of the people to contribute to national
production, small industries will be developed and extended in a well- organized way. Cooperatives will also be
strengthened on a viable economic basis. Timely changes will also be made in the tax and land revenue systems of
HMG in order to make them more just and equitable. According to the Panchayat Systems goal of enlisting greater
cooperation of the people in the economic development of the country, attempts will be made more effectively to
make involve Panchayats of various levels in the process of both plan formulation and implementation in order to
make the participation of people in the local development work more active and dynamic.
CHAPTER II
PLAN OUTLAY & ITS ALLOCATION
Although the above expenditure were incorporated into the development budget, they also include regular
expenditures. It is, therefore, necessary to ascertain the amount of actual development expenditure incurred during
the Plan period .In accordance with the newly adopted classification system (of regular and development
expenditure) followed by the Ministry of Finance on the advice of the National Planning Commission, the actual
development expenditure for the Third Plan period will be only Rs. 1,420 million. This estimate is based mainly
upon the analysis of the budget for the year 1968-69. The development expenditure under the traditional and new
classification is indicated in Table 2.
TABLE 1
PUBLIC SECTOR EXPENDITURE DURING THE THIRD PLAN
1965-66
Sectors
1. Transport,
Communication &
Power
2. Agriculture & Rural
Development
3. Industry
4. Social Services
5. Miscellaneous
6. Unallocable
Total
1966-67
1967-68
1968-69
(Rs. in Thousand)
1969-70
Total
Plan
Target
Est.
Actual
Est.
Actual
Est.
Actual
Est.
Revis.
Est.
Est.
Actual
875000
130678
117027
15285
1
116839
147371
128056
173036
186879
324504
928040
873305
377500
125000
63883
21326
56966
21726
74362
17507
98561
20333
70665
13628
101144
16493
67061
13149
128658
20579
497028
97490
397739
86589
292500
70000
-
50058
37809
100
44910
22325
100
43730
19866
500
50237
11584
1100
38396
17719
1100
56152
58150
53400
44872
49019
500
67119
59276
7500
279186
236666
62600
239027
168205
14200
174000
0
308854
263054
272804
349186
269564
458375
365980
607663
2101010
1779065
10475
5
18759
50629
49487
500
37693
2
Fiscal year
1965-66
1966-67
1967-68
1968-69
1969-70
Total
TABLE 2
DEVELOPMENT EXPENDITURE UNDER THIRD PLAN
(Rs. In million )
Under traditional
Under new
Classification
classification
263
230
273
217
270
225
366
300
608
450
1,780
1,424
The above table reveals that during the Third Plan period development expenditure in the public sector,
under the new classification, is Rs. 360 million less than development expenditure under the prevailing system.
When the increase in national output is compared to the expenditure, it becomes necessary to determine the volume
of the actual capital investment out of such increase. Since the recurring expenditures shall be included in
development outlays under the new classification, it is clear that the volume of capital investment shall be reduced by
less than 1,420 million.
The estimation of expenditure during the Fourth Plan period is based on the new classification of the
development expenditure. Accordingly, provisions for preparing the development and regular budgets (according to
the new classification) shall be made. The details of this are shown in Annex 2.
Priority of the Fourth Plan:
In conformity with the objectives and policies of the Fourth Plan, priority has been given to the continuing
projects, which were started during the Third Plan period or to those projects related to foreign aid. With the
objectives of producing more within a short period of time and the creation of the infrastructure for accelerating the
process of economic development in the future, priority has been given to the development of basic sectors like
transport and communications during the Fourth Plan period. The lack of transport and communications has become
the main deterrent to accelerating the process of economic development. No large scale development in the
agricultural and industrial sectors is possible without adequate communications facilities. Therefore, as some new
projects essential for regional development have to be planned along with the uncompleted projects started during
the Third Plan period, the greater portion of expenditure in the public sector has been envisaged for the development
of transport and communications facilities.
More than 93 per cent of the manpower in Nepal is engaged in agriculture. Agricultural development is,
therefore, very important and the improvement of the standard of living of the majority of the people is possible only
by increasing agricultural production. Increased food production is essential for accelerating the speed of
development and to eliminate the deterrents to development. Agricultural products also provide the raw materials
required for various industries. In view of these factors the agricultural development programme has occupied an
important place in the Plan.
In order of priority, industry is third after transport and agriculture. Although the main responsibility for
developing industries falls upon private sector, His Majestys Government may involve itself when the private sector
is unable to develop certain basic industries. During the Fourth Plan period, firm reform measures will be undertaken
for the reinforcement of industries that have already been established in the public sector.
Although it is desirable to expand such services as education, health etc., the improvement and strengthening
of existing facilities, rather than expansion of them, has been considered more appropriate during the Plan period
because of increasing expenditures in this sector.
With regard to the above mentioned priorities and the fulfillment of the objectives and programs of the
various sectors, the total expenditure planned is Rs. 3,540 million. The estimated breakdown by sectors is as follows:
Rs. 2,550 million in public sector,
Rs. 120 million in panchayat sector and
Rs. 870 million in private sector.
Out of the Rs. 3,540 million, 2,930 million shall be in the form of capital investment. This could be further
divided according to sectors, as Rs. 2,250 million in the public sector; 120 million in the panchayat sector and Rs.
650 million in the private sector.
TABLE 3
BREAKDOWN OF EXPENDITURE IN THE FOURTH PLAN
(Rs. In million)
Public Sector
Sectors
1. Transport &
Communications
2. Agriculture, Land
Reform,
Irrigation, Forest
& Botany
3. Industry,
Commerce, Power
& Mining
4. Panchayat,
Education, Health
& Social Services
5. Statistics
Total
Panchayat Sector
Private Sector
Total
Amount
Per cent
Amount
Per cent
Amount
Per cent
Amount
Per cent
1050.0
41.0
52.0
43.3
150.0
17.3
1252.0
35.4
662.8
26.0
39.0
32.5
470.0
54.0
1171.8
33.0
470.0
18.5
250.0
28.7
720.0
20.3
352.5
14.7
2,550.0
13.8
0.6
100.0
29.0
120.0
24.2
100.0
870.0
100.0
381.5
14.7
3,540.0
10.8
0.4
100.0
21.9 million in FY 1966-67 and Rs. 30.3 million in 1967-68. Local resources alone amounted to Rs. 17.0 million in
1966-67 and Rs. 26.2 million in 1967-68. If the resources utilized by the village panchayats in the local development
projects implemented by local resources alone is considered, the actual amounts seem to be higher.
In order to make the panchayat sector better organized, effective and dynamic, provisions have been made to
increase the current amount of central development grants and to provide these grants in definite proportion to
particular local projects. Intending to utilize more local resources as a result of such provision, the capital investment
in the panchayat sector during the Plan period is estimated to be Rs. 100 million. This amount will be utilized mainly
for the construction of minor irrigation, light transport, drinking water, drainage, school, library and other facilities.
During the Plan period, His Majestys
Government will provide development grants of Rs. 20 million to the village panchayats through district panchayats.
Expenditure in Private Sector:
Estimated expenditure in the private sector is Rs. 870 million of which capital investment will be Rs. 650
million. The Agricultural Development Bank and the Compulsory Savings Corporation shall make available Rs. 475
million as agricultural loans in the private sector. This estimate of the volume of loans is based on the loans issued
during the past years and on the cost of agricultural implements required for achieving the targets for agricultural
development in the Fourth Plan. Out of the funds available from these corporations, Rs. 280 million shall be spent on
seeds, fertilizers, insecticides and other recurring expenditures. Therefore, funds amounting to only Rs.250 million
have been allocated for actual capital investment. No estimate has been made regarding the development expenditure
to be met by the private sector from its own resources, although it will obviously exceed the amount state above.
It is estimated that Rs. 250 million will be invested by the private sector in industry. Nepal Industrial
Development Corporation shall make available Rs. 120 million to lend to the private sector. It is assumed that
private sector will not only be encouraged but also be able to mobilize and invest its own capital, thereby reaching
the figure envisaged for total private sector investment. In view of investment made and experience gained in
preceeding years, it is also estimated that private sector investment in transport facilities during the Plan period will
amount to Rs. 150 million.
TABLE 4
18,69,00
2
4,61,00
9,01,00
8,08,00
25,89,00
10,85,00
2,27,00
50,00
7,45,00
22,53,00
2,40,00
1,00,00
4,10,84
11,97,52
15,12,36
3,72,60
1,28,00
25,97
77,71
66,28,00
47,00,00
37,25,00
5. Statistics
1,47,00
Grand Total
2,57,00,00
1) Share Capital.
2) Includes Rs.10 million needed to increase the share capital of Agricultural Development Bank.
3) Includes Rs.10 million needed to increase the share capital of NIDC.
4) Includes development grant of Rs. 20 million to the panchayat sector.
CHAPTER III
FINANCIAL
RESOURCES
It has already been stated that out of the total financial resources of Rs. 3540 million required for achieving
the goals of the Fourth Plan, His Majestys Government must provide Rs. 2570 million: i.e. Rs. 2550 million for the
development of the public sector and Rs. 20 million for the development of the panchayat sector. Based on potential
available resources and the efforts for providing additional resources to meet the minimum requirements of
development, the outline of the Plan has been prepared and the goals have been determined accordingly. Therefore,
assuming that the government policy of mobilizing resources may change and in fact, recognizing the necessity of
changing and improving that policy, the resources which can and should be made available have been provided in the
Fourth Plan. In the foregoing chapter, the available resources for achieving the specified goals in both the private and
panchayat sectors have been analyzed, and it has been shown that the required resources will be available.
Public Sector
In the process of economic development it is necessary to think of the maintenance of a fiscal balance between
resources and investment as an objective of planning. But, giving due consideration to the minimum requirements, if
the available savings for investment is insufficient to accelerate development activities, the possible impact of such
an imbalance on the physical system should also be considered. But due to a lack of data on the national income and
balance of payments, it is natural that the necessary information of savings and investments is also not available.
Therefore, with the view of maintaining of financial balance in the fiscal system on the basis of available data, the
estimate of financial resources potentially available for the public sector has been made for the Fourth Plan period.
Estimation of resources which may be available in the public sector during the Fourth Plan period has been
based on the following factors: changes in the government revenue and regular expenditure during preceding years;
the possible changes in the future; assumptions concerning the proper utilization of foreign exchange; projected
national and foreign credit; and the level of deficit financing which can be tolerated without adversely effecting the
fiscal system by increasing the politically practical tax burden. I accordance with the long-term objective of
accelerating development activities and gradually reducing the dependence upon foreign aid, efforts are being made
to reduced the foreign aid ratio in the Fourth Plan. Following are the summary of the resources:
Sources
INTERNAL
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
TABLE 5
RESOURCES FOR FOURTH PLAN
Rs. In million
1080
330
Revenue Surplus
Additional Revenue from the
tax changed
Domestic Credit
Deficit Financing
Deficit
Percentage
42.0
12.8
300
150
200
100
14090
1290
200
11.7
5.8
7.8
3.9
58.0
50.2
7.8
2570
100.0
EXTERNAL
f. Aid
g. Loan
Total
a. Revenue surplus: The estimated revenue of Rs. 430 million for the FY 1969-70 shows an annual increase of 5 per
cent in revenue during the Fourth Plan period. On the assumption of an annual increase of 10 per cent in regular
expenditures, a revenue surplus of Rs. 330 million will become available for the Fourth Plan.
During the seven years between FY 1963-64 to FY 1969-70 total revenue increased at the rate of 19 per
cent per annum. Such a significant increase was made possible primarily because of periodic increases in various
taxes and not because of improved tax administration. The development of the general fiscal system has also helped
increase revenue. As such, while estimating the rate of increase in future revenue separate analysis should be made of
the development of the fiscal system and of the increases in the rate of taxation in order to determine their relative
importance in the overall increase in revenue.
During the above mentioned seven years, the impact of development itself is responsible for no more than
an annual 8 per cent increase in revenue. In fact, the increase in prices during that period seems to be a contributing
factor to the increased revenue. Assuming fixed prices, it seems that general development has contributed to the
increased revenue by 4 per cent annually. Therefore, considering the estimated revenue of Rs. 430 million in FY
1969-70, the increase in revenue during the Fourth Plan period will be 5 per cent per annum, assuming fixed prices.
When viewed from the experience of past years, such an increase seems optimistic. There are several factors which
might reduce the increase of revenue to less than 5 per cent. While difficult to quantify, some of these factors are: (1)
while considering the price index for agricultural production in India, the export sector cannot made its complete
contribution to the nation al income of Nepal, and thereby creates possible difficulties in increasing revenue from
other sectors. (2) In the same way, increases in revenue are adversely affected by regulations concerning the gift
parcel system. However, the favorable impact of economic development on revenue resulting from the proposed
increases in investment during the Fourth Plan period should also be considered.
At the recommendation of the National Planning Commission, the Finance Ministry will adopt a new
classification of regular and development expenditures. According to the new classification system, some of the
amounts under the development budget heads will come under regular budget heads. The difference between the
current system and the new classification system may be shown on the basis of FY 1968-69.
TABLE 6
FY 1968-69 BUDGET ACCORDING TO NEW CLASSIFICATION
(Rs. In million)
Item
Current Classification
New Classification
209.0
314.0
201.9
269.5
Regular Budget
7.1
44.5
a. Recurring Expenditure
458.4
353.4
b. Loan Payment
67.6
37.4
353.4
353.4
Development Budget
a.
b.
c.
Recurring Expenditure
Loan Payment
Development
Expenditure
667.4
667.4
Total
According to the prevailing prices, regular expenditures seem to have increased by 12-13 per cent per annum
during the seven year period from FY 1963-64 to FY 1969-70. But according to the fixed prices of FY 1963-64, the
increase has been only 10 per cent. According to the fixed prices of FY 1969-70, it is estimated that regular
expenditures shall increase by 10 per cent during the Fourth Plan period. To achieve this, emphasis should be given
to administrative efficiency and frugality. Generally, salaries and allowances constitute the largest share of regular
expenditure. Based on the statements given above, total revenue shall be Rs. 2,490 million and total regular
expenditure shall be 2,160 million during the Fourth Plan period. Accordingly, a surplus revenue of Rs. 330 million
shall be available for the Fourth Plan.
b. Additional revenue from the tax changed: Increase in revenue, due to changes in the rate of the prevailing
taxes, may be more difficult to achieve during the Fourth Plan. Because of increases in custom duties, income tax
and sales tax during recent years, the opportunity for increasing revenue by changing the rate of taxation seems very
limited. If the minimum resources required for development were not made available through internal resources (by
changing existing rates of taxation and by making tax administration more efficient), it is clear that the pace of
development would be affected adversely and Nepals dependency upon foreign aid would increase. From economic
and technical points of view, agriculture may make a great contribution to increase revenue. However, the current
land tax system should be changed scientifically in order to make it just. The working efficiency of governmentowned industrial, financial and business institutions should be improved and operated more frugally, thereby
contributing to increases in revenue. Therefore, along with the changes in the prevailing rate of taxation and
improvements in tax administration, the earnings, from better operated government-owned corporations, will be Rs.
300 million , which will also be available for the Fourth Plan .
c. Domestic credit: When compared to the Rs. 59 million collected during the Third Plan period, Rs. 150 million
should be collected during the Fourth Plan period. Considering the present situation of financial institutions in the
public sector (like commercial banks, insurance corporation, provident fund etc.), it seems possible to collect Rs. 150
million or more from the domestic loan. It is not the collection of the loan, but the extent to which government can
bear the burden of future credit and the expenditure required to provide resources from other sources in comparison
to domestic credit which are the factors determining the quantity of domestic credit. The study of savings which can
be invested at present reveals that the terms and interest of the prevailing loans have made domestic credit relatively
more expensive from the government viewpoint. Consideration should be given to provide resources from deficit
financing instead of domestic credit. Although the possibility of providing development funds from deficit financing
is limited, such provision, within certain limits, can reduce government liabilities to a great extent.
d. Deficit financing: In order to mobilize resources for development of the public sector during the Fourth Plan , Rs.
200 million of deficit financing is projected. It will cause no imbalance in the financial system, and will therefore,
create no adverse effect. Assuming a general balance of the resources required and available in the private sector, the
situation of the fiscal system shall have been determined from the resources and this will be available in the public
sector. In fact, the study on savings in commercial banks and other government institutions reveal that more
resources have become available in the private sector. So, if the expenses in the public sector were to be met through
revenue and domestic loan, one should agree that financial balance has existed likewise and one should agree on the
balancing nature of the investment through foreign aid available in the form of goods or in services. Now,
considering the optimum relation that should exist between savings and investment, the extent of investment by
deficit financing has to be determined. The result of the investment by deficit financing, the adverse impact on the
price and the balance of payment of the country has generally determined the limit of deficit financing. Deficit
financing is one of the numerous causes of inflation. As the proposed deficit financing will reduce the reserve of
convertible foreign exchange and will be spent at the same ratio for importing physical resources for development,
there is no possibility that adverse effect on the internal price situation will be caused.
One of the main causes of monetary inflation during the past years has been the continuous increase in
foreign exchange expected to be earned during the past years, the Fourth Plan period, the current savings, the
quantity of the resources available from domestic sources, the minimum saving of foreign exchange required to
increase foreign trade, the quantity of convertible foreign exchange in relation to the money supply, and the quantity
of foreign exchange required for the development works in the public sectors during the Fourth Plan, the proposed
deficit of Rs. 200 million is necessary to accelerate development activities.
e. Deficit: The resources available from domestic sources for operating various development projects show a deficit
of Rs. 100 million. This deficit shall be met by the saving of foreign exchange, if possible. The estimates of
resources reveal that the present savings of foreign currency is more than future requirements. However, the above
savings can be spent only when foreign currency is in deficit. Otherwise, the required amount will have to be
collected by the mobilization of domestic resources.
f. foreign aid: During the Third Plan period, foreign aid amounted to Rs. 950 million including both loans and
grants. The following table shows the actual amount received during the first three years of the Third Plan, the
revised amount during the fourth year, and the estimated amount of the fifth year. The estimate of foreign aid during
FY 1969-70 is considerably higher than in FY 1968-69. However, the actual amount seems not to have increased
more than Rs. 270 million.
TABLE 7
FOREIGN AID DURING THIRD PLAN
Foreign Aid
Type
Actual
1965-66
Grant
Loan
Total
175.3
3.3
178.6
Actual
196667
142.2
3.7
145.9
Actual
196768
158.1
158.1
Revised
196869
214.2
214.2
(Rs. In million)
Estimated
1969-70
Total
329.2
12.5
341.7
1019.0
19.5
1038.5
It is difficult to estimate beforehand the amount of expected foreign aid for the Fourth Plan . However,
considering the experiences gained during the Third Plan period, the type of projects to be operated during the
Fourth Plan period, and the quantity of domestic resources available for local expenses, estimated foreign aid for the
Fourth Plan is expected to total Rs. 1,490 million; Rs. 1,290 million in the form of grants and Rs. 200 million as
loans.
The following table shows the amount to be provided by HG for regular and development expenditures and
the sources of each during the Fourth Plan period. The table gives a clear picture of the complete financial situation
of the public sector and the relation between expenditure and resources during the Fourth Plan period.
TABLE 8
PUBLIC SECTOR EXPENDITURE AND SOURCES OF
RESOURCES DURING FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
Item
Expenditure
a. Regular
b. Development
Total
Rupees in million
2160
2570
4730
Percentage
45.7
54.3
100.0
Sources:
Internal
a. Revenue
b. Domestic Loan
c. Deficit Financing
d. Deficit
3240
2790
150
200
100
1490
1290
200
68.5
59.0
3.2
4.2
2.1
31.5
27.3
4.2
4730
100.0
External
a.
b.
Grant
Loan
Total
CHAPTER IV
POPULATION AND MANPOWER
The Growth in Population
The first census of the Kingdom of Nepal was taken in the year 1911. Although an increase of only
3,841,650 persons or 68.12 per cent has been observed during the period between 1911 and 1961, this small increase
might well be the result of the various natural calamities, the two world wars and the political upheaval in the
country. The average annual rate of growth during the period between 1954 and 1961 has been found to be 1.6 per
cent. However, the statistics of births and deaths made available from the census of 1961 shows a growth rate of 2.0
per cent annum. Though data on births and deaths (during a year preceding the census) were collected during the
census of 1961, neither set of figures is reliable. The data on deaths seem particularly less reliable than on births. The
total population recorded in the various censuses is shown in the table below:
TABLE 9
TOTAL POPULATION FROM DIFFERENT CENSUSES
Years
1911
1920
1930
1941
1952/54
1961
Total Population
5,638,749
5,573,788
5,532,574
6,283,649
8,473,478
9,412,996
Estimated Population
In the absence of the necessary reliable statistics of births and deaths, it is not easy to make population
projections. It is possible to formulate informative and reliable estimates of national population trends only when
reliable statistics of births and deaths and knowledge of the possible results of existing programmes effecting births
and deaths are available. Due to a partial lack of the necessary information, it is natural to encounter difficulty in
making a scientific study analyzing the population. However, estimates of the future population for the period
between 1961 to 1981 have been prepared on the basis of the available statistics and assuming that the sex-age
adjusted birth rate of 40 per thousand will remain constant throughout the period of projection and that due to a
decline in the death rate there will be an annual increase of 0.5 year in life expectancy. The expectation of life was
estimated by comparing the age-specific death rates obtained from the census of 1961 and the population survey of
1963 to the age-specific death rates given in the United Nations Model Life-Tables. The estimated population thus
obtained is given in Table 10.
TABLE 10
ESTIMATED POPULATION PROJECTION FOR NEPAL
1961-1981*
Years
Age group
All Ages
0-4
5-9
10-14
1961
1966
1971
1976
1981
9412996
1487784
1264094
1059931
10276533
1561932
1354102
1228122
11247616
1668313
1437517
1320190
12392794
1847095
1550438
1405755
13777262
2097462
1731917
1520365
15-19
20-24
25-29
30-34
35-39
40-44
45-49
50-54
55-59
60-64
65-69
70-74
75-79
80-84
85-over
857303
791467
772523
668445
580789
472744
394943
327437
257449
196969
132222
88407
42838
14440
3211
1029778
822975
753025
731882
630163
543289
436637
357586
287806
216239
154113
92492
52099
19581
4622
1197046
992689
787141
717778
693829
594216
506293
399430
318130
245210
127121
110193
56066
24726
6678
1290299
1158273
954042
754440
685495
658729
558227
467257
359153
274618
198252
125511
68574
27564
9072
1377507
1252946
1117967
918850
724374
654675
622938
519471
424042
313532
228254
147177
79955
34811
11019
Period
1961-1966
1966-1971
1971-1976
1976-1981
*
A difference has been observed between the rates of population growth shown in the above Table and those
given in the population and Manpower Chapter in the Third Plan. This difference is due to the different methods
employed in estimating future population. In the population chapter of the Third Plan, a very simple growth pattern
for each quinquennium was assumed and then from the estimated total population, age composition figure (i.e. 0-14
years; 15-59 years and 60 years and over) were estimated. The present estimate, obtained by the Cohort Survival
Method after a detailed analytical study of the available data on births and deaths, is definitely more reliable.
Age
All Ages
0-14
15-59
60 and over
TABLE 11
PERCENTAGE DISTRIBUTION OF THE POPULATION BY AGE GROUP
1961
1966
1971
1976
1981
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
40.5
40.3
39.4
38.8
38.7
54.4
54.4
55.1
55.5
55.4
5.1
5.3
5.5
5.7
5.9
It is obvious from the above Table that as a result of an almost constant birth rate and a steadily declining
death rate, the emergent quasi-stable population explicitly needs to reduce its birth rate in order to increase the
percentage of the population in the working age group and hence reduce the percentage of the population dependent
upon others for their livelihood. But as has been stated above, any reduction in the birth rate require special efforts
and a longer time. In spite of a Herculean effort, the birth rate tends toward neither its possible minimum nor its
possible maximum. The birth rate of any country and of any time period is an expression of the culture of that
particular population, tending towards a level which represents a balance of conditions that affect it both in a positive
and negative sense.
Thus, to bring a substantial change in the birth rate, the initial requisites are to bring required changes in
the economic and social conditions, cultural patterns and aspirations towards life of the common man. The second
need is to create an institution such as the family planning programme, which can sufficiently consolidate the
successes brought through the above mentioned changes.
Population density increases with the growth of population. Specifically, the density of population in
Nepal is 173.2 persons per square mile. With regard to the physical geography, the amount of habitable land and the
amount of land under cultivation in Nepal, the density of population seems to be quite high. The estimated density of
population in various years is shown in the Table below:
TABLE 12
POPULATION DENSITY PER SQUARE MILE 1961-1981
Year
Population Density
(per Square mile)
1961
173.2
1966
189.1
1971
207.0
1976
228.0
1981
253.5
From the above Table, the population density of Nepal in the year 1961 was 173.2 persons per square mile
and it is estimated that it will reach 253.5 persons per square mile in the year 1981. The estimated population density
of the various regions is given in the Table below:
TABLE 13
POPULATION DENSITY PER SQUARE MILE BY REGIONS 1961-1981
Region
1961
1966
1971
1976
1981
Nepal
Eastern Hills
Eastern Inner Terai
Eastern Terai
Kathmandu Valley
Western Hills
Far Western Hills
Central Inner Terai
Western Terai
Western Inner Terai
Far Western Terai
173.2
186.5
105.9
432.3
110.0
152.9
99.6
169.0
306.3
138.1
95.5
189.1
203.2
118.0
472.1
2309.9
166.5
108.5
184.9
330.2
158.3
104.8
207.0
222.4
129.1
516.8
2528.1
182.9
118.8
202.4
361.4
173.3
114.7
228.0
245.1
142.3
569.4
2785.5
201.5
131.8
223.0
398.2
191.9
126.4
253.5
262.4
158.3
622.1
3096.7
224.0
145.4
247.9
442.7
212.3
141.5
From the above Table, the population densities of the Inner Terai region and the Western Terai region are
found to be less in comparison with other regions. The density of population of Kathmandu Valley is very high
comparison with other regions. The capital of the country and the two main cities viz. Lalitpur and Bhaktapur are
situated in this region, and it is natural that the density of population of this region would be higher than that of the
other regions. At the same time, it is obvious that it will be more and more difficult to arrange necessary social and
economical infrastructure (such as education, health, housing, culture and recreation) because of the increase in
population. It seems desirable to launch a programme resettling some people from the highly densely populated
region to the less densely populated regions, especially to the Far Western and Inner Terai regions.
As has been stated above, facilities like education, health, housing, etc. and employment opportunities in
various economically developed fields would be more difficult to provide with a high rate of growth in population. In
comparison with the population of 1961, 2.5 million more people would be added to the 15-59 age group by 1981.
According to the prevailing economic conditions, there would be a substantial pressure of population on the land. To
decrease this pressure, new lands should be opened for cultivation, and job opportunities should be created in the
non-agricultural sector. Even if the present standard of consumption were to be maintained, there would have to be a
substantial growth in production.
If the estimated growth of population were to take place as mentioned above, it would be more and more
difficult to fulfill the increasing needs in the field of education. In comparison with the year 1961, the number of
children of school-age 6-11 years in the primary level would increase by 41,119 and the number of children of
school-age in the middle level would increase by 25 per cent more and the more number in higher education would
increase by 39 per cent in 1981.
As shown by the census, in the year 1961, 48.5 per cent of the total population and 80. 45 per cent of the
working age group 15-59 are the only ones who are economically active. In the new future, a substantial growth in
the economically active population should not be expected. There should be ample opportunities for work in various
new fields which should provide for a substantial growth of the labour force. The development of industries and
occupations giving opportunities to housewives and students would allow them to become economically active, and
therefore encourage the growth of the economically active population. Another interesting fact revealed by the
population census of 1961 was the level of employment in agriculture. Out of the total economically active
population of 4,306,839, 4,040,607 are engaged in agricultural work. The census also showed that 30,365 are
employing others, 3,193,207 are working for themselves, and 263,934 are working as unpaid family workers. Thus it
is clearly shown that, although agriculture is the major occupation, it has not developed into a commercial industry
and has instead retained its subsistence nature.
On the basis of the above analysis, the influences of various population groups expected
during the Fourth Plan can be studied. The age group distribution of the population during the
Fourth Plan is shown in the Table below:
TABLE 14
DISTRIBUTIN OF THE POPULATION BY AGE GROUP
Age Groups
1970
Number
0-4
5-14
1,650,520
14.94
1,809,992
14.89
2,724,351
24.66
2,921,028
24.03
15-19
1,071,790
54.66
6,736,720
55.42
606,00,992
5.44
688,016
5.66
Total
11,047,653
100.00
12,155.756
100.00
Percentag
e
1975 Number
Percentage
During the next five years, there should be an increase of 664,930 individuals in the labour force (the 15-59
age group). It will be essential to create jobs for about 525,000 persons within this economically active group during
the Fourth Plan period. If not, the rate of employment will be even lower than during the Third Plan. In this estimate,
the number of individuals who are under 15 and 59 years have not been included although they might actually be
employed. In order to increase productivity in the labour force, this practices will be discouraged. Gradually the
work done by people outside of the 15-59 age group will be taken over by the new labourers. If this were not done,
the numbers of persons looking for jobs would continue to increase and would be higher than the above mentioned
number.
Also, if an ambitious plan could be formulated to activate the 1.14 million unemployed persons by the end of
the Third Plan period, the number of persons depending on others for their subsistence would decrease and the
standard of living of general people would actually increase.
Industrial classification of the labour force shows the degree of dependency of the
population upon different industries, as well as being a main measuring device to determine how
much the country has developed. According to the national census taken in the year 1961, the
economically active population was about 4.6 million, of which 93.83 per cent were dependent
upon agriculture. Only 6.17 per cent were employed in other sectors of the economy. No reliable
statistics have yet been collected which can indicate the extent of change brought to the
employment structure by economic development during the past nine years. As a result, the
percentage of people who have shifted from agriculture to other industries is not known.
Although reliable statistics on this question should be available from the national census to be
held in 1971, there is little reason to believe that there has been any remarkable change in the
industrial distribution of the labour force. This is because of the underdeveloped nature of the
country and the fact that the rate of economic development has been minimal. Although it is
likely that increased investment during the Fourth Plan period will result in effective utilization
of the agricultural labour force, there is little likelihood that the desired change in the industrial
structure of the non-agricultural sector will occur.
Technical Manpower:
At the base year of the Fourth Plan (1969-70), the number of highly trained persons (graduates) in the
technical and scientific fields such as engineering, health, education and commerce is estimated to be 2,897. The
number of graduates in both technical and non-technical fields is estimated to be 7,648. Also, even those who
complete their studies during the Plan period should be considered. Their number is expected to reach 2,364 by the
fourth year of the Fourth Plan. The breakdown of the estimate is given in the following Table.
TABLE 15
ESTIMATE ON HIGH LEVEL TECHNICAL MANPOWER
Subject
Number expected
In 1969-70
Engineering
Electrical Engineering
Civil Engineering
Mechanical Engineering
Other Engineering
Health
Education
Commerce
Agriculture
Forest
Veterinary
General Science
Art Subjects
456
81
260
57
67
326
240
730
265
99
45
727
4,751
7,648
To be added during
1969-70 to 1973-74
306
30
141
51
84
134
68
264
240
20
20
288
1,024
2,364
Total
771
111
401
108
151
460
308
994
505
119
65
1,015
5,775
10,012
Total
During the last Plan period, several technical and vocational training centers were opened in order to
provide middle and lower level technical facilities within the country. The total number of middle and lower level
technical persons during this period is estimated to be 5,094. This includes the number of persons already trained by
these institutions and the number of persons to complete training in the year 1969-70, assuming that the number of
persons of trainees remains at the same level as in the past. Since training such manpower requires a maximum of
three years, training facilities will be made available during the Fourth Plan period according to the number required.
The number of trained persons as of
1969-70 can be classified into the following groups:
TABLE 16
MIDDLE AND LOWER LEVEL MANPOWER AS OF 1969-1970
Subject
Civil Engineering (Overseers)
Mechanical Engineering
Electrical Engineering
Chemical and Related Technologies
Wood Working Technology
Weaving, Garments, Foot-wear and
Textile Technology
Agriculture
Forestry
Health
Home Science
Middle-Level
432
-
Lower-Level
372
150
216
419
231
98
-
739
1,637
360
286
154
761
4,333
Total
Some 1,000 Nepalese have received miscellaneous vocational and technical training during their service
with the British-Gurkha Army which will also help to fulfill the need for technically trained manpower.
The above description does not give us a very positive picture of the ratio between the higher level and the
middle and the lower level technically trained persons available in the country. The number of lower and middle
level trained persons is not adequate to help the higher level personnel function most effectively. This shows the
need to put greater emphasis on the training of middle and lower level manpower. In the training centers of the
country, duplication in training subjects, oversupply in certain trades, and scarcity in some others have also been
evident. Thus, during the Fourth Plan period, efforts must be made to coordinate the training of personnel with the
requirements for skilled manpower.
In the health sector, the number of specialized doctors and well trained nurses falls short of those required.
However, the number of indigenous health workers (i.e. Kabiraj, Vaidyas, etc.) could be fully mobilized, thereby
increasing the number of facilities in the health services. The number of such indigenous health workers in the
country is estimated to be around 200 at the present time.
In the absence of some basic information, it was not possible to estimate scientifically the required technical
manpower for the Fourth Plan period. Since higher level personnel require six to seven years of training, only those
undergoing training at present will be available during the Fourth Plan period. If the higher level manpower available
were to be used as a base, the number of middle and lower level persons required during the Plan period would be as
follows:
Subject
Table 17
ESTIMATED MANPOWER REQUIREMENT DURING THE
FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
Available
Middle
Level
Manpower
Higher Level
Manpower
Engineering:
Civil
Mechanical
Electrical
Others
Health
Education
Commerce
Agriculture
Forest
Veterinary
771
401
108
111
151
460
308
994
505
119
65
Required
231
3
120
3
324
333
453
920
800
288
130
Available
107
635
9
324
120
322
288
-
Skilled
(Lower
Level)
Manpower
Deficient
1234
34695
598
-
1840
3200
380
260
568
213
453
Training
The first important goal to keep in mind when considering training during the Plan period is the elimination of
duplication in training facilities. Expansion of such facilities should arise only in subjects which have been found to
be absolutely essential. Experience in preceding years has shown that, when training was given in vocations with
little demand, the trained persons remained unemployed and consequently caused a loss to the national wealth. Such
wastage should be eliminated as soon as possible.
To date higher level technical personnel have been trained outside the country under
foreign assistance. In view of long- term requirements, such training facilities should be made
available within the country. A medical college and an engineering college will be established
during the Fourth Plan period. Graduates from these institutions can be utilized during the Fifth
Plan period. In important vocations, facilities for the training of middle and lower level technical
manpower will be expanded whenever necessary. However, the opening of new institutions will
not be encouraged until a thorough study has been made regarding the types of manpower
required and the means to fulfill these demands. Since on-the-job training of skilled workers and
upgrading training programmes are more effective, such programmes will be implemented
wherever necessary.
Employment
The employment of the labour force is a vital factor in a developmental plan. The main objective of economic
planning should include the provision of employment opportunities to those looking for employment. According to
the latest estimate, the number of persons of working age, i.e. between 15-59 years, is 6,072,000. In the absence of
any employment survey, it is difficult to ascertain the total unemployed population in the country. Since Nepal is
basically an agricultural economy, it is natural that under-employment is visible everywhere as it is in other
predominantly agricultural economies. Distinguished unemployment is also visible in several areas. In the field of
trained manpower, those who have received technical training have been able to find employment. However, surveys
and studies have indicated that persons having non-technical or arts education are finding it increasingly difficult to
find suitable employment. Among the educated, the number of persons looking for non-technical jobs has increased
tremendously.
More suitable jobs will be required during the Fourth Plan period for the additional population that will join
the labour force. Since most of the population is dependent upon agriculture for its livelihood, there is much underemployment in the country.
If sufficient employment opportunities cannot be created for the increased labour force in the nonagricultural sectors, the unemployment problem might take an unpleasant trend. In view of constant progress in the
field of education, the number of educated persons is expected to increase greatly. In view of this, it is essential that
arrangements be made to provide the educated manpower with ample job opportunities. Keeping these facts in mind,
all possible attempts will be made to create and expand employment opportunities in all economic sectors in hopes of
solving the problem of unemployment and under-employment during the Fourth Plan period.
CHAPTER V
AGRICULTURE
In the existing condition of the economy agricultural sector should play an important role consistence with
the underlying objectives of the Fourth Plan to maximize output by concentrating available resources and creating
basic conditions necessary for acceleration of economic development in the country. With the existing structure of
our economy, it is true that this requires a heavy emphasis on agriculture. As a matter of fact, in an economy which is
still in the initial stage of development, economic progress depends to a large extent on the development of
agriculture has become even more essential in order to lay down a sound base for further expansion of the nonagricultural sector during the long-run process of development.
Although a number of development works have been undertaken in different sectors of the economy, there has
been virtually no noteworthy change in the basic condition of agriculture. According to an estimate for 1967/68,
agriculture accounts for 66 per cent of the Gross Domestic Product. It is estimated that more than 93 per cent of the
total labour force of the country is engaged in agriculture. Besides, agricultural products are the major items in the
export trade of the country. Of total exports, food grains alone constitute about 70 per cent. In spite of being
predominantly an agricultural country, the level of land productivity is low. In addition, increased population is
exerting heavy pressure on cultivated land, consequently giving rise to the critical problem of providing gainful
employment to the growing labour force in agriculture. Under these circumstances emphasis needs to be given to
transforming the tradition bound and largely monsoon based subsistence agriculture into a modern and commercial
enterprise.
It is necessary to recognize that the farmers play a predominant role in attaining the goals
of agricultural development. Although the over-all targets of the agricultural programme are
determined by the government, their fulfillment essentially depends on the contribution of all the
farmers and families who are engaged in agriculture. The availability of basic agricultural inputs
and services on the one hand and a just reward for their efforts on the other should be guaranteed
to the farmers only in this context can the agricultural development programmes undertaken by
the government be meaningful.
far behind the target and all cash crops (except oil-seeds production) are far short of the targets. Production targets of
different crops and progress made in the first four years of the Third Plan period are shown in the following Table:
TABLE 18
TARGET OF AGRICULTURAL PRODUCTION AND PROGRESS
Target of
the Third
Plan
Crops
1964/65
Food grains
Paddy
Maize
Wheat & Barley
Millet & Others
Cash Crops
Sugarcane
Oil-seeds
Tobacco
Others
1969/70
1965/66
1966/67
1967/68
1968/69
%
Increase
% of
Targets
3270
2201
854
152
63
3776
2368
918
425
65
3358
2007
856
175
120
3138
2007
824
187
120
3420
2217
875
216
112
3598
2322
900
256
120
10.03
5.45
5.39
68.42
84.62
64.8
72.5
71.9
38.0
-
126
51
9
38
252
60
24
54
192
51
8.8
39
147
56
5.2
38.4
167
56
5.4
39.4
188
57
6.3
N.A.
49.21
11.37
3.0
-
49.2
66.6
-
It is clear from the above Table that the basic target of the Third Plan to increase
production of food grains by 15 per cent will remain unfulfilled. This shortfall in production of
food grains and other crops is mainly due to the absence of adequately organizational effort and
necessary inputs. According to progress made during the last four years, the area and the use of
chemical fertilizer is about 17 per cent of the target of the Third Plan. Similarly, progress in the
field of irrigation is much below the target. Targets of various inputs inputs in the Third Plan and
progress made in the past four are shown in the Table below:
TABLE 19
TARGETS OF AGRICULTURAL INPUTS AND PROGRESS
Programmes
1.
Units
Hec.
Target
of the
rd
3
Plan
800,000
1965-66
1966-67
1967-68
1968-69
10754
6331
4326
25993
13493
11371
57303
26068
28027
102630
42552
53775
% of
target
13.0
2.
3.
4.
5.
Maize
Use of chemical fertilizers
(gross)
Irrigation
Reclaimed land
Resettled families
M.T.
221,000
97
3169
1209
6670
3208
16000
6303
24000
17.0
Hec
No.
148,000
13,900
6,000
6000
804
800
25000
2801
1378
12850
3873
1913
15240
9331
1936
39.9
35.5
32.5
Targets of the Third Plan in the field of livestock and horticulture development and progress made in the last
four years are shown in the Table below:
TABLE 20
DISTRIBUTIONAL TARGETS OF LIVESTOCK AND HORTICULTURE PRODUCTION & PROGRESS
Programmes
Pigs
Sheep
Poultry
Fish
Fruits
Vegetables
Distributional Target
12756 (improved breeds)
3,000 lambs
1,100,000 chicken
1,250,000 fingerlings
760,000 root-stock
29,100,000 seedlings
Progress from
1965-66 to 1968-69
1040
48
193,577
1,239,241
602,676
209,750
Percentage of
the target
8.15
1.6
17.59
99.14
79.26
0.72
Keeping in view the needs of agricultural development, several departments have been
established in different fields of agriculture in order to conduct adaptive research which is
suitable in different climate conditions of the country, on improved seeds of various crops, on
livestock, and on fisheries, etc. and also to produce these inputs and make them available to a
large number of farmers on a easy terms. Under these departments there are at present 4
Agricultural Research Situations, 4 Agronomy Farms, 23 Horticulture Development Centres, 4
Livestock Development Farms, 3 Poultry Hatcheries, 34 Veterinary Hospitals and Dispensaries, 3
cheese Factories, 1 Dairy Centre and 10 Fishery Centres located in different parts of the country.
With an aim of establishing a close link between agricultural research and farmers, an agriculture
extension programmes is being implemented under the supervision of graduate level Agriculture
Development Officers posted in 43 out of 75 districts. In the field of training during the last four
years, more then 800 J.T.As. have been trained and 1870 farmers have received practical training.
An Agriculture College has been established to train higher level agricultural technicians inside
the country. In addition, the Agricultural Development Bank, Land Reform Savings Corporation
and Agricultural Supply Corporation have been established in order to provide credit, fertilizers,
seeds, implements and other inputs to the farms. A Dairy Development Corporation has also
been established to turn the dairy enterprise along business lines. A Minor Irrigation Department
with the objective of developing irrigation facilities according to the needs of the agricultural
development programmes has been established in the Ministry of Agriculture.
A perusal of the progress made so far in the development of agriculture and its present status shows that the
use of such high yielding inputs as improved seeds and fertilizer and the provision of irrigation facilities are at a very
low level. Out of 1,845,000 hectares of cultivated land, improved seeds have been used in only 102,630 hectares,
and the annual use of chemical fertilizer ahs amounted to gross
24,000 metric ton. Similarly, irrigation facilities have been provided to 117,500 hectares which is only 6 percent of
the total cultivated land. Furthermore, this includes minor irrigation from which it is naturally doubtful that
permanent irrigation facilities will evolve. Although in the last four years institutional reforms have been introduced
and at the same time several institutions have been established in the agricultural sector, much remains to be done to
make them more effective.
terms and also to fix on appropriate rent ceiling that would permit the actual farmers to receive a large
art of the increased production. Moreover, no effort has been made so far to provide marketing and
warehousing facilities.
Objectives, Policies and Priorities of Agricultural
Development in the Fourth Plan
Objectives:
The agricultural development programme in the Fourth Plan will be geared to attain the following objectives
through the maximization of output. This calls for increasing production of each crops, yields per land area & per
capita yields:
(a) To ensure rising levels of consumption;
(b) To provide greater exports;
(c) To supply an adequate amount of industrial raw-materials;
(d) To develop greater purchasing power for a larger segment off the population; and
(e) To generate a capital base for savings and a broader tax base.
Policies:
In accordance with the above mentioned objectives and also on the basis of the present status of the
agricultural sector, the policies adopted in the Fourth Plan for the agricultural development are the following:
1. Efforts will be concentrated in a few selected fields so that the limited resources are not scattered thinly
over too many projects and over too many lines of production irrespective of their effectiveness.
Accordingly the following modus operandi is adopted for the formulation of programmes:
(a) First, the country will be delineated into major agricultural areas according to potential for food
grain production, cash crop production, livestock development and dairy products, horticulture
production, fishery, etc.,
(b) Second, areas or districts for each line of production where concentrated efforts will be made
for providing the services and inputs required to achieve the targets in each line of
production will be selected.
2. The many activities for agricultural development, like extension, research irrigation etc. undertaken by the
concerned departments of the Ministry of Food & Agriculture, will be coordinated and integrated to make
them mutually reinforcing. All the departments in the center will be streamlined to implement the
programmes, while at the same time providing a network at the village level. All the extension activities in
agriculture will be channeled through one department. Effort will be made to make the villages the central
point of all agricultural development programmes.
3. In order to increase agricultural production, it is necessary to make available adequately the numerous
services and facilities such as improved seeds, fertilizer, pesticides, tools and implements to the
programmes of the various agencies such as the Agriculture Development Bank, the Agriculture Supply
Corporation, the Land Reform Savings Corporation, and the Cooperative Department will be operated in
an integrated way.
4. Since it has become essential to consider measures to solve the problems of marketing, the agricultural
development programme will attempt to develop marketing channels through the reorganized cooperatives.
Also, a marketing organization will be established at the national level. In addition, emphasis will be given
to the adoption of an appropriate rent and land tax base in the agricultural sector.
5. Extensive feasibility studies are required if the goals of promoting agro-based industries and diversifying
agriculture are to be achieved. Arrangement will be made to provide the credit and technical assistance
required to the landlords for the establishment of these industries. This credit is conditional on the sale of
their land to the tillers. Similarly, appropriate programmes will be implemented to increase production of
food grains, fruits, vegetables, milk, and other livestock.
6. There are indications that the Terai will face decreasing prices for its grain exports to India. Efforts are
urgently required to increase future exports of the Terai surplus to countries other than India. The market
should also be extended towards the hills. This is possible only if the purchasing power of the hill people is
increased. For these reasons, the policy is to invest in the hills according to the potentially of agricultural
development.
Priorities:
The formulation of the Agricultural Programme under the Fourth Plan consists of specific projects and is
designed at the onset to include ongoing projects which have already been started and other projects for which
foreign aid has already been ear-marked by agreement. In addition, attention will be given to projects which
have already been built but are not operating. Additional investment will have to be included in the programme
if such projects are to be made operational. One of the overriding principles in drawing up the programme is
the determination of what can be done to maximize the use of present projects, ensuring at same time a logical
linking of both the continuing and new projects.
Agriculture Development Programme in the Fourth Plan
It is necessary to increase the output of cereal and cash crops, as much as possible, to
attain the objectives of agricultural development under the Fourth Plan. In addition, the
production of fruits, vegetables, meat, milk and eggs has to be increased in order to augment the
supply of nutritious food. Keeping this in view, targets of different agricultural products, along
with the necessary supply of inputs and departmental programmes, have been fixed for the Plan
period and are described below:
1.
Cereal Grain:
During the Fourth Plan period, the population of Nepal is projected to increase at the rate of 1.95 per cent
per annum. Thus, to meet the increased demands of food grains caused by increase in population and income and in
view of the fact that production of cereal grain increased by only 2.5 per cent per annum during the Third Plan
period, it is envisaged in the Fourth Plan to increase the production of cereal grains by 16 per cent. Accordingly, the
average annual increase in production will be 3 per cent. It is estimated that the annual increase in the production of
paddy, maize and wheat will be 2 per cent, 1.3 per cent and 14.4 per cent respectively. This target is based upon past
progress and future programmes to be implemented during the Fourth Plan period. Production targets of different
cereal crops during the Fourth Plan period are shown in the Table below:
1.
2.
3.
Crops
Paddy
Maize
Wheat (including barley)
4.
Total
TABLE 21
PRODUCTION TARGET OF CEREAL CROPS
(In Thousand Metric Tons)
Est production
Target of
Percent
Annual
1969-70
1974-75
increase
growth
2,353.81
2,598.60
10.40
2.0
918.21
980.17
6.74
1.3
296.59
580.00
95.55
14.14
120.00
120.00
0.00
0.00
3,688.61
4,278.77
16.00
3.0
In order to fulfill the target of cereal grain production, efforts will be concentrated on the provision
of seeds, fertilizers, irrigation facilities, and agricultural extension to those districts selected on the basis of
priority. The selection of districts for the intensive Agriculture Development Programme is based on the
following factors:
(a) The availability of irrigation and transport facilities;
(b) Provision of organizational units concerned with agriculture development;
(c) Potentially of agricultural development;
(d) Regional development; and
(e) Facilities of government offices.
Districts selected for Intensive Agricultural Development Programme are as follows:
TABLE 22
ESTIMATED CONTRIBUTION OF DIFFERENT INPUTS TO ACHIEVE
TARGETS OF CEREAL GRAIN PRODUCTION
(In Per cent)
Crop:
Paddy
Wheat
Maize
Cereal
Inputs
1. Chemical Fertilizer
2. Improved Seeds
3. Irrigation
4. Plant Protection Services
5. Additional cultivated land
Total
42
26
20
5
7
100
28
18
15
22
17
100
29
26
27
13
5
100
33
22
17
14
14
100
Improved Seeds:
Since improved seeds play an important role increasing agricultural production, it is estimated that
their use will contribute to 22 per cent of the increase in the total production. It is estimated that in the last year
of the Plan 25,020 metric tons of seeds will be provided for 472,000 hectares of land. A breakdown of this
programme is given in Table 23.
TABLE 23
USE OF IMPROVED SEEDS
Crops
Paddy
Intensive Districts
Other Districts
Total
Wheat
Intensive Districts
Other Districts
Total
Maize
Intensive Districts
Other Districts
Total
1970-71
Area Seed
1971-72
Area Seed
88
17
105
4.4
0.7
5.1
98
22
120
4.9
1.1
6.0
118
32
150
5.9
1.6
7.5
139
41
180
7.0
2.0
9.0
147
50
197
7.4
2.5
9.9
86.4
9.7
96.1
6.0
0.7
6.7
102.3
13.2
115.5
7.2
0.9
8.1
121.9
17.6
139.5
8.5
1.2
9.7
145.6
23.4
169.0
10.2
1.6
11.8
170.0
30.0
200.0
11.9
2.1
14.0
13.0
2.0
15.0
0.19
0.03
0.22
21.0
4.0
25.0
0.32
0.06
0.38
32.0
8.0
40.0
0.48
0.12
0.60
46.0
14.0
60.0
0.69
0.21
0.90
56.0
19.0
75.0
0.84
0.28
1.12
The necessary arrangements for increasing the supply of improved seeds should be made from the
beginning of the Fourth Plan period. The major responsibility for this will lie with the Agriculture Education and
Research Department, the Agri-Extension Department, and the Agriculture Supply Corporation. Foundation
seeds which are discovered to be suitable for food grain production from research work undertaken by the
agriculture stations of the Agriculture Education and Research Department and located in different parts of the
country will be multiplied at government farms and made available to registered seed growers. The seed growers
will grow the improved seeds under the direction and technical assistance of the Agriculture Education and
Research Department. The Agriculture Supply Corporation will purchase and sell these certified seeds inside the
country and import the necessary amount of seeds to meet the requirements fixed under the agriculture extension
programme.
Only a portion of the total amount of improved seeds required to meet the target will be supplied by the
Agriculture Supply Corporation. A major portion of the required improved seeds is expected to be provided by
the farmers themselves. To accomplish this, it is necessary to make the agriculture extension programme more
effective. The quantity of seeds to be supplied by the Agriculture Supply Corporation is given in the Table 24.
Crops
Paddy
Wheat
Maize
TABLE 24
QUANTITY OF SEEDS TO BE SUPPLIED BY AGRICULTURE SUPPLY
CORPORATION
(in Metric Tons)
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
400
600
800
1,100
1,400
546
780
1,092
1,326
1,510
136
204
306
408
510
b.
Chemical Fertilizer:
More than 33 per cent of increased production during the Fourth Plan period is expected to be achieved
by the use of chemical fertilizer will be used for different crops in the last year of the Third Plan period. Those
areas where irrigation available and where improved seeds are being used will be given top priority for use of
fertilizer. Moreover, information about the use of the new types of chemical fertilizer will be provided to the
farmers by the Department of Agriculture Extension. According to this programme, it is proposed that the
Agriculture Supply Corporation will import all the required chemical fertilizer and distribute it to the farmers
through its agencies. The annual quantities of chemical fertilizer used for different crops during the Plan period
are given in the following Table:
TABLE 25
QUANTITY OF CHEMICAL FERTILIZERS TO BE USED
(in Metric Tons)
Crops
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Paddy
Intensive Districts
3,892
5,989
7,531
9,258
11,365
Other Districts
57
104
166
239
317
Total
3,949
6,093
7,697
9,497
11,682
Wheat
Intensive Districts
3,982
4,692
5,562
6,634
7,728
Other Districts
420
536
684
880
1,091
Total
4,402
5,228
6,246
7,514
8,819
Maize
Intensive Districts
832
1,395
2,294
3,309
4,507
Other Districts
397
500
628
782
950
Total
1,229
1,895
2,922
4,091
5,457
c.
Irrigation:
In accordance with the target of food grain production in the Fourth Plan, it is estimated that additional
246,000 hectares of land will require irrigation facilities.
It will contribute more than 17 per cent to the increased production. During the Plan period 183,632
hectares of cultivated land will be irrigated by major, tube-well, and minor irrigation projects. Details about the
various irrigation projects included in the Fourth Plan are given under the chapter on the Irrigation Programme
d. Plant Protection Services:
Approximately 16 per cent of the total annual agricultural production is estimated to be destroyed by
diseases, insects and pests. It is thus evident that if the plant protection programme is implemented more
effectively, agricultural production can be easily raised. So far, it has been possible to provide the necessary
facilities to limited areas only because of lack of the necessary technicians and materials. Such services are
expected to contribute about 14 per cent to increased production in the Fourth Plan period. Necessary
arrangements will be made to extend plant protection services. This programme will include the training of
farmers regarding plant protection, the distribution of necessary materials including polythene bags and
pesticides at low prices, and the provision of emergency plant protection services. Since it is not possible to
supply pesticides solely through the government, the private sector will also be encouraged in this field and will
be provided with the necessary technical and other assistance. It is estimated that plant protection materials
worth 5.4 million rupees will be used during the Fourth Plan period. Out of this, materials worth 3.9 million
rupees will be supplied by the Agriculture Supply Corporation.
e. Agricultural Tools and Implements:
Due attention has been given to the use of improved agricultural and implements under the agriculture
development programme of the Fourth Plan. The major portion of the demand for such materials is expected to
be supplied by the existing Agriculture Tools and Implements Factory at Birgunj. The main responsibility for
the distribution of tools and implements will be upon the Agriculture Supply Corporation. The Corporation will
sell agriculture tools and implements worth Rs. 7.3 million during the Plan period.
f. Reclamation of additional cultivable land:
To achieve the agricultural production target of the Fourth Plan, 25,000 hectares of additional land
will be reclaimed, out of which 21,000 hectares will be brought under cultivation. This will contribute
approximate 14 per cent to additional production. Reclamation works in these 25,000 hectares of new land will
be undertaken by the Department of Resettlement and Resettlement Company.
g.
TABLE 26
PRODUCTION TARGET OF CASH CROPS
Crops
1. Sugarcane
2. Jute
3. Tobacco
4. Oilseeds
Total
Est. Production
(1969-70)
200.0
48.0
7.5
58.0
313.5
Target
(1974-75)
300.0
65.0
10.0
64.8
439.8
Additional
increase
100.0
17.0
2.5
6.8
126.3
Increase in
percentage
50.0
35.4
33.3
11.7
40.3
The quantity of necessary inputs to fulfill the target in respect of the cash crops is estimated as follows:
TABLE 27
QUANITITY OF NECESSARY INPUTS FOR CASH CROPS 1974-75
Inputs
1. Additional land to be cultivated
2. Land to be irrigated
3. Improved seeds
4. Fertilizer
Unit
Sugarcane
Hec
M.T.
2,520
1,400
11,900
212
Jute
2,994
5,274
72
660
Tobacc
o
2,000
1,450
120
35
Oilseeds
3,000
13,000
160
888
Total
10,514
21,124
12,252
1,795
The quantity of seeds and chemical fertilizers required for this programme will be made available
through the Agriculture Supply Corporation. As in the case of the food grain programme, arrangements for the
provision of loans for the cash crop development programme will be taken care of by the concerned
organization. It will be difficult to enlist the interest and cooperation of the farmers in this programme because
of its newness. The targets, have been made practical. The details of the cash crop programme are given in the
following Table:
TABLE 28
CASH CROPS PROGRAMME
Crops
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
A) AREA TO BE COVERED BY IMPROVED SEEDS (In Hectare)
Sugarcane
119
555
1020
1680
2500
Jute
500
1500
4000
6500
8000
Oilseeds
650
3200
6400
10900
16000
Tobacco
35
100
200
330
500
B) REQUIREMENTS OF SEEDS (In M.T.)
Sugarcane
566.37
2165.86
4857.14
8000.16
11900.94
Jute
4.50
13.50
36.00
58.50
72.00
Oilseeds
6.50
32.00
64.00
109.00
160.00
Tobacco (Kg.)
8.40
24.00
48.00
79.20
120.00
C) REQUIREMENTS OF CHEMICAL FERTILIZERS (In M.T.)
Sugarcane
10.0
39.0
87.0
143.0
212.0
Jute
40.0
120.0
320.0
530.0
660.0
Oilseeds
36.0
178.0
361.0
605.0
888.0
Tobacco
2.0
7.0
14.0
23.0
35.0
Total
88.0
344.0
782.0
1301.0
1795.0
The following districts have been selected on the basis of their potentiality for development and their
contiguity to the existing factories:
Crops
Districts
__________________________________________________________________________________
1. Sugarcane Bara, Parsa, Rupandehi, Kapilvastu, Morang, Chitwan, Kailali
2. Jute
Morang, Sunsari, Jhapa, Saptari
3. Tobacco
Dhanusha, Siraha, Mahottari, Sarlahi, Chitwan, Kailali, Bardia, Banke, Dang
4. Oilseeds
Saptari, Sarlahi, Dhanusha, Makwanpur, Rautahat, Nawal-parasi.
TABLE 29
PRODUCTION TARGET OF LIVESTOCK PRODUCTS
Items
Unit
Meat
a. Buffaloes
b. Pigs
c. Sheep
d. Goats
e. Fowls
f. Others
Milk
a. Buffaloes
b. Cows
c. Others
Milk Products
b. Ghee & Butter
c. Cheese
Eggs
M.T.
M.T.
M.T.
M.T.
M.T.
M.T.
M.T.
000 litres
000 litres
000 litres
000 litres
M.T.
M.T.
000 Nos.
Est.
Production
of 1969-70
46,100
19,000
4,200
2,700
2,900
7,300
10,000
5,82,600
4,00,000
1,78,000
4,600
9,000
37
1,80,000
Target of
1974-75
53,475
23,000
5,600
3,100
3,100
8,475
10,000
7,17,000
5,00,000
2,12,000
5,000
12,000
75
2,27,000
Increase
7,375
4,200
1,400
400
200
1,175
1,34,40
0
1,00,00
0
34,000
400
3,000
38
47,000
Increase in
Percentage
16
22.1
33.3
14.8
6.9
16.0
23
25
19
9
33
100
26
In order to fulfill the targeted production of meat, the number of animals required at the end of the Plan
period are shown in the following Table:
TABLE 30
Livestock
Buffaloes
Pigs
Sheep
Goats
Fowls
To be
imported
35
10
30
60
-
Since all the slaughter animals required to fulfill the target will not be available internally from the natural
increase in the country-animal stock (even including the increase due to the livestock development and improved
cattle breeding programme) the shortage will be met by imports.
Balanced Feed
A programme for making available qualitatively improved and balanced feed is also included in the
Fourth Plan. At present the only food producing center is in Hetauda. It is envisaged in the Fourth Plan to
establish four additional centers in the private sector. Production of each of these center is projected in the
following Table:
Producing Centres
Public Sector
Hetauda
Private Sector
Biratnagar
Nepalgunj
Bhairahawa
dhangadhi
Total
TABLE 31
PRODUCTION TARGET OF ANIMAL FEED
(In Metric Tons)
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
2,500
-
2,500
2,500
-
2,500
2,500
2,500
-
2,500
2,500
2,500
2,500
2,500
2,500
2,500
2,500
2,500
2,500
2,500
5,000
7,500
12,500
12,500
Artificial Insemination
In the field of livestock development, it has been difficult to make available improved bullocks and
buffaloes in the adequate numbers for the purpose of breeding. It has become necessary, therefore, to implement an
artificial insemination programme. This programme will help to increase the production of milk and other livestock
products from the local breed.
At present, facilities for artificial insemination have been made available at the existing seven centers and
four sub-centres located in different parts of the country. In order to achieve the livestock development target of the
Fourth Plan, these facilities will be provided in an extensive way. Under this programme, provision is made for the
recruitment of the necessary technicians who will be posted in the existing thirty-four veterinary hospitals and seven
new hospitals to be opened during the Plan period. It is expected that 198,000 cows and buffaloes will be artificially
inseminated.
Veterinary Services
The availability of veterinary services is essential for the protection of livestock. At present, there are 34
veterinary hospitals in the country. Seven new hospitals will be established specially in those districts where the
livestock development programme is to be implemented. Existing Veterinary Hospitals are at present located in the
following places:
Kathmandu
Birgunj
Ilam
Pokhara
Lalitpur
Kalaiya
Bhadrapur
Bandipur
Bhaktapur
Bharatpur
Bhairawa
Baglung
Trisuli
Okhaldhunga
Palpa
Mustang
Dhulikhel
Bhojpur
Nepalgunj
Jumla
Janakpur
Rajbiraj
Surkhet
Humla
Sindhuligadi
Dhankuta
Dang
Baitadi
Jiri
Biratnagar
Kailali
Kanchanpur
During the Plan period, Veterinary Hospitals will be set up in the following places:
Taplejng
Ramechhap
Rasuwa
Bajura
Rukum
Darchula
Sankhuwashabha
Surveys of animal diseases will also be conducted. The production of vaccines in the laboratory at
Kathmandu will be expanded in hopes of gaining control of different types of diseases.
TABLE 32
PRODUCTION OF LIVESTOCK IN THE GOVERNMENT FARMS
Livestock
Cow-calves
Baffalo-calves
Lambs
Pigs
Unit
No.
No.
No.
No.
1970-71
75
104
616
950
1971-72
90
119
746
1,210
1972-73
97
128
1,034
1,460
1973-74
113
159
1,139
1,820
1974-75
152
202
1,379
2,310
Total
527
712
5,094
7,750
Poultry Farming
Keeping in view the important role of poultry farming in the field of livestock
development, a programme for the production and sale of improved breeds of chicken has been
implemented. In the last few years encouraging progress has been made by the private sector in
poultry farming especially in Kathmandu. At present, 100,000 chickens of the new improved
breed are produced every year in the three existing hatcheries located at Parwanipur, Jawalakhel
and Biratnagar. It is estimated that the two privately owned hatcheries produce 100,000 chickens
annually.
In order to fulfil the targets for poultry meat and eggs, three brooder units will be established at Pokhara,
Nepalgunj and Bhairahwa during the Plan period. As the target can not be fulfilled by the Government sector alone,
further contributions in this field are needed from the private sector. Hence, five hatcheries, each with an annual
production capacity of 100,000 chickens should be established in the private sector. The number of chickens to be
produced and distributed from both the government and private hatcheries during the Plan period is shown in the
following Table:
TABLE 33
PRODUCTION AND SALES OF CHICKENS (In Thousands)
Hatchery
Government
Private
1970-71
100
100
1971-72
100
200
1972-73
100
300
1973-74
100
400
1974-75
100
600
Dairy Industry
It is evident that programmes such as artificial insemination, pasture development and production of
improved food, as mentioned above, will help to fulful the Fourth Plans target of milk production. Moreover, it is
expected that milk production will increase as a result of the assured market provided bythe Dairy Development
Corporation which was established to prodec commercially pasteurized milk and milk products. The production
targets of processed milk, cheese and other milk products will be fulfilled mainly from this Corporation and its
centers that will be established during the Plan period. The programme of the Dairy Development Corporation are as
follows:
(i) Urban Milk Supply Project
At present, a central dairy with a capacity of 1.2 million litres has been established inKathmandu. It
collects, processes, preserves and distributes milk and milk-products in a modern way. Keeping in view the
increasing demand for milk, the capacity of this dairy will be increased to 3 million litres during the Plan
period. In addition, since it has become necessary to provide pasteurized milk in other urban areas of the
country, a programme for establishing dairies at Biratnagar, Nepalgunj and Birgunj is also included in the
Fourth Plan. The projected annual production of pasteurized milk during the Plan period is shown in the
following Table:
TABLE 34
PRODUCTION TARGET OF PASTEURIZED MILK
(In Thousand Litres)
Projects
1. Central Dairy Kathmandu
2. Urban Milk Supply Project:
a. Biratnagar
b. Nepalgunj
c. Birgunj
1970-71
1,200
Construction
-
1971-72
1,500
Construction
Construction
-
1972-73
1,500
Construction
Construction
Construction
1973-74
3,000
1,500
Construction
Construction
1974-75
3,000
1,500
1,000
Construction
Since there is a suitable climate and an adequate quantity of water in the different lakes
and rivers of Nepal, it has become essential to pay attention to the development of fisheries in
hopes of making available an essential nutritive diet for the increasing population. At present, no
estimate of total fish production of the country is available. It is, however, estimated that
additional fish production was approximately 560 metric tons in the fiscal year 1969/70. On the
basis of this estimate and considering the possible programmes which can be implemented during
the Fourth Plan it is envisaged to increase additional fish production from 560 metric tons to
2000 metric tons by 1974-75. According to this estimate, the quantity of fish to be available from
different sources is shown in the following Table:
Sources
Lakes
Rivers
Ponds
Commercial Farms
Total
TABLE 35
FISH PRODUCTION TARGET
(In Metric Tons)
Est. increase in
Additional increase
1969-70
in 1974-75
10
15
250
400
800
150
375
560
1,440
Total Increase
25
250
1,200
525
2,000
About one million fingerlings were sold in the year 1969/70. In order to fulfil the estimated target of fish production,
4 million fingerlings will have to be sold in the year 1974/75. since it is not possible to produce the fingerlings from
the Government Fishery Centres and Fish-farms alone, the private sector will be encouraged to produce more and
will be provided with technical and other assistance. It is estimated that while carrying the fingerlings from the
government Fish Centres to the farmers ponds, the rate of mortality is about 25 per cent. To compensate for this,
about one million fingerlings should be produced in the private sector. The number of fingerlings to be sold and
distributed each year during the Plan period by the government farms and the private sector are given in the
following Table:
Source
Government Sector
Private Sector
Total
TABLE 36
SALES AND DISTRIBUTION OF FINGERLINGS
(No. in Thousand)
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
100
1,450
1,850
2,500
50
150
500
100
1,500
2,000
3,000
1974-75
3,000
1,000
4,000
During the Plan period, the annual projected production of fingerlings from all the fishery
development projects operated by the government sector is given in the following Table:
TABLE 37
PRODUCTION OF FINGERLINGS IN THE GOVERNMENT SECTOR
(No. In Thousands)
Fish Centres Farms.
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
Godavari
250
110
80
100
Janakpur
150
175
210
240
Pokhara
30
50
80
100
Tarahara
125
170
200
210
Parwanipur
150
200
220
240
Bhairahwa
80
100
125
160
Hetauda
300
420
525
600
Rapti
100
400
460
550
Kathmandu
70
350
500
600
Trout Hatchery
50
75
Nepalgunj
10
20
40
Rajbiraj
10
20
40
Eastern Terai
75
300
Western Terai
100
Total
1,255
1,995
2,565
3,355
1974-75
100
275
120
230
270
200
600
650
750
100
75
75
400
300
4,145
Accordingly, it has been estimated that more than 1,500 metric tons of fish will be
produced by the end of the Plan due to the distribution of the fingerlings. This still leaves about
500 metric tons to fulfil the plan target. This shortage will be met by the production of the
Government Fish Centres and Farms and the fisheries contract on different rivers. The annual
projected production of the Government Fish Centres and Farms during the Plan period is given
in the following Table:
TABLE 38
PRODUCTION OF FISH FROM THE GOVERNMENT FISH CENTRES
(In hundred kilograms)
Fish Centres & Farms
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Godavari
Janakpur
Pokhara
Tarahara
Parwanipur
Bhairahwa
Hetauda
Rapti
Nepalgunj
Eastern Terai
Rajbiraj
Western Terai
2.5
4.0
65.0
4.0
4.0
3.0
150.0
232.5
Total
4.0
6.0
60.0
5.0
5.0
4.0
300.0
200.0
584.0
6.2
8.0
55.0
5.5
6.0
5.0
400.0
300.0
2.0
2.0
7879.7
7.0
9.0
50.0
6.0
7.5
7.0
400.0
400.0
3.0
300.0
3.0
1,192.5
8.0
10.0
50.0
7.5
8.5
9.0
450.0
550.0
4.0
300.0
4.0
150.0
1,551.0
Fish breeding centers and commercial farms have been established in different pars of the
country in order to breed native and foreign fishes (like carps, trouts, asala and mahasher) after
the necessary survey and research is done in accordance with the climatic and geographinc
conditions of the country. During the Fourth Plan period, two new breeding centers and two large
fish development centers will be established.
Horticulture Development
It is essential to increase the production of fruits and vegetables in order to meet the
growing internal demand for nutritious food and to possibly increase the volume of exports.
Since diverse climatic conditions are present in the country, there is ample opportunity to
produce different potential for development in this field, the targets for the production of fruits,
vegetables and potatoes during the Fourth Plan period have been fixed and are given in the
following Table:
TABLE 39
TARGET OF HORTICULTURAL PRODUCTIONS
Crop
Unit
Situation in
1969-70
Target of
1974-75
Net
Increment
Increase in
Percentage
Fruits:
Area
Production
Potato:
Area
Production
Vegetable seeds:
Production
Hectare
M.T.
Hectare
M.T.
M.T.
21,000
2,66,000
43,875
3,35,000
20
30,000
2,76,000
55,000
4,35,000
40
9,000
10,000
11,125
1,00,000
20
48.14
3.75
25.35
29.85
100.00
The requirements for those seeds and plant inputs necessary to fulfil the Plans production
target for each crop have been estimated, and the programme for making such inputs available
has been determined as follows:
Fruits
In order to fulful the targets of the Plan, 2.25 million plants will be required for an
additional 9,000 hectares or 250 plants per hectare. However, about 33 per cent of the plants will
be lost during planting, so an additional 75 million plants will be required, thus making the total
number of plants required to be 3 million. This requirement will be met by the production of the
horticulture centers located in different parts of the country and also by the provision of
incentives and encouragement to the private sector. The shortage will be met by imports.
The annual programme making these plants available is shown in the following Table:
TABLE 40
PLANTS TO BE AVAILABLE IN THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
Year
Number of
Plants required
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Total
5,00,000
5,50,000
6,00,000
6,50,000
7,00,000
30,00,000
Production in
Horticultural
Centres
1,50,000
2,00,000
2,50,000
3,50,000
4,50,000
14,00,000
Production in
the Private
Sector
50,000
1,00,000
2,00,000
3,50,000
Plants to be
Imported
3,50,000
3,50,000
3,00,000
2,00,000
50,000
12,50,000
Potatoes
of the Plan period. This will require 12,500 metric tons of potato seeds, including 1 M.T. per
hectare for the 11,125 hectares and a provision for potential loss. The Nucleus Seed Production
Programme will be implemented to meet this requirement. Under this programme, registered
growers will produce improved potato seeds under the technical guidance of the Horticulture
Department. Foundation seeds will be produced and made available from the Potato
Development Centres under the Horticulture Department. Fertilizers and other inputs required for
this programme will be made available fro the Agricultural Supply Corporation. It is expected
that 12,500 metric tons of potato seeds will be produced by the third year of the Plan period.
Vegetable Seeds
In order to produce the additional 20 metric tons of vegetable seeds envisaged in the Plan,
it will e necessary to cultivate vegetables on 40 hectares of land, assuming that 500 Kg. Will be
produced per hectare. A Nucleus Seed Production Programme will be implemented for this
purpose as in the case of potato seeds production, and necessary technical and other assistance
will be provided to the private sector. Accordingly, the annual programme for cultivating
vegetables both in the Hilly and Terai Regions is given in the following Table:
TABLE 41
PROGRAMME FOR THE PRODUCTION AND CULTIVATION OF
VEGETABLE SEEDS
Unit
1970-71 1971-72 1972-73 1973-74 1974-75
Region
Hill
Area
Vegetable Seeds
Terai
Area
Vegetable Seeds
Hectare
M.T.
Hectare
M.T.
4
2
4
2
8
4
8
4
14
7
14
7
20
10
20
10
20
10
20
10
transportation facilities are available. Accordingly, two 40 hectare horticultural farms will be
established along Prithivi Highway and Arniko Highway. Similarly another horticulture farm
covering an area of 120 hectares will be established along the Simra-Janakpur sector of
Mahendra Highway.
Horticulture Research
At present, experimental research work aimed at increasing the production of fruits,
potatoes and vegetables is being undertaken at horticultural stations located in different parts of
the country. Before the Third Plan, there were 16 such stations, including nurseries under the
Department of Horticulture. Seven additional stations were established during the Third Plan
period. New stations will be established at Humla and Mustang district during the Fourth Plan
period. Emphasis in this research programme will be given to the fulfillment of the production
targets of the Fourth Plan. Since no programme has yet been implemented in the field of
horticulture, research work will also be encouraged in this field at the existing stations.
Agricultural Education and Research
In order to ascertain the effects of the combined or individual use of various inputs (like
improved seeds, fertilizers, implements, pesticides and irrigation) in increasing the output of
important cereal and cash crops and also to determine their practical utility, research work has
already been started in the agricultural stations and farms of the Department of Agricultural
Education and Research located in different parts of the country. The training programme for
technicians required in the agricultural sector is also continuing. During the Fourth Plan period,
all research activities undertaken by the Agricultural Education and Research Department will be
made more effective, emphasizing those aspects of research which directly help to increase
productivity. Because of the great climatic differences in the country, it is not possible to apply
the results of research and experiments from one area to another. Therefore, all research activities
in all stations and farms will be carried out in an integrated way. The programmes to be
implemented by various actions are as follows:
(a) Agricultural Botany
In hopes of improving cereal crops such as paddy, wheat, corn, millet as well as other crops such
as oil-seeds and pulses, the collection of improved seeds from both internal and external sources
and the multiplication of those seeds found suitable after analysis and varietal test will be
expanded. At present, sample-analysis of seeds as required by the Agriculture supply corporation
and the district agricultural development programme are being undertaken at a Seed Testing
Laboratory in Kathmandu. Since the Centre is unable to provide the required facilities for testing
seeds, additional laboratories will be established in the agricultural stations located at
Parwanipur, Janakpur and Bhairahwa during the Plan period. In addition, a seed multiplication
and development project will be implemented with the joint collaboration of His Majestys
Government, Nepal and the United Nations Special Fund. Under this programme, a seedprocessing center will be established at Hetauda and necessary technical services for the
production of certified seeds will be provided to the farmers
(b) Agronomy
In accordance with the Plan target, foundation seeds (including the imported varieties that are
found suitable after botanical research and analysis) will be produced at various agricultural
farms in the country. In addition, experimental research work on the use of the new variety seeds,
fertilizers, water and other inputs will be continued as in the past. These foundation-seeds will be
produced at the agricultural farms at Khumaltar, Doti, Nepalgunj and Janakpur and the
agricultural stations at Rampur, Parwanipur, Tarahara and Bhairahwa. The projected production
for each year of the Plan period is as given below in the Table. In order to develop improved
seeds suitable for the hilly regions, two agronomy farms, one in the eastern hills and the other in
the western hills, will be established during the Plan period:
TABLE 42
PROJECTED PRODUCTION OF DIFFERENT AGRICULTURAL PRODUCTS
DURING THE PLAN PERIOD
(In Metric Tons)
Crop
Paddy
Wheat
Sugarcane
Tobacco
Oil-seeds
Jute
1970-71
108
39
200
0.04
2.10
0.30
1971-72
130
45
237
0.05
2.70
0.40
1972-73
149
51
262
0.06
3.20
0.50
1973-74
171
56
299
0.07
3.90
0.60
1974-75
192
61
335
0.08
4.50
0.70
Total
750
252
1333
0.30
16.40
2.50
Bhairahwa and Dahngarhi during the Plan period. Specific research will be carried on regarding
those insects which appear to be important from an industrial point of view: bees, silk-worms,
etc. in addition, legal measures will be taken, and plant quarantine units will be established in
order to check the entry of new pests and other disease-transmitting insects and to prevent the
spread of pest within the country, thereby making the farmers more enthusiastic and responsive
towards crop protection measures. Plant Quarantine Check-Posts will be established at
Tribhuwan Airport, Birgunj, Nepalgunj, Jogbani and Bhairahwa during the Plan period.
(e) Plant Pathology
In order to control plant disease and to safeguard productions, plant pathological research will
be conducted on both local and improved varieties of paddy, corn, wheat, citrus fruits,
vegetables, potatoes, oranges, sugarcane, jute and tobacco. Research, experimentations, and
demonstration of the simple, economic, and effective measures to control plant diseases will
be undertaken. For this purpose, there is at present a laboratory at Khumaltar, and plant
protection units have also been set-up at Ilam, Biratnager, Rapti and Dhaulagiri Zones during
the Plan period. Because this programme is also related to entomology, both will be jointly
implemented by all the plant protection units.
(f) Soil Science
In order to ascertain the production potential of the soil, the initial necessary steps are the survey,
analysis and classification of the different types of soil found in the country. The necessary
working this field has already stared. A central laboratory has been established for the analysis of
various types of soil and their properties. In the Plan period a soil survey of 3.427 million
hectares, of land and a analysis of 40,000 samples of soil will be conducted. Experimentation on
the productivity differences of major crops like jute, maize and paddy, as a result of the
application of different organic and chemical fertilizers with various types of soil and climatic
conditions, will be conducted at different Agricultural Stations and Farms. Also, HMG in a joint
effort will consist of experiments on different crops and fertilizer use according to soil
conditions, demonstrations of results in the farmers fields, and the establishment of a soil testing
laboratory at Parwanipur. In the second phase of the programme, two pilot projects will be
scientifically implemented. Studies will also be undertaken regarding soil physics, soil
microbiology, and soil conservation.
(g) Agricultural Station
The different research projects outlined above have been implemented at the agricultural stations
located at Bhairahwa, Rampur, Parawanipur and Tarahara. The necessary administrative
arrangements will be made at eh beginning of the Plan period to ensure better coordination
between the different programmes. The work to be done by the respective sections has already
been outlined above.
(h) Agricultural College
In order to fulfil the requirements for medium and other lower level technicians, an
agricultural school was established in 1956. An Agricultural College was established in 1968,
with the objective of domestically providing the training facilities for higher level technicians. By
the end of 1970, it is projected that 225 persons will be trained up to I.Sc. level, 25 persons up to
B.Sc. level, 700 persons up to JTA levels, 340 J.T. As will be upgraded and field training will be
provided to 500 persons.
Agriculture Extension
The Agriculture Extension Programme has been used as an important means of providing
technical assistance and necessary knowledge to the farmers so that they could adopt improved
modern agricultural techniques such as the applicable findings of different agricultural research
activities. The Extension Programme also involves the actual demonstration of results, farmers
training programmes, and competition. Under this programme, District Agricultural Development
Offices manned with Agricultural Graduates have already been established in 43 districts, and in
each of another 22 districts, there are two to four medium level Agricultural technicians. At
present, under the Agricultural Extension Department, there are 43 District Agricultural
Development Officers, 90 J.T. and 700 J.T. As.
So far, Agricultural Extension has been primarily limited to food crops. It has, however,
become necessary to pay attention to horticulture, fishery and livestock development projects in
order to fulfil the Plan targets in these sectors. To implement the Agricultural Extension
Programme effectively during the Plan period, specialists in cereals, cash crops, livestock, and
horticulture, will be made available to the District Agriculture Development Offices according to
their agricultural development programmes. Moreover, the number of village-level extension
workers will be increased technical assistance will be provided to them from the nearest
Agriculture Centres and Agriculture Farms. According to this policy, the District Agriculture
Development Offices in 28 selected districts will be further strengthened in order to implement
the Intensive Agricultural Development Programme. In each of the above districts there will be a
J.T.A for every three Panchayats, and one J.T. for 9 J.T.As, and one Graduate level agricultural
technician for each District Agriculture Development Office. In these 28 districts, each J.T.A.
and J.T. will have the responsibility of conducting agricultural extension work in their respective
panchayats, the names of which will be specifically stated. If, after the requirements of the 28
districts are filled, there are any remaining J.T.As, J.T.s and Agricultural Graduates, they will be
posted in the other 37 districts where Agricultural Development Offices have been established,
including those 22 districts where only J.T.s have been deputed. They will be distributed
according to the Districts agricultural development programme. Since there is no arrangement in
the central office to investigate and identify the problems and to evaluate the facts and figures of
the reports received from the District Agriculture Development Offices, it is important to initiate
this kind of work. The Agriculture Extension Programmes training and demonstrations to be
conducted during the Fourth Plan period are given in the following Table:
TABLE 43
AGRICULTURAL EXTENSION TRAINING AND DEMONSTRATION
1. Method Demonstration
2. Result Demonstration
3. a. Leader farmers training (No.)
b. Trained leader farmers (No.)
4. Number of seasonal trained
J.T. As and J. Ts.
5. a. Number of Farmers Day
b. Number of Farmers
participating in the
Farmers Day
6. Agricultural fairs and
exhibitions
7. a. Number of districts
contesting in the Grow
More Crop Competition
b. Number of district
competitions
c. National Competition
d. Estimated Number of Farmers
participating in the competition
8. Rural Youth Programme
a. Number of 4-H Clubs
b. Members of 4-H Clubs and
members to be trained
9. Agriculture Information
Programme
a. Books, booklets, pamphlets,
posters publication (in
thousands)
b. Agriculture exhibition
1. Method-Demonstration
1970-71
1
7,000
3,900
2,000
30,000
200
25
2,500
15
28
84
1
900
204
3,060
1,400
4
1971-72
2
8,000
4,100
4,000
40,000
400
27
2,700
20
30
90
1
1,000
385
5,775
1,550
6
1972-73
3
9,000
4,300
4,500
45,000
400
30
3,000
25
35
105
1
1,100
431
6,465
1,800
6
1973-74
4
10,000
4,500
5,000
50,000
500
32
3,200
30
35
105
1
1,200
601
9,015
2,625
8
1974-75
5
11,000
4,500
6,000
60,000
500
35
3,500
35
40
120
1
1,400
771
11,565
3,150
10
their own fields. This will prove to be very advantageous if adopted; therefore,
great attention will be given to this faster and more effective programme. While
carrying out the result-demonstrations, the farmers should be convinced that
improved seeds will produce more than the local ones. For this purpose, the
improved seed varieties are to be sown along with the local ones. Although there
will be some farmers who are already convinced that increased production will
result from the use of the improved varieties, it is necessary to show to them the
quantitative differences by using a variety of (improved) seeds sown in different
plots. The changes in output of a particular type of seeds due to differences in
fertilizers in the area should also be included in the result-demonstrations.
These type of demonstrations will be carried out particularly on paddy,
maize, wheat and cash crops. For demonstrations, chemical fertilizers, pesticides
and variety seeds will be provided free of cost to the farmers.
J.T.As will perform in heir assigned areas: two to three resultdemonstrations for paddy and wheat, three for maize in the hills, one each in the
Terai, and two for cash crops.
3. Leader Farmer Training
J.T.As stationed in various villages are to teach new techniques and provide
necessary knowledge to the farmers regarding the cultivation of better seeds, uses of fertilizers,
pesticides, medicines, agricultural implements, and scientific methods for livestock rearing. They
are also to select progressive farmers and conduct a one to three day training course regarding
paddy, wheat, maize, cash and other crops, Every J.T.A is to conduct, on average, five such
training courses each year. The necessary seeds, fertilizers, medicines, etc., will be provided free
of charge to the J.T.As for these training programmes. The target of providing training to at least
ten Leader Farmers has been set.
4. Seasonal In- Service Training
Provisions have been made to provide seasonal training to the J.T.As on such
matters as new seeds, fertilizers, plant protection and other medicines recommended as useful by
the research programme and also about new methods of horticulture, fishery and livestock
rearing. Such a programme is not to be longer than five days and should be arranged in each of
the zones by those related to or in the agricultural department. Keeping the zones by those related
to in possible to conduct this type of training programme in all of the districts, so efforts will be
made to train a most five J.Ts. and J.T.As from the intensive districts. The training programme
will cost of two parts:
(a) Winter Season Training: The course will include audio-visual training and will
cover all kinds of winter crops and fruits, taking place from Mid-September to
Mid-Novemner.
(b) Summer Season Training: Training will be provided primarily in paddy, maize,
other summer crops and fruits and fishing, taking place from Mid-February to
Mid-Apil.
5.
Farmers Day
A farmers Day will be arranged in order to teach progressive peasants about the
research findings of the Government Agriculture Farms and Centres on improved seeds,
fertilizers and manures, animals, birds and fruits. This will be done so that the farmers can see
the demonstrations with their own eyes. It has been found that such Farmers Day have had
significant influence upon the farmers, especially since it is not possible to have all the farmers in
one place and since the number of Agricultural Farms and Centres is limited. Farmers Day will
be held by transporting farmers to agricultural farms and centers from outlying districts. Since the
number of 100 progressive farmers from one district will be allowed to participate in Farmers
Day may also be held on the farm of a progressive farmer within the district.
6. Agricultural Fair and Exhibition
The agricultural projects model charts, posters, pictures, booklets, etc. are exhibited at the
fair. The main objective of the exhibition is to attract the attention and interest of the farmers and
to encourage them to use the improved farming methods. Such fairs and exhibitions create a
competitive feeling among the farmers and provide encouragement to the large number of
farmers impressed by the new techniques. Since such arrangements will involve large amount of
money, efforts, and time and since it is not possible to arrange such fairs in all districts, they will
be arranged only in those districts possessing the necessary facilities. It is most essential to obtain
the participation of farmers in the products raised by the farmers, including their domestic
animals. The evaluation committee will decide the items for exhibition, as well as later judging
them. The successful farmers will be awarded prizes of agricultural implements and booklets.
This is mainly to arouse enthusiasm and interest among the farmers.
and improved methods of agriculture. For this purpose, 4-H Clubs will be organized for rural
youth, and training will be provided to them on improved cultivation, animal husbandry, home
science and small scale industry, under the guidance of the J.T., J.T.A. and other adult leaders
who have been trained result-demonstrations on paddy, wheat, maize and vegetable crops will be
done at each club. All the club members will, according to their training interest, capacity and
condition, undertake an agricultural project, and with their own effort and funds proceed to
complete their projects, thereby learning and earning at the same time. They are also to engage in
community service 4-H activities, festivals, cultivation programmes; tours kitchen gardening, and
other programmes.
9. Agriculture Information Programme
A programme for providing information to the maximum number of farmers on research findings
and new techniques will be carried out. This will be done through the mediums of ratio
broadcasting, documentary films, exhibitions, audio-visual aids, publication of books and
booklets, and agricultural news written in a simple language.
Food Research
The food research programme is being implemented with the objectives of conducting research
on the nutritious value of available food stuffs and the provision of technical assistance to make
the necessary arrangements for maintaining regular standards and quality of food stuffs for export
and domestic consumption. A Food Research Laboratory has already been established for this
purpose. Research works in the laboratory will be conducted in an effective way during the
Fourth Plan period. In addition, research work will be undertaken regarding the production of
nutritive food from industrial waste and the preservation of food. A study survey on the nutritious
elements of food will also be undertaken.
Resettlement Programme
There has been increasing population pressure on land, especially in the hilly regions of
the country, as a result of natural increase and the lack of cultivable land, there has been a
growing uncontrolled movement into the Terai forests because of malaria eradication. Because of
these factors, a resettlement programme has become essential. The problem of resettlement has
become more complicated due to an increasing influx of Nepalese from outside, including the exservicemen. In a view of this, a Resettlement Company was set up in the year 1964 in order to
settle landless farmers and their families in a n organized and planned manner. So far, 2000
families have been settled on 5000 hectares of land at Nawalpur and Khajura. A Resettlement
Department has also been recently established, thereby making implementation of these
programmes more extensive. It will be the responsibility of the Nepal Resettlement Company to
carry-out comparatively big projects, involving the resettlement of thousands of farmers. On the
other hand, the resettlement of less then 200 families (including those who have encroached into
the forest areas) will be undertaken by the Resettlement Department through the Zonal
Resettlement Committees.
It has already been mentioned that additional cultivated land will be a significant
contribution to the achievement of the target of food grains production for the Fourth Plan. It has
been envisage in the Plan to settle 8,000 families after reclaiming25,000 hectares of land. The
Districts
Kanchanpur
Kailali
Banke
Bardia
Jhapa
Total
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Total
2,500
625
750
1,875
500
1,125
3,750
1,000
937.5
3,750
1,000
937.5
11,87
5
3,125
3,750
3,875
3,500
5,687.5
5,687.5
TABLE 45
THE RESETTLEMENT PROGRAMME TO BE IMPLEMENTED BY
RESETTLEMENT DEPARTMENT
(Land to be reclaimed in hectares)
Zones
Lumbini
Narayani
Janakpur
Koshi
Districts
Kapilvastu,
Rupandehi,
Nawalparasi
Bara, Parsa &
Rautahat
Sarlahi
Morang, Sunsari
Total
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Total
500
312.5
312.5
312.5
500
250
250
250
500
250
250
250
500
250
250
250
500
187.5
187.5
187.5
2,500
1,250
1,250
1,250
1,437.5
1,250
1,250
1,250
1,062.5
6,250
It has been difficult to formulate and properly implement policies and plans for
agricultural development because of a lack of basic studies and research work. At present, data
on agricultural production and area under cultivation are available. There is, however, a lack of
data regarding capital formation in agriculture, wage rates of seasonal labour, the marketing of
agricultural products, income elasticity of demand for food, input-output relationships in
agriculture, the feasibility of agro-based industries, and evaluations on the impact of land reform,
agricultural extension, agricultural education and research programmes. Therefore, a programme
for the collection of these data has been included in the Fourth Plan
Situation
Target (production)
Continuing
(Outlay
Rs. in
1000)
142
166
204
2,000
300,000
162
229
160
1,500
3,87,800
2,45,00
15,00
119
164
2,200
120
2,83,000
15,00
48
960
150
450
48,000
840
2,000
15,00
400
2,50
Lambs
1,400
2,50
Proposed
90
90
120
540
180,000
15
15
840
60
30,000
25,00
Continuing
198,000
Proposed
Continuing
Proposed
Continuing
500
17,00
12,00
20,00
15,00
300,000
19,00
100,000
8,00
1,00,000
7,00
3,00,000
4,00
3,00
10,00
Proposed
Continuing
Proposed
Continuing
Proposed
Production of different
vaccines required for the
whole kingdom
Establishment of one
diagnostice laboratory to
provide appropriate
treatement for protection
and control of possible
disease of cattle and birds
through the laboratories
under Zonal Veterinary
Centres
Production of fertilizers
from by-products available
through slaughter-house and
waste carcass and to provide
training on carcass
utilization, skinning, curing
and processing.
Production and sale of 2500
Metric Tons of balanced
feed per annum.
1.
2.
1.
2.
1.
2.
1.
2.
1.
2.
3.
Expansion in
capacity
Expansion of annual
production capacity to
300,0000 Litres.
Establishment of
Centre
Annual production
capacity to 150,000
Litres
Completion of center
establishment by the end
of fourth year
Production of 1,000,000
litre milk per annum.
Completion of the
project in the fifth year
Production of 1,000,000
litre milk per annum
Establishment of 5
Centres
Cheese Shelters as
required
Cheese Production 50
Metric Tons per annum
11,75
25
400
7,800
1,23,00
700
3,400
Contining
1. Establishment of 2
Centres
a. Extension of Fish
Farming & Distribution
of fingerlings on
continuation
b. Survey of artificial
impondation in Eastern
Terai
c. Preparation of study
reports of Trisuli and
Tadikhola
d. Economical and
biologica study of
Narayani & Bhotekosi
e. Study of Fingerlings
production and artificial
breeding of Ashala and
Mahaser
Continuing
Continuing
1. Production of fingerlings
(in number)
2. Table Fish production
3. Production of fingerlings
of Grasscarp and
Silvercarp (in number)
4. Testing and artificial
breeding of Ashala.
1. Production of Fingerlings
(in No.)
2. Table Fish production
3. Extension Villages
4. Artificial carp and Grass
carp
5. Collection of local fish,
artificial impondation
survey and data
collection
1. Production of fingerlings
(in No.)
2. Trail Fishing (Kg.)
3. Extension Villages
4. Boat making (in No.)
5. Organising of Public
Cooperative Society to
each fish farming
6. Table Fish Production
(Kg.)
Continuing
10,200
15,00
5,00,000
2,770 Kg.
140,000
5,00
9,60,000
3,700 Kg.
200
90,000
6,00
3,80,000
28,000
120
17
37,000
(a) Tarahara
(b) Parwanipur
(c) Bhairahwa
(d) Nepalgunj
(e) Rajbiraj
Continuing
Proposed
1. Production of fingerlings
(in No.)
2. Table Fish Production
Kg.
3. Extension Villages
4. Breeding of fingerlings
of Silvercarp and
Grasscarp
5. Local Fish and
impondation survey
1. Production of fingerlings
(in No.)
2. Table Fish Production
Kg.
3. Extension Villages
4. Breeding of fingerlings
of Silver carp and Grass
carp
5. Survey and collection of
local fish
6. Construction of
additional ponds
1. Production of fingerlings
(in No.)
2. Production of Table Fish
Kg.
3. Extension Villages
4. Grass carp & Silver carp
breeding (No.)
5. Local fish collection and
impondation survey
6. Construction of pond
1. Completion of Survey
and Construction
2. Production of fingerlings
(in No.)
3. Production of Table Fish
Kg.
4. Extension Villages
1. Completion of Survey
and Construction
2. Production of fingerlings
(in No.)
3. Production of Table Fish
Kg.
4. Extension Villages
8,95,000
2,800
200
40,000
4,00
5,00
10,00,000
3,100
200
80,000
4,00
6,30,000
2,800
200
35,000
4,00
1,45,000
900
80
1,45,000
900
80
Continuing
Proposed
Proposed
Continuing
1. Completion of
Construction
2. Fingerlings Production
(in No.)
3. Grass & Silver carp
Breeding (No.)
4. Breeding test of Ashala
and Mahasher
1. Completion of
construction
2. Artificial breeding (in
No.)
3. Droppings of fingerlings
in rivers of northern side
& Trisuli and study of
their growth (in No.)
1. Completion of
construction by the end
of second year (Hec.)
2. Fingerlings production
(in No.)
3. Table Fish Production
Kg.
1. Completion of
construction in Third
Year (Hec.
2. Fingerlings Production
(in No.)
3. Table Fish production
Kg.
1. Fingerlings Production
(in No.)
2. Table Fish production
Kg.
3. Grass carp and Silver
carp breeding (in No.)
4. Extension Villages
1. Fingerlings production
(in no.)
2. Table Fish Production
Kg.
3. Grass carp and Silver
carp Breeding (in No.)
4,00
18,50,000
4,20,000
500
2,25,000
1,25,000
54.42
7,75,000
60,000
54.42
4,00,000
15,000
21,50,000
1,70,000
2,95,000
40
20,00,000
1,45,000
1,60,000
20,00
10,00
10,00
HORTICULTURAL DEVELOPMENT
1,29,00
(Rs. in Thousand)
Name of the Project
Situation
Number of
fruit rootstocks in 000
3
Number of
fruit plants
in 000
4
Vegetable
seeds in kg.
Potatoes
Metric Ton
Expenditure
1.
Horticulture Research Centre, Kirtipur
2.
Dhankuta
3.
Pokhara
4.
Daman
5.
Helambu
6.
Satbajha Baitadi
7.
Janakpur
8.
Dhunibesi
(Dhading)
9.
Thakmarpha
10.
Trisuli
11.
Jumla
12.
Tarahara
(Sunsari)
13.
Parwanipur
14.
Bharatpur
15.
Humla
16.
Palpa
17.
Mustang
18.
Rasuwa
19.
Plant introducing Singha Durbar Godawari
20.
Fruit Centre Kalanki
21.
Potato Development Project Ilam
22.
Kirtipur
23.
Daman
24.
Fruit Preservation Centre, Kirtipur
25.
Large Scale Horticulture Development
Programme:
(a) Prithvi Rajmarg
(b)
Arniko Rajmarg
(c)
Simra-Janakpur (Mahendra Rajmarg
Continuing
Proposed
Continuing
Proposed
continuing
Proposed
425
380
125
300
125
100
43
50
25
15
190
130
200
90
25
12
28
28
380
220
70
Prod of
30,000 kg.
Preserved fruit
40 Hectares
120
220
220
100
200
37
62
19
50
15
75
95
180
125
300
12
12
12
135
125
23
-
24000
12500
5000
2000
250
2000
17000
500
15000
500
700
3000
1500
50000
275
2500
Establishment
of
Horticultural
Farms
Seed
Production
Vegetable
Nucleus 40
Hectares land
50
20
25
5
10
5
18
10
100
10
10
10
37
720
150
375
-
829
500
400
250
250
250
220
225
250
225
250
439
272
500
250
225
225
500
300
1640
300
400
225
35,00
2,50
5,49,00
Continuing
1. Testing of different
(Bagmati, Narayani,
vertical crops
93
2. Collection of varied crops and
primary analysis of qualities
(number)
4,900
3. Collection of varied
crops
1,910
4. Testing of collected varieties
3,800
5. Main seed production (Kg.)
19,700
6. Breeding seed production (Kg.)
1,200
1. To increase seed sample analysis
capacity up to
23,000
2. Crop inspection in 27,000
hectors field
3. 14,500MT. Seed certification
4. Study of 15 varieties of seed
1. Collection, classification &
analysis of 750 varieties of paddy
and 500 varieties of grass
2. Survey and analysis of seeds
suitable to 60 varieties of
leguminous crop and green-manure
1. Survey and collection of 350
varieties
2. Primary analysis on quality of
275 varieties
1. Arrangement of certification of
seed production
2. Formulation of policy and rules
on certificationof the seeds
Number of Trained Personnel
1. I. Sc.
225
2. B. Sc.
25
3. Field Training
500
4. Upgrading Training 340
5. J. T. A.
700
1. Introductory Study, Number
of crops
120
2. Testing
285
3. Improved seed Production
(M.T.)
10,07
4. Cash Crop Development
(M.T.)
13,58
5. Experimentation of crop
varieties
85
6. Crop rotation study
5
7. Green Manure Study
7
8.Agri-Education & Training 15
9. Agri-service
10
30,00
68,00
35,00
68,00
35,00
72,00
4. Agronomy Science
Agri-farms
(a) Khumaltar
(b) Janakpur
(c) Nepalgunj
(d) Doti
5.
Agriculture Engineering
(a) Agri-Engineering construction
project, Kathmandu
(b) Agriculture Implements & Tools
(Research & Repair) Project,
Kathmandu, Birgunj
(c) Farm Development & Irrigation
Research Project, Agri-Farms and
Research Centres
6. Entomology Research
(a) Khumaltar, Biratnagar & Parwanipur
only
(b). Plant Quarantine Kathmandu,
Birgunj, Bhairahwa & Nepalgunj
7. Plant Pathology Section
(a) Central Laboratory Kathmandu
(b) Plant Protection Centre and
Laboratory
8.
Soil Science Section
(a)
Soil Science Central
Laboratory
(b) Field Soil Fertility Section &
laboratory (Parwanipur, Tarahara,
Bhairahwa, Rampur, Jiri, Janakpur,
Nepalgunj & Doti)
(c) Soil Fertility Research and promotion
of Fertilizer use
(d) Agriculture Centre: Parwanipur,
Rampur, Biratnagar and Jute Farm
Bhairahwa
Continuing
Continuing
Proposed
Continuing
Continuing
Proposed
Continuing
1. Introductory Study
Number of crops
120
2. Testing
3. Improved seed Production
(M.T.)
4. Cash Crop Development
(M.T.)
5. Experimentation of crop
varieties
6. Crop rotation study
7. Green Manure Study
8. Agri-Education & Training
9. Agri-Services
10.
Jute Farm (M.T.)
11.
Hilly Agri-Farm
(M.T.)
12.
Extension of Jute
Farm & Hilly Agri-Farm
1. Design estimate of the agriengineering construction
2. Pucca graineries design
3. Other graineries design
1. Repair of Transportation means
2. Repair of Tractors and others
3. Formulation of irrigational
structure and Research
4. Specimen of Graineries
5. Training on Tools
6. Demonstration of Tools
7. Specimen of driers
8. Specimen of Tools
1. Study of irrigation for Wheat,
Maize and Sugarcane Crops
2. Agri-Training
3. J.T.A. Surveyor Training
4. Farm Tubwell
5. Farm Channel Design
1. Research Survey hectare 20,000
2. Collection & Experimentation
(Insects) 20,000
3. Preservation (Insects) 500
4. Chemical Test of Silkworm &
beekeeping
5. Plant Protection Units 5
1. Completion of Legalization
2. Establishment of plant
quarantine laboratory in
Kathmandu
3. Establishment of 5 check-posts
1. Survey of diseases in hectare
1,00,000
2. Disease Collection (Number)
5,000
3. Disease Control Study 97
4. Disease Experimental Study
500
5. Disease Study Seeds 1,000
6. Publication 20
7. Demonstration 60
8. Training 1,000
9. Advice on diseases 1,000
1. Establishment of new centres
72,00
4,000
22,00
10,00
22,00
22,00
8,00
1,55,00
65,00
(D)
Agriculture Extension
1. Agricultural Extension Programme
2. Rural Agriculture
Youth Programme
3. Agri-Information Section
4. Gandaki Agriculture Development
Project
continuing
Programmes
No.
Method Demonstration 45,000
Result
2,13,000
Leader Farmers Training 21,500
Trained Leader Farmers 2,25,000
Seasonal Training for J.T.s &
J.T.A.
2,000
Farmers Day 149
Farmers to participate the Farmers
Day
14,900
Agricultural fair & exhibition 125
Grow more food competition 168
District competition 504
National 5
Estimated number of Farmers
participating the competition
5,600
Panchayat 511
Club 771,17,00
Trained Member 11,563
Adult Guide 771
4-H leaders Training 2200
Result Demonstration 9,153
Individual project to be
implemented by trained
members
26.908
Team Training for method
demonstration 3084
Judging Team Training 3084
Community services 7175
District 4-H Festival day 110
Zonal 4-H Festival day 13
National 4-H Festival day 5
Grow more vegetable campaign 25
Booklet Publication 570 type
Poster
200
Radio programme
1,248 times
Movie Demonstration 570
Agri-Information
8700 sheets
Agri-Demonstration 34 times
Movie Preparation
12
3,82,00
30,000
15,00
50,00
(E)
Food Research
1.(a) Babarmahal , Kathmandu
(b). Food Technological Plant WorkShop Kathmandu
2.
Food Testing Laboratory, Jhapa
3. Survey and Research on food protein
(F)
Continuing
Proposed
Proposed
in 1250 hectares
450 families
in 1250 hectares
450 families
in 2500 hectares
900 families
in 1250 hectares
450 families
29,00
2,60,00
Resettlement:
Departmental Programme
1. Zonal Resettlement (Morong &
Sunsari)
2. Zonal Resettlement
Narayani
3. Zonal Resettlement
Lumbini
4. Zonal Resettlement
Janakpur
5. Reclaimation
Companys Programme
Resettlement in Kanchanpur,
Kailali, Banke, Bardia & Jhapa
6,70
6,75
6,80
6,75
2,00
1.Families to be settled 6000
2.Land to be distributed 20408
hectares
30,00
10,00
5,00
20,00
CHAPTER VI
Agricultural Credit, Inputs and Marketing
It is evident that the achievement of the agricultural development programme targets depend
primarily upon the efficiency of hundreds of thousands of farmers. In order to enable the farmers
to increase production and to adequately use modern agricultural inputs, it is urgently necessary
to provide credit on easy terms. At present, cooperative societies, Agricultural Development
Bank, Savings Corporation and Ward Committees are supplying agricultural credit. There is,
however, a lack of scientific organization, an inefficient administration with minimum direction
and control and a lack of clearly defined fields of activity and responsibility. This has, in turn,
created obstacles in the provision of credit to farmers. Based upon actual experience gained so far
the following arrangements will be made for the supply of credit, inputs, and marketing facilities
in those districts where intensive agricultural development programme will be implemented
during the Fourth Plan period:
1. Instead of establishing new organizations to supply institutional agricultural credit for inputs at
the village level, the existing institutions will be strengthened, i.e., Cooperatives, the Agricultural
Development Bank, the Land Reform Savings Corporation, and the Agriculture Supply
Corporation and Ward Committees.
2. Village Committees will be entrusted with the collection of Compulsory Savings
at the village level, the provision of individual agricultural credit, the sale of
improved seeds, chemical fertilizers and other inputs in all 28 districts where the
Intensive Agriculture Development Programme will be implemented. All records
of the financial transactions and marketing operations of Village Committees will
be kept by the secretaries of the concerned Village Panchayats. The Land Reform
Savings Corporation will depute 344 credit inspectors and establish 14 regional
offices in order to supervise and guide the Village Committees. When these
Villages Committees are efficient enough to run on their own the Committees will
be converted into Village Multipurpose Cooperative Societies, and the
compulsory savings, subject to the approval of deposits, will be transformed into
the share capital of the society. Thus when the committees are converted into
Multipurpose Cooperative Societies, the Cooperatives will be reorganized at the
inter-village level in the following way. In the interim period, Village Committees
with function only as agents of the Inter-Village Cooperative Organization and
will sell agricultural inputs to the farmers of the village on the basis of a
prescribed commission. The Land Reform Savings Corporation will provide
general agricultural production loans through village committees on commission
as at present. His Majestys Government will provide grants to the Land Reform
Savings Corporation for the administrative expenses of Credit Inspectors who will
be supervising Village Committees.
3. The Department of Cooperatives will establish up to 10 inter-village cooperative
organizations after reorganizing in stages the existing cooperatives in the 28
intensive districts. The Cooperative Institutions, thus resources-organized, will
receive guidance and administrative support from the Agricultural Development
Bank. During the plan period, the Department will set up offices in those districts
with cooperative institutions and will provide facilities for supervision and audit.
Trained persons will be posted by the Agricultural Development Bank in such
institutions to work as managers of the cooperative organizations, His Majestys
the existing cooperatives lack sufficient funds, members, knowledge, and efficiency
of management. Hence, it was natural that these fast growing cooperatives would not
have the anticipated qualitative development. Out of the 1,300 existing cooperative
societies, about two third of the 1,100 concerned with agriculture are ineffective and
are in the process of liquidation. Of the rest, some need promotional measures,
whereas, others need to be amalgamated. Therefore, it is envisaged in the Fourth Plan
to resources-organize the existing societies, and to concentrate on quality rather then
quantity
Programme in the Fourth Plan
In view of the lack of technical personnel, resources, and managerial skill at the
Village level, it is impracticable to establish cooperative societies simultaneously
throughout the country. It is, therefore, envisaged in the Fourth Plan to establish up to
10 well-organized societies after reorganizing and amalgamating the existing
cooperatives in each of the 28 intensive districts. Since each society thus established
will cover more then one village, they will be called inter-village cooperative
societies. As stated above, the management of these societies will be supervised for
the required period of time. These societies will concentrate their activities primarily
on the provision of credit to the member farmers, the supply of agricultural inputs
through village committees, and the marketing of agricultural products in an
organized way so that the farmers can get proper remuneration for their labour. When
the village committees are converted into village multipurpose cooperative societies,
they will then become members of the inter-village cooperative organization. When
cooperatives at the village level are functioning smoothly and effectively, inter-village
cooperatives will be amalgamated, and then only one organization will be constituted
at the district level.
In the first year of the Fourth Plan, at least two inter-village cooperative
organizations will be established by the amalgamation or resources-organization of
the existing societies in the 28 intensive districts. Cooperative societies thus
resources-organized will be established in each district as required by the end of the
Plan period.
Although cooperatives have been introduced in 56 districts of the country, the
Fourth Plan gives priority to the 28 districts, where the Intensive Agricultural
Development Programme will be implemented. They will be strengthened by
providing trained personnel, such as cooperative inspectors, accountants, and others.
In the Central Office, the audit section will be made more effective and efficient. In
addition, a separate section to deal with agricultural production is not marketed in
accordance with cooperative principles and the farmers are not guaranteed fair prices,
agricultural production is likely to be adversely affected.
Theoretical and practical training of 3 to 6 months duration and a short-term inservice training programme will be continued by the Cooperative Training Centre for
departmental personnel and managers of cooperative societies. Moreover, mobile
training teams for the districts will provide short-term practical training to the
members and staff of the cooperative organizations.
B. Agriculture Supply Corporation
Among the inputs required to achieve the targets of the Fourth Plan, chemical
fertilizers, improved seeds, pesticides, and improved implements will be supplied
mainly by the Agriculture Supply Corporation. The amount of different inputs to be
sold during the Plan period by the Corporation is given in the following Table:
TABLE 46
CHEMICAL FERTILIZERS TO BE SOLD DURING THE FOURTH PLAN
PERIOD
Fertilizer
Nitrogen
Phosphorous
Potash
1970-71
5,930
2,360
390
1971-72
9,000
4,500
1,200
1972-73
11,000
5,500
1,600
1973-74
13,000
6,500
2,200
1974-75
15,000
7,000
3,000
TABLE 47
SALES OF IMPROVED SEEDS DURING THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
Seed
Maize
Wheat
Paddy
1970-71
136
546
400
1971-72
204
780
600
1972-73
306
1,092
800
1973-74
408
1,326
1,100
1974-75
510
1,510
1,400
TABLE 48
DURING THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
SALES TARGET OF AGRI-TOLLS AND PLANT PROTECTION MATERIALS
(Rs. in THOUSAND)
Agri-Tools
Pesticides
1970-71
775
375
1971-72
1,100
525
1972-73
1,425
780
1973-74
1,750
1,000
1974-75
2,225
1,250
Total
7275
3930
At present, the Agriculture Supply Corporation has its central office at Kathmandu
with six branches in Kathmandu, Birgunj, Janakpur, Biratnagar, Bhairahwa and
Nepalgunj; nine depots in Chituwan, Rautahat, Sarlahi, Saptari, Sirha, Jhapa,
Taulihawa, phokara and Bardia and four seasonal supply centers in Parasi, Dang,
Kailali and Palpa. During the Fourth Plan period, saled depts. Will be established in
all 28 districts where the Intensive Agricultural Development programme will be
implemented. These depots will provide the necessary agricultural inputs and supply
the chemical fertilizers, improved seeds, polythene bags, to the iner-village
cooperative organizations and village committees.
Warehouses
Warehouses are under construction in Kathmandu and Birgunj to cope with the
increasing volume of trade. During the Third Plan period, with the completion of
warehouses for fertilizers and seeds, the corporation will have warehouses with a
capacity of 2,500 M.T. 2,000 M.T. and 1,000 M.T. respectively at Birgunj,
Kathmandu and Bhairahawa. During the Fourth Plan Period warhouses will be
constructed as need in the 28 districts where the Intensive Agricultural Development
Programme will be implemented. The expenditure required to implement the above
mentioned programmes is given in the following Table:
Table 49
EXPENDITURE REQUIRED FOR AGRICULTURAL INPUTS
DURING THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
(Rs. in 000)
Implements
Chemical Fertilizers (NPK)
Seeds
Plant Protection Materials
Agricultural Tools
1970-71
15,000
1,520
375
775
1971-72
25,000
2.150
525
1,100
1972-73
31,500
3,040
780
1,425
1973-74
37,200
4,050
1,000
1,750
1974-75
43,000
4,920
1,250
2,225
Total
151,70
0
15,680
3,930
7,275
TABLE 50
EXPENDITURE REQUIRED FOR WAREHOUSE CONSTRUCTION
DURING THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
(Rs. in 000)
1970-71
1,000
1971-72
1,500
1972-73
2,500
1973-74
1,800
1974-75
1,200
Total
8,000
TABLE 51
ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENDITURE
DURING THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
(Rs. in 000)
Administration
1970-71
1,500
1971-72
2,100
1972-73
2,500
1973-74
3,000
1974-75
3,600
Total
12,70
0
TABLE 52
FINANCIAL REQUIREMENT OF THE CORPORATION
DURING THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
(Rs. in 000)
Heads
Inputs
Construction (Storage)
Administrative Budget
Total
1970-71
17,670
1,000
1,500
1971-72
28,775
1,500
2,100
1972-73
36,745
2,500
2,500
1973-74
44,000
1,800
3,000
1974-75
51,395
1,200
3,600
20,170
32,375
41,745
48,800
56,195
Total
178,58
5
8,000
12,700
199,28
5
TABLE 53
ESTIMATED REQUIREMENTS OF FOREIGN EXCHANGE
DURING THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
Year
US Dollar in 000
1970-71
1,580
1971-72
2,500
1972-73
3,150
1973-74
3,720
1974-75
4,300
Total
15,250
Bank, Agriculture Development Bank, Land Reform Savings Corporation and other
financial institutions. From the very beginning, the Corporation will construct
warehouses from available resources at appropriate places in the country for its own
use and the use of farmers.
Agricultural Credit
In order to achieve the targets of the Fourth Plan, agricultural credit of 220 million
rupees over that which is mobilized in the private sector will be needed for the
provision of various inputs, such as chemical fertilizers, improved seeds, plants and
seeds and other inputs for horticulture development, chicken, fingerlings and
improved livestock for poultry, fisheries and livestock development. The Agricultural
Development Bank and the Land Reform Savings Corporation are the main sources of
agricultural credit and can provide credit worth 475.1 million rupees during the Plan
period. Therefore, long-term credit worth Rs. 250 million can be made available to
augment capital expenditure on implements, storage and minor irrigation projects for
agricultural development in the private sector. Short term agricultural credit will be
provided to the farmers in the intensive districts by the Land Reform Savings
Corporation through the district offices and ward committees. Similarly, the
Agricultural Development Bank will provide small loans to member farmers through
cooperative Organizations and large scale credit for specific purposes directly through
its district offices.
The details of agricultural credit supplied during the Third Plan period by the
Agricultural Development Bank and the Land Reform Savings Corporation are given
in the following Table:
TABLE 54
LOAN TRANSACTIONS
(Rs. in 000)
1966-67
1967-68
1968-69
1969-70
3,588
3,430
4,762
13,428
8,058
8,047
3,528
9,195
5,357
5,719
5,865*
1,776*
13,370*
13,826**
4,628**
14,107
13,745
16,824*
3,990
2,041
4,604
8,337
-
Repayments
8,737
Investments
*
Land Reform Savings Corporation
Loans
Repayments
Investments
The above Table shows that the Agricultural Development Bank has, on average,
supplied annually more then Rs. 5.8 million of credit for various purposes. The Land Reform
Savings Corporation has supplied about 10.0 million rupees.
During the Fourth Plan period, more then Rs. 470 million of credit will be provided by
the Agriculture Development Bank and the Land Reform Savings Corporation. Annual details are
given below:
TABLE 55
PROVISION OF CREDIT IN THE FOURTH PLAN
(Rs. in 10 million)
Agricultural Development
Bank
Land Reform Savings
Corporation
Total
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Total
1.25
3.44
2.00
4.64
3.00
5.82
4.50
7.31
6.50
9.05
17.25
30.26
4.69
6.64
8.82
11.81
15.55
47.50
It is estimated that the Land Reform Savings corporation will meet its requirements for
credit from the sources given in the following Table:
TABLE 56
ESTIMATE OF FINANCIAL RESOURCES
(Rs. in 000)
Source
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Total
Savings
Loan repayment from
institution investments
Private Loan repayment
Interested to be paid to His
Majesty's Government
From Financial Institutions
Total
27,726
6,519
93
100*
31,059
2,500
7,000
5,847
29,255
6,135
3,000
19,808
34,670
11,435
3,000
15,331
55,078
17,075
3,000
15,331
27,726
156,58
2
37,238
16,000
65,056
34,438
46,406
58,198
73,075
90,484
302,60
2
TABLE 57
SOURCE OF FINANCE IN THE FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
(Rs. in 000)
Source
1. Share Capital
(a) His Majesty's Government
(b) Individuals and Institutions
2. Deposits
3. Loan from Financial Institutions
4. Loan Repayment
Total
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Total
2,570
700
8,064
1,666
13,000
2,500
3,100
1,000
6,167
7,733
20,500
2,500
150
1,250
15,066
11,534
30,500
5,000
250
1,800
20,219
18,731
46,000
325
2,500
34,064
29,111
66,000
10,000
6,395
7,250
83,580
68,775
176,00
0
In order to achieve the approved agricultural targets of the Fourth Plan, the Agricultural
Development Bank and the Land Reform Savings Corporation will provide credit on the basis of
the annual programme through the concerned organizations or committees, as required for cereal
crops, cash crops, horticulture, livestock and poultry and fisheries development. His Majesty's
Government will provide grants amounting to 10 million rupees for the personnel expensed to
the Agricultural Development Bank in order to operate the inter-village cooperative organizations
and to the Land Reform Savings Corporation in order to supervise the Village Committees.
The estimated outlay required for implementing the above mentioned programme regarding
agricultural credit, inputs and marketing during the Fourth Plan period, is as follows:-
1.
Programmes
Cooperatives
(a) Cooperative Training Centres
2140
(b) District Cooperative Offcies
1860
2. Agriculture Supply Corporation (Grants)
(a) Warehouse Constructrion
8000
(b) Administrative expenses
6300
3. Marketing and Warehousing Corporation
(Share Capital)
4. Agriculture Credit
200,00
(a)
Agricultural Development Bank (Share
Capital)
10000
(b)
Agricultural Development Bank and Land
Reform Savings Corporation (grants) 10000
Total
143,00
78,00
200,00
4,61,00
CHAPTER VII
IRRIGATION
The water resources of the country are adequate for the development of irrigation
facilities. The three major river systems are Kosi, Narayani and Karnali. Before crossing the
border they drain a total area of 141,190 sq. Kilometres or 83 per cent of the total catchments
area of all the river systems of the country. These three rivers have their head waters in the main
Himalayan range, and are perennial due to glacial origin. The minimum discharge of each river is
214 cubic meter per second, even during dry winter season. Besides the watersheds of these river
system there are seven big rivers draining catchments between 1280 sq. k.m. and 6400 sq. k.m.
These rivers are, from west to east- Sharada, Babai, Rapti, Bagmati, Kamala, Kankai and Mechi.
These rivers are also perennial since the source of these rivers is either in the Himalayan or
Hahabharat ranges. In addition, there are several small streams which have their origin in the
Chure hill. Among these small streams are the Banganga, Tinau, Balan and Trijuga. They have
catchment areas varying from 256 sq. k.m., to 768 sq. k.m.
Progress in Irrigation Development
Prior to the First Five Year Plan, only 14,700 hectares of land are recorded to have had
irrigation facilities provided by the government. Irrigation facilities for an additional 17,200
hectares were provided during the First Plan Period. During the Second Plan Period, 26,500
hectares of land were brought under irrigation. Thus before the beginning of the Third Plan total
irrigation facilities provided by the government covered an area of 58,400 hectares of land.
The revised target of the Third Five Year Plan was to provide irrigation facilities for
148,000 hectares of land. During the four years of the Plan period, in other words by the end of
1968-69, irrigation facilities have been provided to 59,090 hectares of land by the completion of
the following projects:
1. Khageri Irrigation Project
2. Tokha
3. Sange
4. Sisaghat
5. Dedguan
6. Minor
Objectives, Policies and Priorities of Irrigation
Development in the Fourth Plan
Objectives
The irrigation programme in the Fourth Plan is formulated to reach the following
objectives:
(a) To provide irrigation facilities as required for the agricultural development
projects;
(b) To gradually reduce dependence on uncertain monsoon and thereby increase
agricultural production by creating opportunities for growing more than one
crop
Policy and Priority
In accordance with the above objectives the following policies and priorities are adopted
for the Plan period:
1. During the past few years special attention was given to the development of
minor irrigation projects. Therefore, medium and major irrigation projects
were not given proper attention. Since a considerable part of the irrigation
facilities provided so far have been minor projects, it is evident that such
projects are not suitable for meeting long-term irrigation requirements. Since
construction of major irrigation projectors depends upon external aid, the
timely development of irrigation potential
2. There are some projects which have been started but not completed during the
Third Plan, but will be completed in the Fourth Plan. Two of these projects are
the Gandak and Chatra canals which are being constructed directly by the
Indian Government and will be completed and made available during the Plan
period.
3. In order to utilize ground water, tube-well projects also will be implemented
as required. Feasible minor irrigation projects will also be implemented during
this Plan period.
4. Along with the constructions of continuing and newly proposed projects,
feasibility studies of various projects will be undertaken in order to prepare
future plans. At the same time, renovation and extension of old projects will
be continued. River control and reclamation projects will also be implemented
to prevent losses during the rainy season.
5. Since there is no water management code for effective use and protection of
water resources available in the country, necessary steps will be taken in the
Fourth Plan period to institute an appropriate water management programme
designed to ensure the efficient construction, maintenance and operation of
irrigation dams, canals and distributories. Permanent arrangement will be
made with necessary coordination between the Departments of Agriculture
and Irrigation.
6. Although all activities concerning irrigation were being carried out by one
department until very recently, two separate departments-Minor Irrigation
Department and Irrigation Department have been established. This has greatly
increased administrative expenses, added to the problem of coordination, and
caused confusion in deciding the function of each department. It is
appropriate, therefore, to resources-unite these departments as before, in order
to implement the irrigation programme more effectively.
Irrigation Development Programme in the Fourth Plan
The irrigation programme in the Fourth Plan has been determined in accordance with the
priority of irrigation policy and the targets of agricultural production. Accordingly, irrigation
facilities will be provided to 183,632 hectares of land during the Plan period. Detailed
programmes are given below:
(a) Major Irrigation Programme
Since all projects cannot be completed within the Plan period, only 146,700 hectares
of land will be provided with irrigation facilities by the end of the Plan.
report of the project has been completed and its total cost is estimated to be
Rs. 2,97,50,000. the construction work of this project is expected to be
completed in the last year of the plan. By the completion of this project and
the Khageri Project (already completed), a large percentage of the cultivable
land of Rapti Valley will be irrigated.
4. Bagmati Irrigation Project
Bagmati is one of the main medium-sized rivers in Central Nepal. This river is
perennial, providing an assured supply of water which is essential for
dependable farming. A barrage will be constructed near Mangalpur, near the
place where the Bagmati river flows into the Terai plain and passes through
the Mahabharat and Chure ranges. The project aims to utilize 34.7 cubic metre
water per second on each bank or a total of 69.4 cubic metre per second of
water. The total cost of this project is estimated to be Rs. 15,00,000,000. the
project feasibility report has been completed. The project will be started in the
last year of the Plan and 25 per cent of the construction work will be
completed in the same year.
5. Patharaiya Irrigation Project
The purpose of this project is to provide irrigation water by constructing a
weir in Patharaiya river at a site 72 k.m. north-east of Dhangarhi,. The Canal
on the right side will irrigate 2,000 hectares of land. The estimated cost of the
project is Rs. 30,00,000. The construction work of this project has been in
Babai is one of the main rivers in Bheri Zone. According to the preliminary
survey, it is estimated that the project can irrigate 9,100 hectares of land in
Banke and Bardia districts. During the Plan period, a feasibility study of this
project will be completed, and the final report will be prepared.
(c) Kankai Irrigation Project
Kankai is the main river in Mechi Zone. According to the preliminary report, it
is estimated that this river can be harnessed to irrigate 40,500 hectares on the
west bank and 32,000 hectares on the east. A feasibility study will be
completed, and a detailed report will be prepared during the Plan period.
projects were carried out by the Government for drinking water in Kathmandu
valley and in some parts of the Terai. Subsequently, 29 tube-wells were installed
for irrigation in 1967-68 and 1968-69. it is noteworthy that even in the absence
of necessary data from surveys and investigations of ground water resources, the
above mentioned tube-wells are functioning satisfactorily. Tube-well projects
will be more successful when the results of ground water resources
investigations to be conducted by the Department of Hydrology are made
available.
Tube-well irrigation projects have some special benefits of their own, and
such projects are gaining in popularity. Therefore, it has become necessary from economic and
practical stand-points to utilize ground water as well as surface water for irrigation.
According to the programme, 250 tube-wells will be installed in
Sagarmatha, Janakpur, Narayani and Lumbini zones. Assuming that a one tube-well will irrigate
60 hectares of land on average, approximately 15,000 hectares of land will be brought under
tube-well irrigation.
Minor Irrigation Project
Since a detailed survey of all projects to be implemented during the Fourth
Plan period has not been completed and no cost estimates for such projects have been made, it is
envisaged to implement 182 projects throughout the 14 zones on the basis of toposheets and
preliminary surveys. This should add 21,932 hectares of land to be under irrigation. The annual
17,39,00
3,50,00
5,00,00
Total:
25,89,00
TABLE 58
IRRIGATION PROJECTS
Outlay (Rs. in 000) Irrigation (in
Hectares)
Outlay
Projects:
on
Project
Location
Total
Cost
Outlay
Total
Area to be
during
area
irrigated
the Plan
during the
period
Plan period
New Projects
1. Sharadha
Kanchanpur
18,000
18,000
25,000
25,000
2. Lohattar
Chitwan
29,750
29,750
12,000
12,000
3. Bagmati
Rautahat,
1,50,00
37,500
81,000
14,000
8,000
8,000
35,000
15,000
15,000
50,000
21,932
21,932
33,000
28,000
2,000
2,000
2,000
3,000
3,000
3,000
2,000
2,000
2,000
600
250
250
6,500
56,500
56,500
28,200
28,200
9,750
9,750
7,550
10,000
10,000
Sarlahi
4. Banganga
&
Bara
0
14,000
5. Tube-well
Kapilvastu
35,000
6. Minor Irrigation
Sagarmatha,
Continuing Projects
50,000
Janakpur,
55,000
1.
Kamala
2.
Pathraiya
Lumbini
3.
Rapti
14 zones
4.
Chapakot
Dhanusha &
&
3,000
4,000
Chaurj
ahari
Chatra
3,000
700
Sirha
5.
6.
Narayani
Kailali
7,000
Banke
Syangja
Rukum
7,550
(Field)
7.
Gandak
Morang
&
10,000
(East)
Sunsasri
8.
Gandak
Bara,
Prasa
(West)
& Rautahat
Miscellaneous
Nawalparasi
10,000
Total:
3,97,00
0
2,58,900
2,92,632
1,83,632
CHAPTER VIII
SURVEY, LAND REFORM AND LAND ADMINISTRATION
The land reform programme must be effectively carried out in order to create
the proper atmosphere of planned development and to establish a society free from exploitation,
based upon class coordination as envisaged by the Panchayat System. In the present situation,
economic development cannot be generated without substantially changing agriculture, and
thereby raising the living standard of the tenants no basic change in agriculture can be attained
unless the tenants share equitably in agricultural output. In fact, the objective of creating the
necessary conditions for attaining a society free from exploitation may remain unfulfilled unless
traditional exploitation based on land is eliminated. Also, it is necessary to transfer inactive
capital and under-employed labour from agriculture to industry or some other more productive
sector of the economy. It is for these reasons that the current land reform programme will be
implemented as a priority programme.
Unless the land reform programme is effectively and properly executed, other
agricultural development programmes will not be effective. Therefore, the land reform
programme will be emphasized by accelerating the work of survey and land administration.
The revenue survey is imperative in the establishment of some permanency in
the land system and in the preparation of a register showing land-owners, tenants, and the kind of
land. This information helps in the distribution of the permanent tenancy right certificates and
land above ceiling. Considering these facts, the objectives and policies of the Fourth Plan are
formulated to keep in view the capacity and the desired changes in the directors of survey, land
reform, and land administration.
Progress of the Third Plan
Revenue survey work in 7,82,992 hectares of land was completed during the
first four years of the Plan period, compared to the target of 10,73,418 hectares. Similarly,
maintenance survey branches were set up in 16 districts instead of the targeted 22. Simplification
in administration and uniformity in land management are indispensable for the attainment of the
objectives of the land reform programme. Land (Administration) Offices in 13 districts were
opened during the first four years of the Plan period as part of the programme to set up Lands
Department in the center and Land (Administration) Offices in the districts.
The following Table shows clearly the achievements made in the land reform
programme:
Table 59
ACHIVEMENTS OF THE LAND REFORM PROGRAMME
Third Plan
Progress up
Subjects
Unit
Target
to four years
No.
8,89,928
11,63,005
16,66,338
18,27,605
3.
certificates
17,89,050
14,46,496
58,022
1,02,417
13,55,360
16,24,850
2,01,143
25,000
25,000
8. Collection of savings
Rs.
30,13,31,691
9,82,05,956
9. Determination of loan
Rs.
8,95,09,000
5,07,45,472
61,913
16,685
4.
Moneylenders
5.
Tenants
23,136
the farmers are going to become owner-tillers and the original proprietors are
investing their money (that they got from land sold) in particular industrial projects.
Such institutional credit will be provided only on the condition that real tenants will
be the owner-tillers and that the land for sale will be used as security against loans
advanced to the tillers whose liability to the lending corporation will be redeemed as
they repay the loan in prescribed installments.
1. Survey Programme
a. Cadastral Survey
Revenue surveys help to levy a uniform land tax. They also pave the way for
the appropriation and redistribution of land about the allowed ceiling to the
landless tenants and the distribution of permanent tenancy certificates.
New equipment, such as orthophoto, telescopic alidade, stadia rod, etc., will
be introduced to make the revenue surveys less expensive and faster during the
Plan period. The staff of the survey party team will be trained to use this new
equipment.
Revenue surveys will be completed in an additional 26 districts or
approximately 3,37,955 hectares of land, and will be started in 4 more districts
during the Plan period. A detailed programme is shown below:
Table 60
DISTRICTS WHERE REVENUE SURVEY WILL BE COMPLETED
F.Y. 1970-71
F.Y. 1971-72
F.Y. 1974-75
73
Dang,
Makwanpur,
Palpa & Ilam
Kapilvastu,
Rupendehi,
Morang
Saptari
&
Arghakhac
Dhankuta,
Ramechhap,
hi,
Dailekh,
Rolpa,
Panchathar
Pyuthan,
Rukum,
Jajarkot,
Tanahu &
Tehrathum
,&
Gulmi,
Surkhet
& Sindhuli
Syangja
b. Trigonometrical Survey
The trigonometrical survey team will establish three trigonometrical points
in the areas where revenue surveys have been completed the trigonometrical points established
by the Survey of India will be systematized. Each Amin of the revenue survey party will have
three trigonometrical points. In the beginning period, arrangements will be made for the requisite
number of trigonometrical points for 7 survey team parties.
The scale of the map will be uniform for all areas where the survey work has been
completed. There will be no overlapping of one area above the other when there are common
borders.
2. To reproduce one inch map sheets of Nepal in the required quantity now being
published by the Survey of India and to keep the sheets up-to-date.
3. To draw and publish up-to-date small maps of Nepal, e.g. 1:250,000.
4. To survey and produce plans of sites for development projects.
5. To print, and possibly draw, maps of surveys by other departments (e.g. Geological
Survey, Soil Survey, Forest Resources Survey).
The training of staff (Junior and Operating) and construction of the building will
be completed during the first three years of the Plan period.
Drawing and reproduction of map sheets will begin in 1974-75 and continue from
that date.
e. Training
The importance of trained personnel can be hardly exaggerated if there is to be a
fast and efficient completion of the different survey programmes. The Survey Training Centre is
continuing its training programme for the staffs of the survey parties, as well as sending survey
personnel to foreign countries for training. The programme of the Survey Training Centre will be
expanded for training in different subjects in order to cope with the expanded activities in the
revenue, trigonometrical, maintenance, and topographical surveys.
2. Land Reform Programme
(a) Compulsory Savings Scheme:
In order to increase agriculture productions, an institutional credit system is
deemed to be a major pre-requisite. The main and foremost objective of this programme is to
accelerate the growth of the agricultural sector by transfering the inactive capital remaining in the
agriculture sector to the non-agricultural sector. In addition to this, protection of tenancy rights
and an end to unnecessary economic pressures on the peasants should be attempted. During the
Fourth Plan period, it has been estimated that the collection of compulsory savings will amount
to Rs. 60 million.
(b) Auditing and Proper Management of Savings:
The objective of land reform cannot be achieved only by collecting savings. It is
very necessary to utilize the savings in an effective manner. To overcome the misappropriation of
savings, it is very urgent to audit all the account records and to keep the records intact and in
order. During this Plan period, the target for regular auditing of savings has been fixed at 17,019
wards.
(c) Protection and Proper Management of Tenancy Rights:
It is very necessary to protect and secure tenancy rights, in order to increase
production by providing incentive to the real tenant who is supposed to till the land. The number
of temporary and permanent tenancy certificates issued up-to-date are 14,46,496 and 23,136
respectively. Unless the accurate boundaries of the land have been determined, tenancy rights
certificate cannot be issued. Until the revenue survey is completed, the tenants are protected by
issuing temporary certificates covering the lands they are tilling at present. Legal provisions have
been made in the Act for the protection of such tillers from eviction. During the Fourth Plan
period, permanent tenancy certificates will be issued after due enquiry and investigation on the
basis of the temporary certificates. These will be issued in panchayats of the districts where the
revenue survey has been completed. In addition to this, a programme for securing written
agreements between land-owners and tenants will be launched. This will minimize litigation
between the land owner and tenants, thereby restoring mutual cooperation between them.
(d) Fixation of Rent:
It is deemed compulsory to fix the amount of rent in order to provide a just share
of output to the tenant who works so hard, and thereby increase total production. This sort of
fixation of rent has been concentrated in the Kathmandu Valley at present. The tenant outside the
Valley has no incentive to increase production by hard labour since the rent is not fixed.
Therefore, during the Fourth Plan period, the rent will be fixed in those 26 districts where the
revenue survey is presumed to be completed.
(e)
agricultural production and to create an atmosphere in which investment of inactive capital may
be chanelled from the agriculture sector to the non-agricultural sector, the provision of land
ceilings has been made. Those lands which are above the ceiling will be distributed to the tenants
and landless peasants in order of priority. It has been difficult to distribute the excess boundaries
of land above the ceiling could not be determined. For this reason, the programme of land sale
and distribution will be carried out in only those 39 districts where the Revenue Survey will be
completed.
(f) Determination of Loan:
To free the peasants from the clutches of the money lenders and other
unnecessary exploitation by traditional credit systems, a programme to determine the actual
amount of agricultural credit is still in operation. During the Fourth Plan period, the target has
been fixed for the determination of agricultural credit to the approximate amount of Rs. 40
million, out of which the remaining amount not completed during the last plan period will be
calculated.
3. Land Administration
Targets have been fixed to set up Land Offices (now called Land Administrative
Offices) in those 26 districts where the revenue survey operation will be completed during the
Fourth Plan period. Particulars are given below:
Table 61
DISTRICT WHERE LAND (ADMINISTRATIVE) OFFICES WILL BE SET UP
1970/71
1971/72
1972/72
1973/74
1974/75
1.
Morang
Kapilvastu
1. Makwanpur
1. Surkhet
1. Dhankuta
2.
Sunsari
Rupendehi
2. Palpa
2. Dang
2. Daileck
3.
Mohottari
Saptari
3. Ilam
3. Arghakhachi
3. Jajarkot
4.
Siraha
4. Pachthar
4. Achham
5.
Dhanusha
5. Terathum
5. Pyuthan
6.
Chitwan
6. Sindhuli
7. Sallyan
8. Gulmi
9. Syangja
1. To compile and keep land-owner and tenant records up-to-date and to prepare sound
statistical date for future land reform programmes;
2. To protect and guarantee the rights and interests of the proprietors and the tenants in
their respective lands; and
3. To distribute lot-wise certificates to the proprietors and tenants and to introduce
simple and prompt types of land dealings e.g., Registration of Title for the
convenience of the people and for mitigating land litigation cases.
APPENDIX
SURVEY, LAND REFORMS & LAND ADMINISTRATION
List of programmes
(a) Survey
1.
Cadastrial Survey
2. Trigonometrical Survey
3. Maintenance Survey
4. Topographical Survey
5. Survey Training Centre
Present position
Already started
Proposed
Already Started
Target
Additional 26 districts or 3,37,955
hecters approx.
2,72,685 hecters approx.
Additional 26 districts
Basic works such as construction
of building, training and
installation of the equipment will
be completed by the third year and
reproduction of maps will start on
and from the fourth year of the
Plan period.
a. Amins
570
b. J. Surveyors
95
c. S. Surveyors
20
50,75
1,11,50
39,25
4,09,00
Already started
1,93,15
2,77,26,342
17,019
17,019
1,151
Already started
Expenditure
(Rs. in000)
4,92,00
2,90,50
61,35
26 (more)
17,386
26 (more)
Already started
11,35
26 (more)
Already started
40,90
6,40,85,400
300
2,77,26,342
34,890
17,188
Already started
6. Determination of Loans
(a) Determination of agriculture loan (in Rs.)
Already started
40,90
26 (more)
23,530
23,530
61,35
According to
the petition
filled in the
office
3.
TOTAL
* All expenditures will be met from Regular Budget.
Already started
26
30
26
9,01,00
CHAPTER IX
FOREST AND MEDICINAL PLANTS DEPARTMENT
Against the target of training 70 Foresters and 35 Rangers annually at the Nepal
Forestry Institute, 61 Rangers and 96 Foresters have been trained.
Under United Nations assistance, the preliminary survey work in Trisuli
Watershed Development Project has been completed, and the demonstration and development
works have also been started and partially completed.
The gradation, pharmacognostic study, screening and analysis of 150 kinds of
herbs and drugs were carried out in the Royal Drug Research Laboratory under the Department of
Medicinal Plants. In addition, 50 herbs obtained from private parties were analysed and
investigated. More than 500 other analytical studies were also carried out.
Also, studies were done for the formulation, standardization, and quality control
of thirty-two newly manufactured types of medicine. These medicines were manufactured and
sold all over the kingdom. In total 200,000 antibiotic capsules, 3.7 mi; tablets of various types of
sulpha drugs and vitamin C, 1.9 million bottles of syrup and 25,000 bottles of liquid drugs were
also manufactured.
More than 10,000 indigenous and exotic plants of academic interest and aesthetic
value were introduced in the Godawari Royal Botanical Garden for recreational purposes. The
garden has been renovated.
The Preliminary Botanical Survey has been completed throughout the country, and
more than 25 thousands Herbarium sheets have been prepared and preserved. In the context of
the plant survey, five books on Nepalese flora have been prepared and published. Publications
dealing with the flora of Nagarjung, Lamtang, Jumla and areas of Central Nepal are in press.
Mentha and Rauwolfia have been raised in experimental basis on four bighas of
land at Tarhara and Biratnagari. They have also been raised on 30 bighas of land in Brindaban
Herbal Farm (Hetauda). Pyrethrum, Belladona, apple and plums have been raised on 200
ropanies of land in Daman. The annual production consists of 2000 kg. of Pyrethrum and 200 kg.
of Belladonna. In Tistung, Saffron, Pyrethrum and Belladonna have been planted on 200 ropanies
of land. The annual yield has been 1000 kg. of Pyrethrum and 200 kg. of Belladonna. There is a
Belladonna farm of 300 ropanies in Manichur. There is also a farm of 300 ropanies in Shivapuri
having Pyrethrum, Belladonna and Digitalis with an annual yield of 1000 kg. of Pyrethrum 100
kg. of Belladonna and 6000 kg. of Digitalis.
On the basis of up-to-date experiences, the difficulties encountered ineffectively
carrying out the forest development programme have been as follows:
a. The forest is being damaged gradually by the haphazard and increasing
settlement of illegal encroachers.
b. In the absence of a sound national forest policy, there is no coordination
between Land Survey, Revenue, Forest and Resettlement Departments. This
has resulted in each department emphasizing its own departmental interest
rather than the national interest.
c. The protection of forest is being adversely affected due to such excessive
privileges as Harghar Sangha, (a tradition under which the Government issues
permits to the public for cutting certain trees for domestic purpose, although,
this is often abused) uncontrolled entry to the contractors and the public inside
the forest, and the auction of the trees inside the deep forest.
will gradually deteriorate instead of develop if the concerned forest offices do not prohibit free
entry into the forest and do not control the use and exploitation of the forest according to the
working plan prescription.
As there is a sever soil erosion problem in the hills, the policy of soil conservation
and afforestation will be continued, as well as the overall development of forest resources in the
Fourth Plan period. To develo the forest based industries more attention will be given to the
survey and investigation of raw materials in order to increase production.
Programmes of the Fourth Plan
1. Complete coverage of aerial photos for the hilly region
2. Prescription and implementation of working plans for the four remaining divisions of
Terai: Janakpur, Hanumannager, Jhapa, Kapilvastu and the prescription of working
plans for two divisions in the hills: Mahakali, and Kathmandu.
3. Revision of working plans for three Divisions in Terai: Chaitwan, Banke and Bardia
4. Solid and land-use survey of Banke, Bardia, Hanumannagear, Kathmandu, Jhapa,
Lumbini, Kapilvastu divisions and one hill division.
5. Starting of soil conservation work in the Kathmandu water-shed. Completion of soil
conservation work in Panchkhal and developing it into a recreation center.
6. Silvicultural studies, collection of hydrological and Meteorological data, collection of
timber and botanical specimens and standardization of grading and scaling rules for
timber.
7. 4,000 km of forest demarcation and the maintenance of old forest demarcation.
8. 8,000 hectares of afforestation in Hills and Terai and the supervision and maintenance
of old plantation areas. Under this programme, 2,000 hectares of forest will be
protected and conserved, and 2,000 hectares of landing Likhu Valley will be
afforested as a follow-up programme of the Trisuli Watershed Development Project.
9. Economic Mill Units will be established on the basis of extensive investigation of the
utilization, marketing, demands, and producing capacity of the forest. In this
connection, there is a programme to establish a Forest Products Development Centre
at Hetauda.
10. The programme of annually training 25 Rangers 70 Foresters will be continued. A
three months inservice training course will be given to refresh forest technicians.
11. Forest conservation, development and improvement works will be continued at Jiri in
Dolkha District.
Medicinal Plants
A. Royal Drug Research Laboratory
1. Manufacturing of medicines from the extraction of herbs and plants
2. Extension of Pharmacological Laboratory and Pharmacological screening of
herbs
3. Quality control of herbs and drugs, oil and fats, condimonts and spices,
beverages and drinks
Medicinal Plans
1,97,00
Total
Rs. 8,08,00
APPENDIX
Name of Project
A. Forest
1. Forest Inventory
Management Country-wide
(Preparation of the working
plan)
2. Implementation of the
working plans
3. Afforestation
4. Forest Training Hetauda
5. Implementation of the
working Proposed plan in
the Nagarjung Royal Forest
6.
Forest
Boundary
demarcation
7. Building Construction
8. Forest Development
Project
9.
Jiri
Multipurpose
Project, Jiri, Dolkha
Condition
Physical Target
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Proposed
Continuing
Continuing
Proposed
Continuing
1,35,00
1,97,00
60,000
14,44
5,71
18,00
25,00
6,11,00
1,51,08
4,77
B. Medicinal Plants
1.Royal Drug Research
Laboratory, Thapathali
2.Production
Unit
Thapathali
3.Royal Botanical Garden
Godawari
4.Botanical Survey and
Harbarium country-wide
5. Herbal Farm Countrywide
A. Opium
Cultivation
Narayani Zone
B. Bellodonna Cultivation
1,97,00
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
24,00
94,00
17,00
17,00
23,000
15,00
7,00
CHAPTER X
TRANSPORT
1.
Introduction:
(1) In the process of economic growth, the overall development programme of a landlocked country like
ours can progress only with well organized and expanded transport facilities. The more inaccessible an area, the
more difficult it becomes to transport men and materials. The infusion of development ideas in these regions
depends largely on the availability of adequate transportation. It is only through transport expansion that that
development projects of all types can flourish together through mutual co-ordination and integration. The
rugged topography of the country has posed a formidable problem to all sorts of transport, and because of this,
even in the highly emphasized agricultural sector, production targets have not been reached. Thus it is evident
from our experience (as well other countries ), that unless transportation is sufficiently developed; development
programmes cannot be effectively implemented. Consequently, transportation has been given top priority.
Furthermore, its development is necessary to bring about efficiency and coordination in administration, to
overcome regional disparity, and to mobilize scattered and surplus labour from agriculture to other sectors.
(2) With the availability of cheap, speedy and far reaching transport facilities, isolated rural substances
economies can now find markets and, therefore, form larger and more efficient producing units and
replace barter with a cash economy. Industry can be encouraged by the greater accessibility of new resources.
Communities or regions so connected and integrated become more productive and more or less self sufficient,
causing inter-regional trade to grow on the basis of specialization and comparative advantage. Thus, transport
development, though by no means guarantee of economic growth, does make direct and indirect contributions to
national income through a more productive
utilization of time and an expansion of almost all sectors of the economy. In short, transport development
contributes to economic development in the following ways:
(a) Enlarging the market and thereby further stimulating economic specialization;
(b) Helping exploitation of additional resources by making them accessible and
thereby enlarging
employment and rehabilitation;
( c) Leading to the establishment and for expansion of related industries by making them accessible to raw
materials and
( d) Enhancing the optimum utilization of resources and making the means of production more dynamic.
(3) Communication has its own importance, and to a larger extent, it acts as a complement to transport. Only
through the expansion of communication channels, can we utilize the transport facility at its maximum
capability. The need for all types of communication grows rapidly in every sector of the economy during the
process of development. In fact, organized communication channels are the only way to satisfy the increasing
needs. Modern life can not be imagined without a developed and modernized communication system. In spite of
the importance of transport and communication, to this day historical and geographical factors divide the
country into several parts; people are isolated in their villages during the rainy season because of landslides and
flood.
2 Objectives:
(d) To speed up the pace of progress with a view to imparting an element of dynamism into
society and thereby enhancing efficiency in the public and private sectors.
3. Policy:
Transport will get a higher priority during the Fourth Plan period than communication. Surface roads,
waterways, airways ,ropeways and railways comprise the different modes of transportation, although it is not
possible to consider them as equally important. Therefore, the type of transport, which is most speedy and stable and
yields the quickest returns will be emphasized.
The rugged terrain of the country has limited the expansion of railways, and within this Plan period, only a
necessary feasibility survey will be undertaken. Air transportation, though expensive and primarily beneficial to only
a section of the well-to-do-class, will nevertheless be extended as a temporary measure to all those economically
feasible areas, as well as to those places necessary from an administrative or tourist point of view. Therefore, air
transport has been given second priority after roads. River navigation, as a solution to our transport problem, is
unfeasible because of the rugged topography. Ropeway extension in the hills looks attractive on theoretical ground,
but not from a cost-benefit point of view. Since roads are the most dependable means of transport, the emphasis in
the near future will be given to the construction of roads.
In the field of communication, telecommunication and postal services will be given due consideration. So
far, postal service is the only means which is serving the majority of the population. Its need is continuously
increasing because of the increase in transport extension and educational facilities. Efforts will be made to make
available cheaper and speedy services throughout the country by the improvement and expansion of postal services.
Moreover, various types of telecommunication services will be established, considering the growing international
relations together with the development of industry, trade and tourism.
4. Introduction to Road Development:
The National Planning Commission has based the road development programme of Fourth Plan on the 20
year Highway Plan in Nepal. Keeping in mind the unique topography and the limited resources in hand, all the
districts and zonal headquarters will be linked by motorable road in accordance with the long-term plan. Since road
building is a time consuming process, it would be unreasonable to tie our hands without proceeding with some
transport development work in those districts where road construction is supposed to continue in future. Attention
will therefore be devoted not only to the construction of existing roads, but also to the improvement of primitive
tracks and the construction of new ones. In this context, efforts will be made to prepare maps with the cost estimates
of various roads in the country. In order to provide swift and efficient administration, the entire road network has
been classified in the following manner:
National-----Road-----Network
________________________
l
l
l
l
l
l
Road
Track
l
l
l
l
l
l
Motorable
Non-motorable
l
l
l
l
_____________________ ______________________
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Highway
Trunk Road Road Jeep track Mule track
Foot track
In view of the need for a stable and strong organization for the proper development and maintenance of
roads, three categories of roads have been devised so that minimum requirements for construction and maintenance
are fulfilled. This has been done because further classification is considered unnecessary at present.
1. Highway:
Roads, which are considered to be strategic from a national view point are included in this category.
All highways should have the recommended width, sub-base and local bearing capacity. His Majestys
Government (HMG) will assume the responsibility for construction and maintenance.
2. Main road:
Roads, which are less important and shorter than the highway, but like several districts and zones are
included in this category. HMG will decide the minimum standards, both physical and technical, for these roads.
The task of repairing and maintenance will rest with the local authorities of HMG.
3. Freeder road:
Roads, which are generally short in distance when compared with the main road and connect only one
or two districts and which are only important locally are included in this category. The road surface will be
black topped, graveled, or unmetalled according to the region. HMG will take the appropriate steps for the
maintenance of such roads, including the complete inventory of road lists. The local authorities will also share
some responsibility in this matter.
Even a concentrated road building effort will not complete the project in a short period due to complete
neglect for a century. Keeping in view the ideal goal of planning to serve all the people, appropriate steps will be
taken to develop and facilitate the transport system in the remote areas where motorable road construction has
not yet been feasible. Henceforth it has been necessary to classify those transport facilities which provide for the
movement of mules and people a foot and bridle path. Most of the transport facilities available in the country
are in this condition. In the Terai, there are similar narrow tracks called Pagdandi. The sole responsibility and
maintenance of such tracks will lie with the Panchayats themselves. For the present, necessary maintenance and
improvement will be undertaken in most remote areas as required and the standard of mule-tracks will also be
improved.
4. Mule tracks:
The tracks which offer two way traffic for mules are included in this category. These mule tracks can
be quite wide at places, but the absence of bridges and culverts, together with the step ups and downs, restrict
the operation of vehicular traffic.
5. Jeep track:
The tracks where the movement of carts and jeeps is possible are included in this category. Such
tracks will help to link village and farms on the one hand and villages and markets on the other-especially in the
Terai region. Such tracks are quite important at present and will continue to be so in the future. It can be hoped
that economic prosperity of the region will automatically lead to further development of fair-weather feeder
roads.
6. Road construction Progress up to Date:
In 1951, the total length of roads existing in the country was only 376 kilometers, including 5Km. of
pitched and 83 Km. of graveled roads. Prior to the First Five Year Plan, the total length of roads in kingdom of
Nepal was 624 Km. Including 259 Km. of all-weather and 365 Km. Fair-weather roads.
TABLE 62
Roads
6
42
126
5
80
259
48
80
21
19
80
80
16
21
365
6
42
126
5
48
80
80
21
19
80
80
16
21
624
In the First Plan (1956/57-60/61), the target set for road construction was 1,440 Km. which included 480 Km. Allweather and 960 Km. Fair-weather roads. Progress achieved during this period was 912 Kilometers of roads, including 170
Km. Black top, 173 Km. Gravel and 569 Km. Fair-weather. In 1961-62, another 178Km. Of roads were added, of which 77
Km. Were all-weather and 101 Km. Were fair-weather. The First Five Year Plans achievements in road construction are
given in the following table.
TABLE 63
PROGRESS ACHIEVED IN FIRST PLAN (1956/57-1960/61)
Road Projects
Pitch
1. Kathmandu-Arniko Highway 2. Hetaunda-Narayangadh
3. Kathmandu Valley
64
53
4. Jogbani-Dharan
5. Kuncha-Pokhara
6. Kanti Highway
7. Patan-Godawari
8. Tribhuban Highway
48
9. Lumbini Road. Bhaisen-Raxaul
10. Bhaisen-Raxaul
5
11. Sunauli-Pokhara
12. Kathmandu-Trisuli
13. Dhangarhi-Dadheldhura
14. Kathmandu-Janakpur
15. Krishnanagar-Piuthan
16. Nepalgunj-Surkhat
Total:
170
Gravel
80
35
37
173
(Length in Kilometers)
Fairweather
Total
19
19
80
64
53
31
31
96
96
19
19
83
21
21
42
80
80
69
69
45
45
143
143
24
24
43
43
569
912
During the Second Plan also, top priority was given to transport development. Its target was to construct 1,440
Km. of roads, including 1,120 fair weather and 320 Km. all-weather. By the end of this Plan, only 927 Km. of roads were
constructed, of which 71 Km. were fair weather and 856 Km. of all-weather.
TABLE 64
Black-top
Gravel
(Length in Kilometres)
Fairweather Total
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
9
9
14
24
6
8
5
1
4
62
621
95
13
6
8
13
7
64
29
856
621
104
27
24
6
6
8
13
13
1
11
64
29
927
Thus, before the beginning of the Third Plan, all types of road available in the Kingdom of Nepal were 1,826 Km.
which included 289 Km. black top, 147 Km. gravel and 1,390 Km. fair-weather.
According to the revised target of the Third Plan (1965-70), it was envisaged to construct 1,365 kilometers of
roads, including 753 kilometers all-weather and 607 kilometers fair-weather. Out of this, 1,009 kilometer or 80 per cent of
the target has been achieved including 405 Km. black top, 230 Km. gravel, and 455 Km. fair-weather roads. The following
Table clearly shows the picture of the progress achieved in the Third Plan.
TABLE 65
PROGRESS ACHIEVED IN THIRD PLAN IN TRANSPORT AND
COMMUNICATION SECTOR (1965-70)
Projects
Pitch
1
2
1. Highway
a. Mahendra
150
Highway
117
1. Janakpur-Jhapa
2. Simra-Janakpur
105
3. Narayangadh209
Butwal
b. Arniko-Highway c. Sidhartha Highway 117
d. Prithvi Highway
2. Main Roads
1. DhangarhiDadheldhura
3
2. Other Roads
Total
758
F.W.
In Kilometers
Target of the Plan
1965-66
196768
2
2
2
Pitch
Gravel F.W. Pitch
Gravel F.W. Pitch
Gravel F.W.
10
11
12
114
122
176
70
125
27
24
43
26
61
183
6
77
24
27
32
96
10
3
-
1
16
32
10
70
3
19
77
43
47
6
13
607
51
69
250
101
165
13
40
102
180
1. Fair weather
2. Includes both black top and gravel roads.
3. Other roads include: Swayambhu road, Birgunj-Kalaiya, Maharajgunj Leather & Shoe Factory, Taulihawa-Khunwa,
Rajbiraj-Kunauli, Narayani Ferey, Balaju road, Gokarna Rajnikunja, Dakshinkali, Jawalakhel-Lagankhel, Bhainse-Hetauda,
Janakpur, Koshi, Nepalgunj-Khajura, Dharan-Dhankuta, Mechi main road, Kathmandu town roads and Pokhara roads.
Projects
1968-69
Pitch2 Gravel F.W.1
1969-70
Pitch2 Gravel F.W.1
1.a.1.
1.a.2.
1.b.3.
1.b.
1.c.
2.1.
2.2.
Total
4
15
97
3
119
23
13
30
13
79
43
28
77
170
87
405
63
28
69
173
123
22
188
19
19
4
13
2
37
97
233
83
26
27
16
7
51
230
110
11
2
65
111
455
Compared with the previous Plans, achievement in the field of roads construction during the Third Plan is quite
encouraging. The following Table clearly shows the figure of achievement compared to the target.
TABLE 66
ROAD CONSTRUCTIONS TARGET & ACHIEVEMENTS OF THE FIRST, SECOND
AND THIRD PLANS
(Length in Kilometres)
3
All-weather
Fair-weather
Total
Before commencement of First Plan
259
365
624
Target of the First Plan
480
960
1,440
Progress of the First Plan
343
569
912
Percentage
71
59
63
Fiscal Year (1961-62)
77
101
178
Target of the Second Plan
320
1,120
1,440
Progress of the Second Plan
71
856
927
Percentage
22
607
1,365
Target of the Third Plan
635
455
1,090
Percentage
80
78
79
By the end of the Third Plan, the total length of roads in Nepal is estimated to be 3,731 Kilometers. In the process
of development the sub-standard roads, including fair-weather ones, were successively improved and standardized.
Accordingly, the net availability of roads before the implementation of the Fourth Plan will be 2,730 including 821 Km.
black top, 435 Km. gravel and 1,474 Km. fair-weather roads. The details are as follows.
1.
2.
3.
Fair weather
Includes black top and gravel roads
Includes pitch and gravel roads
TABLES 67
ESTIMATED LENGTH OF ROAD BEFORE THE BEGINNING
OF THE FOURTH PLAN
(Length in Kilometres)
Project
Allweather
Gravel
Pitch
Total
(A) Highway
1. Mahendra Highway
106
a. Jhapa-Dhalkewar Sector
32
b. Pathlaiya-Dhalkewar
c. Pathlaiya-Detauda
d. Hetauda-Narayangadh
2. Tribhuban Rajpath
138
a. Kathmandu-Bhainse
b. Bhainse-Birgunj-Raxual
3. Arniko (Kodar) Highway
4. Sidartha Highway
5. Prithvi Highway
(B) Main Roads
136
1. Nepalgunj-Surkhet
136
Total of A+B
25
(C) Feeder Roads
299
1. Biratnagar-Rangeli-Jhapa
88
2. Dharan-Jogwani
3. Rajbiraj-Kunauli
4. Rajbiraj-Hanumannagar-Sirha
61
5. Kosti Road
6. Sirha-Jayanagar
8
7. Kunauli-Hanumannagar-Fatteput
10
8. Jaleshwor-Mattihani
6
9. Jaleshwor-Malangwa
51
10. Malangwa-Sonbarkha (Border)
3
11. Janakpur-Jaleshwor (Border)
21
12. Janakpur-Dhanukha
8
13. Janakpur town-Airport
14. Janakpur-Dhalkewar
23
15. Gaur-Bairganniya
1
16. Birgunj-Kalaiya
17. Kathmandu-Trisuli
18. Bhaisen-Bhimphedi
11
19. Narayangadh-Madi
64
20. Bhairahwa-Taulihawa
48
21. Bhairahwa-Tribeni
64
22. Bhairahwa-Pakklihawa
23. Taulihawa-Khunuwa
24. Taulihawa-Lumbini
25. Ratna Highway (Jalkundi Dang airport)29
26. Kiolabas-Jaruwa (Border)
2
27. Nepalgunj Road
28. Kilabas-Ghorahi
64
29. Nepalgunj-Gulriya (Bardiya)
38
30. Gulriya-Murtiha (Border)
9
31. Krishnanagar-Terai (Part of Piuthan) 24
32. Dhangadhi-Dadheldhura
27
33. Mechi main road
55
34. Kathmandu-Janakpur
56
35. Bilor-Dhangadhi
48
36. Gulriya-Dhangadhi
99
37. Chatra-Dharan
16
38. Hanumannagar-Bhimnagar (Border) 6
39. Chandragadhi-Mechi (Border)
3
40. Brahmhadevmandi-Bilauri
48
41. Taulihawa-Patharkot
29
42. Rajbiraj-Lahan
38
43. Bhimnagar-Chatra
19
44. Kathmandu area road
98
150
83
54
27
-
256
86
27
83
233
27
40
67
300
52
11
22
23
27
81
115
74
189
77
209
286
556
50
13
3
45
3
6
11
8
6
120
452
115
74
189
104
209
176
489
25
1,155
88
50
13
61
52
8
10
6
51
3
21
8
3
23
1
11
67
11
64
51
64
6
11
8
29
2
6
64
38
9
24
50
55
56
48
99
16
6
3
48
29
38
19
245
Total A+B+C
1175
1474
135
435
265
821
1575
2730
Thus out of 2,730 kilometers, 1,474 kilometers or 54 per cent is still classified as fair weather roads mostly
feasible for jeeps. As such, these roads are negligible when compared to our requirements. For example, the road kilometers
per 100 thousand population in Nepal will come to around 24 Kms. while the ratio in other countries comes to
approximately 5.5 Km. Similarly, the motorable road available per 100 thousand population in Nepal in 1968-1969 was 61,
while in Ceylon and Phillipines the total were 903 and 483 respectively.
6. Role of Transport in the Fourth Plan:
The Road development programme in the Fourth Plan has been designed on the basis of a Twenty Year Perspective Plan
aiming to connect the districts and the zonal headquarters by 1985. Efforts will, therefore, be made to complete the
Mahendra Highway, as well as the construction of new highways and trunk roads which will link those areas of the
Himalayan, Hilly and Terai regions having complementary economic relations. Furthermore, a crash programme of road
development will be encouraged based on scattered development potentials as judged from quantitative analysis. The short
description of the of the road development programme in this Plan will be as follows:
TABLE 68
ROAD DEVELOPMENT PROGRAMME IN THE FOURTH PLAN
(Length in Kilometres)
Project
Total
Pitch
Gravel
Fairweather
771
477
294
(a) Completion of continuing projects
83
200
327
(b)
Remaining portion of Mahendra
520
229
35
264
Highway (Western Sector)
150
150
(c)
Growth Axis Road
25
Inter District & District level Roads 25
(d)
100
(e)
Urban Roads
100
(f)
Roads to be constructed after
1,830
585
973
272
Feasibility Study
Thus, with the completion of the above mentioned projects during the Fourth Plan, 1,830 Km. of roads will be
constructed including 585 Km. of pitch, 973 Km. of gravel and 272 Km. of fair-weather.
6.(A) Completion of Continuing Projects
This includes the construction of the Mahendra Highway, stretching from Jhapa in the east to Kholapur in the
west. Between Dhangarhi and Dadeldhura, a main road is now under construction. The length of this will be 771
kilometres, including 477 kilometres black top and 294 kilometres gravel unable for all-weather. Details of these roads
are as follows:
TABLE 69
Name of the Projects
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
2.
(a)
3.
(a)
(b)
Mahendra Highway
Jhapa-Dhalkewar
213
sector
40
Dhalkewar89
Janakpur-Jaleshwor
122
Simra-Dhalkewar
Narayangadh- Butwal
Kamala Bridge 13
Prithvi Highway
Prithvi Highway
Main roads
Dhangadhi-Dadheldhura
Kathmandu-Bhaktapur
Total:
477
156
138
-
294
A. (6) Dhangarhi-Dadheldura:
The construction of 145 kilometres from Dhangarhi to Dadheldhura was started during the Third Plan, partially
under American assistance. Sixty-five kilometres of fair-weather road were completed, both in the Terai and Hilly
regions, by the last year of the Third Plan. The entire length of the road will be gravelled by the fourth year of the Plan.
This road will connect the food deficit areas of the Far Western Hills, such as Doti, Baitadi, Achham and
Bajura with the Terai. Moreover, this will facilitate the availailify of daily consumption goods and will create the
necessary precondition for the development of these areas. The possibilities of horticultural and other development in
these districts are promising and can be explored extensively. The hills, particularly the Himalayan region, are
favourable for the production of apples, walnuts and other fruits, which have a good export-market. Also about 6,000
maunds of ghee are exported to India every year through Rajapur Customs from the above districts. Completion of this
project will increase direct contact between the producers and the consumers and will also help uplift the standard of
the local people. This will also increase national and per capita income. Moreever, this road will bring the hinterland of
Dhadeldura very close and will act as a forward link to Doti, Baitadi, Achham, Darchula, Bajura and Bajhang. Its
importance has been further enhanced by economic and social needs. It will also help to lessen the regional disparity
prevailing in the districts of far western hills. It will have 43 major and minor bridges, along with 60 culverts.
A. (7) Bhaktapur-Kathmandu:
The number of passengers traveling daily along this route is approximately 5,641 by 31 buses. In fact, large
quantities of vegetables and other food stuffs required in Kathmandu are supplied by areas served by this route. This
route has facilitated the growth of inter-regional trade between Banepa, Dhulikhel, Barabise and Kathmandu. Of late,
this road between Bhagtapur and Kathmandu has become quite narrow and congested because of the increasing volume
of traffic. This has resulted in significant inconveniences to passengers and increased dangers from accidents. In
addition, the operating costs of the vehicles have increased considerably. Consequently, the increased cost in diesel and
petrol alone has amounted to Rs. 500,000 annually.
Thus, as an alternative, a new road has been under construction with Chinese assistance from Thapathali to
Bhaktapur since the fourth year of the Third Plan. The entire length of the 13 kilometer road will be black-topped
during the first year of the Fourth Plan. Completion of this road will not only help the passengers, but will also reduce
the operating costs and contribute indirectly to an national income.
B. (1) Western Sector of the Mahendra Highway:
The 437 kilometer road from Nepalgung (Kohalapur) to Banwasa comprises the remaining section of the
Mahendra Highway. Of this, 200 kilometers will be graveled and the remaining 237 Km. will be rair-weather road.
TABLE 70
Name of the Projects
1.
Remaining portion of Highway on the
western side of Butwal
2.
Narayani bridge and HetaudaNarayangadh road improvement
Total:
Pitch
(Length in Kilometres)
Gravel
Fair-weather
83
200
-
237
-
83
200
237
A. (1) Remaining portion of the Mahendra Highway in the western side of Butwal
The main centers to which agricultural products are brought down from the hills or produced and collected for
marketing in the Terai are Nepalgunj, Rajapur, Dhangarhi and Mahendranagar. These serve both as export
centers for agricultural commodities and import-centres for consumer foods from India. Mahendranagar is a
flourishing trade center but because of transport difficulties, it conducts all of its trade with India instead of
the Terai area to the east.
Completion of this road will facilitate the linking of the districts of Seti, Bheri, Mahakali and Terai
portion of Rapti and Lubini zones, as well as helping to increase the exporting capacity of these areas. The
need for this highway has also been regarded as most urgent because it will connect important parts of the
country: i.e., the hills with the resource rich area in the East and West Terai. The road would also help to
integrate the economies of these areas.
B. (2) Hetauda-Narayangarh and Narayani Bridge:
In the Third Plan, survey and investigation work were completed for the raising of the HetaudaNarayangarh road to highway standards. This road is a connecting link to the Mahendra Highway in the Western
sector. The construction work on this 83 kilometers long highway will be black topped by 1974-75, along with the
improved bridges and culverts which are needed.
Appropriate arrangements will be made to continue transportation across the Narayani river. There has
been a ferry-service across this river for some time. During the Third Plan, an economic and technical
investigation reached the final stage, and during the Fourth Plan, either a bridge or a ferry will be established,
depending upon the recommendations of the report.
C. Growth Axis Roads construction
Because of the excessive mountain terrain on the Northern part of Nepal and the low land of the Terai,
the occupations, production, and potentiality of these areas are basically different. A north-south road has,
therefore, become essential to facilitate the movement of complementary products from the hills to the
Terai and Terai to the hills. In addition, intra-regional trade would also gather momentum.
Moreover, the hilly region, in general, is a food deficit area while the Terai is a surplus area.
Therefore, encouragement should be given to the production of commodities other than cereals in the
hills. If the rules of comparative advantage are used, this should, in turn, help to increase the standard of
living of local people. It has been felt that a north-south road is necessary to harness all these
development potentials.
In the Fourth Plan, the need for north south road has been considered to
be most urgent. It would provide a bigpush to the development programme in the backward regions and in
eliminating regional disparities. Accordingly, road, facilities, as a stimulus to Regional development, will be made
available to Jumla in the Karnali region, Jomsom in the Gandaki region, Dhunche and Barabise in the Bagmati region, and
Khandbari in the Kosi region. These represent the Himalayan, Hilly and Terai regions along with Eastern, Central and
Western parts of the country. The total length of such roads is estimated to be 84o kilometers of which 254 kilometers will
be constructed in the Fourth Plan. In the Bagamati region, since the road linking Barabise is already in, service only the
following road projects will be undertaken.
TABLE 71
(Length in Kilometres)
Name of the Projects
1. Nepalgunj-Jumla road (up to Surkhet)
2. Putlikhet-Baglung-Tukuche-Jomosom
(From Putliket up to Baglung)
3. Trisuli-Dhunche
4. Dharan-Dhankuta-Kandwari (From
Dharan up to Dhankutta)
Total:
Pitch
-
Gravel
77
80
25
72
Fair-weather
-
254
C. (1) Nepalgunj-Jumla:
This road is a part of the Western trunk route which will pass from Kholapur to Jumla, connecting
Surkhet, Kalikot and Dhailekh. The total length will be 250 kilometres. By now, the airfields in Nepalgunj
Surkhet and Jumla have been alleviating the transport problems of this area. But only a fraction of the wellto-do-class have been able to take advantage of this facility. Furthermore, the limited land resources and
low producticity in the hills have made people move in search of employment and trade opportunities in the
Surkhet, Dang and Nepalgunj areas. This will shift the population from Dailekh, Jumla and the surrounding
areas to Surkhet, Dang and Nepalgunj, thereby giving rise to likely population problems in the future.
Therefore, construction of this road can help in the establishment of small development projects which, in
turn, will partially help to solve the unemployment problem.
In the Fourth Plan, 77 kilometres of road connecting Nepalgunj and Surkhet will be constructed. Since
Nepalgunj is the trading center of western Nepal, road will open up the surrounding districts and enable them to
expand their trade.
C. (2) Putalikhet-Baglung-Tukuche-Jomsom:
TABLE 72
INTER DISTRICT AND INTRA DISTRICT ROADS
(Length in Kilometres)
internal and external trade, however, this goal will remain unfulfilled until a feeder road from Dhulabari to
the most fertile area in the south is constructed. Therefore, in this Plan,16 kilometres of gravelled road from
Dhulabari to Chandragadhi will be constructed. Completion of this road will help the establishment of jute
processing, paper and other allied industries.
(7) Rajbiraj-Mahendra Highway:
Rajbiraj has its own importance as the headquarters of Sagarmatha Zone. Chandra canal and other
such irrigation facilities have made this area very fertile and densely populated. In addition to paddy, large
quantities of raw jute, mustard, timber and other goods are exported to India.
The present Mahendra Highway which passes through Lahan provides a prospective market for
the local products of Udaipur and other hilly districts. This will also add to the income of the local people.
Feeder road construction from Rajbiraj to Mahendra Highway will facilitate the movement of food grains.
Consequently, in this Plan period, 14 kilometres of gravelled roads from Rajbiraj to Mahendra Highway
will be constructed.
E. Urban Roads:
Under this project, 25 kilometres of black topped road will be constructed in Kathmandu and other
urban areas. The details are as follows:
E.(1) Kathmandu Valley Roads:
Kathmandu is important for many reasons. As the capital of the country Kathmandus urban
population has been rapidly increasing. The number of vehicles registered has increased from 1,845 in 1958
to 6,710 in 1968. However, the road capacity in Kathmandu has not increased at the same rate. It has
therefore been planned to increase the capacity of the roads as well as to upgrade some roads by black
topping.
E.(2) Other Urban Roads:
In this Plan, due consideration will be given to the roads in Pokhara. The improvement and
construction work of the road in Pokhara will begin in 1972/73. Pokhara needs roads because it is the main
town for the Central Hills and has good prospects for tourism. Moreover, with the completion of the
Siddarth Highway and the near completion of the Prithvi Highway, the expected increase in the volume of
traffic of men and vehicles will require improved roads in Pokhara. In accordance with needs, the existing
fair-weather roads of other urban areas will also be black topped.
F. Roads to be completed after the Feasibility Survey:
The World Bank team will conduct a technical and economic feasibility survey for roads
throughout the country. In this Plan, about 100 kilometres of gravelled roads will be constructed according
to the priorities of the survey report. The following roads have also been included in the survey:
Projects
100 kilometres
1. Lahan-Okhaldhunga
2. Kathmandu-Simra
3. Dang-Jajarkot
4. Jhapa-Taplejung
5. Narayanghat-Prithvi Highway
6. Banepa-Sindhuli-Dhalkewar
7. :Bhojpur-Mahendra Highway
8. Thori-Bharatpur
9. Others
F.(1) Lahan-Okhaldhunga:
It has been estimated that the districts of Sagarmatha Zone (especially Okhaldhunga) have been
facing deficits of about 7,677 metric tons of food-grain every year. Lahan has been considered to be a main
market center to this area for both social and economic reasons.
Potatoes and fruits are grown in Udaipur and Okhaldhunga, but only for local consumption.
Similarly, the cheese producing plant in Solukhumbu is incurring high transportation costs trying to get its
products to market.
F.(2) Kathmandu-Simra:
The volume of traffic and the danger of accidents on the Tribhuwan Highway have increased
considerably. Also, the long route passing through steep hills and sharp bends has led to greater fuel
consumption and shortened the lives of vehicles.This has brought to light the need for an alternative to the
Tribhuban Rajpath which will be shorter, more comfortable, and more economic. The length of this road
will be 96 kilometres instead of the 144 kilometers of the Tribhuban Rajpath.
F.(3) Dang-Jajarkot:
Substantial amounts of food-grain, fruits, ghee, and other items are exported to India through
Koilabas. Transport difficulties have posed a formidable problem to move the foodgrain to deficit areas like
Jajarkot and Sallyan.
Oranges are grown in the districts of Sallyan and Jajarkot, and there is good potential for the
development of these export-oriented horticultural products. If the linking of this road is possible, there are
chances for the growth of a needed organized market which will promote exports of these products.
F.(4) Jhapa-Taplejung:
Both Illam and Taplejung are deficit in food-grains. Illam alone imports about 2,728 metric tons of
food-grains from surplus areas of the country. Simultaneously, Jhapa exports 60,000 metric tons of foodgrains to India every year. If suitable transportation were available, food-grains could easily be sent from
Jhapa to these deficit districts in a shorter period of time and at a lower cost.
Also, there is the possibility of setting up a herb extraction plant in Taplejung which has a significant
export potential. There is also potential for the development of potatoes, fruits, and tea farming in Illam
with good markets in India.
F.(5) Narayanghat-Prithvi Highway (Muglinphant):
Narayanghat, a small town in Chitwan, is flourishing as an important center of trade and industrial
activity. It has also absorbed large numbers of settlers from Gorkha, Bandipur and other surrounding hilly
areas. Development projects, such as the Rapti Valley Project has also generated some economic activity in
this region. Presently, Narayanghat is serving as the main food-grain market center for the hilly regions of
Bandipur and Gorkha.
Substantial amount of mustard and timber are also exported from this area. Furthermore, this area
has been supplying a great deal of firewood to Kathmandu Valley.
Narayanghat Bazar is only 25 Km. away from Muglinphant, a village on the Prithvi Highwaay.
Opening a feeder road from Narayanghat to Muglinphant will link the districts of Lumbini, Gandaki and
Bagmati zones. Besides, a straight route would be opened between Birgunj and Pokhara on the one hand
and Bhairahawa and Kathmandu on the other. Moreover, this will provide a more convenient and speedy
route than the Tribhuban Highway it is about 200 kilometers to Kathmandu. However, by the new route
coming up from Narayanghat via the Prithvi Highway, it will be about 135 kilometers only. In addition, this
will facilitate food-grain movement at fair prices from Chitwan and Nawalparasi to Bandipur, Gorkha,
Tanahu and Pokhara during times of food shortage.
F.(6) Banepa- Sindhuli-Dhalkewar:
For many years, Tribhuban Highway has been the only motorable road for all people coming from
either the east or west to Kathmandu. It has not only caused many inconveniences to the people, but also led
to the wasting of national resources. Thus, it has become essential to link Kathmandu with Janakpur through
Banepa, Sindhuli and Dhalkewar. This will serve as another arterial route from Kathmandu to other parts of
the Eastern Terai region. It will facilitate the movement of man and material, as well as reduce the pressure
of accidents on the Tribhuban Highway. For the districts of Janakpur Zone, the road will serve as a base for
development. Also, from an economic point of view, a road will help in extending the trade of Ramechhap,
Dhulikhel and Dolkha and other hilly regions with other Terai centers and Indian markets.
G. Foot tracks, Mule tracks and Jeep tracks:
The road development programme to be initiated in the Fourth Plan will not, however, connect all
parts of the country by motorable roads. Thus with the exception of Kathmandu, the Terai and some other
parts of the hills, the need for foot and mule tracks will remain for some decades to come. The total length
of such trails in Nepal has been estimated to be 10,000 kilometers. The village people generally must pass
over such trails for trade and purchase of their daily consumption.
Inaccessible areas will be connected through motorable roads in accordance with the long- term
plan. However, our limited resources are not adequate for such immediate transport undertakings.
Therefore, about 1,652 existing foot and mule tracks in the following districts will be improved and
constructed, keeping in mind the growing needs of the localities. The details are given below:
TABLE 73
TABLE 74
Location
1. Puchighat
2. Nawalpurghat
3. Sisaghat
4. 5. Kusmaghat
6. Siwalaya (Giri)
Khimti
Dolkha
200
7. Pilwaghat
Pilwa
Sankhuwashabha
260
8. Near Soludhovan
Dhudhkosi
Solukhumbu
300
9. Raighat
Sunkosi
Udaipur
450
10. Near Tallu Village
Bheri
Jajarkot
300
11.
Tamor
Panchtar
330
12. Kabeli and Tomor*
Kabeli
Panchtar
260
13. Purtighat*
Krishnagandhaki
Parbat
260
14. Ranighat
Palpa
500
15. Badegaon*
Ili
Gulmi
350
16. Marin
Kavrepalanchowk
400
17. Madhumalla
Tamor
Terathum
350
18. Kalkitar
Krishnagandaki
Gorkha
450
19. Saleri
Muni
Sallyan
220
20. Chiyang
Babahi
260
21. Nayaramghat
Dudhkosi
Ramechhap
350
22. Samusdhovan
Samsu
Udaipur
300
23. Rasuwadobhan
Rasuwa
Rasuwa
300
24. Charekotar
Kalangi
Bajhang
220
25. Choulani
Choulani
Baitadi
260
26. Tumlingtar
Samakhola
Sankhuwasabha
300
27. Rangaghat
Thulibheri
Surkhet
300
I. Bridges and Culverts Construction and Improvement:
The growing need for bridges and culverts in all parts of a country like Nepal which is surrounded
by rivers and streams, is indisputable. But it is evident that limited resources do not permit us to construct
and improve bridges in all places at the same time Therefore, HMG will construct bridges over those rivers
with the greatest traffic. In addition, alternative routes will be considered keeping in view the volume of
traffic.
Also, four worn-out bridges in Kathmandu which are not capable of bearing any further heavy load
will be replaced and constructed according to a new standard.
J. Roads to be improved:
Due to a rapid increase in the volume of men and materials, and the use heavy vehicles, about 400
kilometers of roads which were classified as substandard in the Third plan will be improved considerably.
The name of roads are as follows:
1. Raxaul-Hetauda and Kathmandu-Hetauda (Tribhuwan Highway)
2. Kathmandu-Trisuli
3. Other roads(Padma road,Biratnagar, Rangeli etc.)
These roads being the important access to the capital have been vital in view of the movement of
men and materials. During the Third Plan, the width of the Raxaul-Hetauda section was widened to metres and was
black topped. In this Plan, the
improvement of corners, culverts and other related
improvements will be continued.
* Expected to be constructed with World Bank loan.
In addition to this, the Naubise-Kathmandu section of Tribhuvan-Rajpath will have to be improved
considerably in view of the expected increase in the traffic from Pokhara.
J (2) Kathmandu Trisuli:
The existing gravel road has been improved at all levels during the Third Plan . During the Fourth
Plan, the gravel road will be converted into black top.
K. Miscellaneous:
It has become quite essential to improve the methodology of the formulation of development projects
during the process of development. Therefore, in the Plan, proper arrangements will be made for studying
the construction of new roads. The report available from this study will certainly form a dependable base for
this Plan, and more particularly, for the Fifth Plan.
By the end of this Plan, more black top roads will be ready, although they may not be able to meet our
requirements. Future generations can receive the benefits only when these roads are properly maintained.
Therefore, due consideration will be given to the protection and maintenance of the national road network.
Attention has been given to making the Road Department more efficient by saving expensive and modern
equipments. However, arrangements will be made to provide the essential equipments.
Since road construction has been carried out on the basis of the knowledge and experience of other
countries, construction materials, equipment, and techniques have accordingly been foreign. However, it
seems very unsatisfactory to continue this system. Therefore, a construction material laboratory for testing
the utility of construction materials will be established. Thus, if these facilities can be developed properly, it
will lead to reduced construction costs for road development through the utilization of local materials and
the savings of foreign exchange.
In order to complete these programmes, the decision will be finalized after necessary consultation with
the U.N.D.P. Special Fund and I.D.A. During the Fourth Plan it is hoped to complete the entire programme.
Financial Outlay,
Past and Present:
1. From the very beginning of planning in Nepal, the road development programme has been given top
priority. In the First Plan, out of a total 330 million rupees, 111.5 million rupees was earmarked for the development
of transport and communications. By the end of First Plan, 94.9 million rupees or 85 per cent of the total outlay were
actually spent. Investment and expenditure in the field of transport and communication are given below:
TABLE 75
PLAN OUTLAY AND EXPENDITURE IN THE TRANSPORT AND
COMMUNICATION SECTOR (1956-61)
Amount
(Rs. in Thousand)
Allocated in
Project
First Plan
Expenditure
Percent
(a) Transport
10,40,00
8,78,29
84%
1. Road
5,00,00
5,65,96
111%
2. Railway
3,30,00
11,21
3.3%
3. Ropeway
1,50,00
2,50,16
167%
4. Aviation
60,00
50,96
85%
(b) Communication
75,00
70,71
93%
1. Telephone
25,00
Not available
2. Wireless
25,00
3. Postal
25,00
From the above, the trend of planned expenditures has been encouraging, except in the case of railways.
2. In the Second Plan, 143.5 million rupees were allocated for the transport and communication
development. Of the total outlay,93.5 million rupees or 65 per cent was spent. Details of targeted expenditure in
transport and communication are as follows:
TABLE 76
PLAN OUYTLAY AND EXPENDITURE IN THE TRANSPORT
AND COMMUNICATION SECTOR (1962-65)
Projects
Amount allocated in
Expenditure
Per cent
Second Plan
(a) Transport
13,75,00
8,62,00
63%
1. Road
11,25,00
6,34,00
56%
2. Aviation
2,50,00
2,28,00
91%
(b) Communication
60,00
73,00
120%
3. During the Third Plan, 615 million rupees or 36 per cent of the total outlay in public sector was allocated for
transport and communication. By the fourth year of the Third Plan about 431 million rupees or 25 per cent had
already been spent. If the amount incurred in the fifth or final year Rs. 271.6 million is also added, the total amount
will reach 702,6 million rupees or 40 per cent of the planned target. In other words, expenditure incurred in the
transport and communication sector becomes 4 per cent above the target. The details are given in the following
Table.
TABLE77
FINANCIAL ACHIEVEMENT OF THE TRASPORT AND COMMUNICATION
SECTOR UNDER THE THIRD PLAN PERIOD
Project
Third
Plan
Targets
1
1.
2.
3.
4.
Road
Civil Aviation
Ropeway
railway:
Communication*
Total:
2
50,00,00
0
7,00,000
90,000
3,60,000
61,50,00
Fiscal
1965-67
Original
Estimate*
3
6,19,33
1,19,13
66,81
8,05,27
Fiscal
1966-67
Actual
Espdt.
4
5,69,7
1
1,05,7
7
-,
53,00
7,28,4
8
Fiscal
1967-68
Rs. in Thousand
Fiscal
Fiscal
1965-69
1969-70
Fiscal
1968-69
Original
Estimate*
5
10,05,83
49,53
56,77
Actual
Espdt.
6
8,47,8
0
30,06
35,41
Original
Estimate*
7
10,86,57
14,14
68,57
Actual
Espdt.
8
9,68,04
15,28
51,13
Original
Estimate*
9
13,38,04
58,73
90,90
Actual
Expdt.
10
15,33,20
29,92
71,29
Total of
4+6+8+10
11
39,18,75
1,81,03
2,10,83
Original
Estimate*
12
21,83,82
3,53,79
21,00
1,57,41
11,12,13
9,13,2
7
11,69,28
10,34,4
5
14,67,67
16,34,41
43,10,61
27,16,02
As shown in above Table 77 the capacity to spend in the transport and communication sector, with the
exception of Civil Aviation is quite encouraging. For roads alone, 3191.87 million rupees or 78 per cent was
spent upto the fourth year of the Third Plan. If the 1969-70 budget is also included, the total in the final year
would be 610.37 million rupees or 22 per cent above the target. The reason for this increase in spending
capacity is due to the developments of skill and willingness on the part of concerned authorities. Details of
the expenditure for road development compared to the targeted amount are shown below:
TABLE 78
4. Financial Outlay for the Transport and Communication development during the Fourth
Plan period:
Our economic development is still in the initial stage and as such, more investment must be done in
the transport sector if we are to speed up development. In other words, transport requirements increase more
rapidly than national income in the early years. For example, in many Asian countries the volume of traffic
on roads and railways increased considerably, from 6 to 20 per cent in the 1950s, while national income
increased only to 5 per cent.
In general, project investment decisions should be made in terms of economic benefit. But in the
initial stages, compared to direct and indirect total achievements required in the transport sector will be
greater than other sectors, and the question of whether some portion of the investment should be directed to
other sectors does not arise. In fact, education, health and other development activities in Nepal have been
found to be closely related to the development of transport. More investment in the transport sector should
be made unless and until the preconditions for rapid economic development have been established. Since the
Government controls the entire transport system, it is therefore necessary for the government to invest more
for its expansion. Only then can we expect the mobilization of capital from the private sector in the form of
buses, trucks and other vehicles. This will help in the development of industry, agriculture and trade.
During this Plan, out of 2,550 million rupees allocated to the public sector, 1,050 million or 47 per
cent has been earmarked for the transport and communication sector. This sum will be spent on different
modes of transportation in the following order of priority:
TABLE 79
pattern of expenditures will be as follows: 533.4 million rupees for continuing projects; 91.8 million for the
growth axis roads;31 million rupees for the inter-district facilities; 16.2 million rupees for urban roads; 30
million rupees for the roads to be constructed after the feasibility survey; 9 million rupees for the foot and
mule tracks; 49 million rupees for suspension bridges; 22.5 million rupees for the improvement of roads; and
30.2 million rupees for miscellaneous purposes. The details are given below:
TABLE 80
(Rs. in Millions)
330.4
121.1
8.0
30.0
76.5
57.5
28.3
9.0
203.0
153.0
50.0
91.8
30.0
30.0
1.8
30.0
31.0
16.2
30.0
9.0
49.0
30.0
19.0
22.5
4.0
7.5
6.5
4.5
30.2
20.2
813.1
TABLE 82
PHYSICAL TARGET OF ROAD PROJECTS IN THE FOURTH PLAN
Project
I. Completion of Current projects
(uncompleted activities)
1. Dhalkewar-Jhapa-Jaleshwor Janakpur
2. Simra-Janakpur
3. Narayangadh-Butwal
4. Prithvi Highway
5. Dhangadhi-Dadheldhura
6. Kathmandu-Bhaktapur
II. Completion of current projects (sectorwise
activities on Mahendra Highway)
1. Butwal-Banbasa
2. Road improved on Hetauda-Narayangadh
III.
Growth Axis Road
1. Nepalgunj-Jumla
2. Putlikhet-Baglung-Tukuche
3. Trisuli-Dhunche-Gatlang
4. Dharan-Dhankuta-Khandbari
IV. Inter District, Intra District level roads
1. Gorkha-Prithvi Highway
2. Choutara-Arniko Highway
3. Gaur-Mahendra Highway
4. Krishnanagar-Bahadurgunj-Mahendra
Highway
5. Dang-Mahendra Highway
6. Dhandragadhi-Mahendra Highway
7. Rajbiraj-Mahendra Highway
V. Urban Roads
1. Kathmandu Valley road
2. Other urban roads
VI. Roads to be constructed after feasibility study
Total
length
Black
top
Gravel
Fairweather
Total
867
294
117
122
176
145
13
520
434
83
840
250
280
150
160
150
25
26
33
20
16
16
14
25
15
10
-
477
253
89
122
13
83
83
25
15
10
-
294
156
138
200
200
229
77
80
72
150
25
26
33
20
16
16
14
100
237
237
35
35
-
777
253
89
122
156
138
13
520
437
83
264
77
80
35
72
150
25
26
33
20
16
16
14
25
15
10
100
TABLE 93
Project
1. Kathmandu roads
2. Other urban roads
3. Kathmandu bridges
VI.
1. Lahan-Okhaldhunga
2. Kathmandu-Simra
3. Dang-Jajarkot
4. Jhapa-Taplejung
5. Banepa-Sindhuli-Dhalkewar
6. Bhojpur-Mahendra Highway
7. Thori-Bharatpur
8. Others
VII.
Roads to be improved
1. Raxaul-Hetauda
2. Hetauda-Kathmandu
3. Kathmandu-Trisuli
4. Others (Padma road, Biratnagar-Rangeli,
etc)
VIII. Miscellaneous
1. Feasibility study
Purchasing & Installation of construction
materials, trucks, vehicles and Central
laboratory and office development etc.
330.4
121.1
8.0
30.0
76.5
57.5
28.3
9.0
203.0
153
50.0
91.8
30.0
30.0
1.8
30.0
82.5
31.0
9.0
40.0
42.5
30.0
12.5
22.7
11.2
5.0
6.5
30.0
22.5
4.0
7.5
6.5
4.5
30.2
10.0
20.2
175.1
90.0
6.0
32.5
32.5
14.1
10.8
10.0
0.8
4.0
7.3
7.0
0.3
7.2
4.0
1.0
2.2
0.5
7.9
1.5
1.5
4.0
0.9
25.4
6.0
19.4
98.1
31.1
8.0
22.0
25.0
12.0
50.0
30.0
20.0
2.0
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
9.0
9.0
8.5
6.0
2.5
6.8
2.0
1.0
3.8
1.0
7.4
2.5
1.5
2.5
0.9
3.4
2.6
0.8
32.2
8.0
22.0
2.2
50.0
40.0
10.0
29.8
9.5
9.5
1.3
9.5
9.0
9.0
10.7
6.0
4.7
4.5
3.0
1.0
0.5
9.0
2.4
1.5
0.9
0.5
0.5
-
8.0
8.0
50.0
40.0
10.0
30.0
10.0
10.0
10.0
9.0
9.0
8.0
5.5
2.5
3.2
2.2
1.0
10.0
2.4
1.5
0.9
0.5
0.5
-
42.2
33.0
9.2
30.0
10.0
10.0
10.0
9.0
9.0
8.0
5.5
2.5
1.0
1.0
9.5
2.4
1.5
0.9
0.4
0.4
-
Uncompleted activities.
Rs. 17 million allocated for the construction of the Kamala bridge and Kathmandu-Bhaktapur road is not
shown in the breakdown.
* Sectionwise activities on Mahendra HIghway.
** Includes (1) Gorkha-Prithvi Highway (2) Chantara-Araniko Highway (3) Gaur-Mahendra Highway &
other regional roads.
*** Includes Bardiya, Bhojpur, Gulmi, Illam, Dailekh, Sindhuli, Taplejung, Sankhuwasava, Solukhumbu,
Dolakha, Sindhupalchowk, Rasuwa, Dhading, Gorkha, Manang, Mustang, Dolpa, Tribrikokt, Jumla, Mugh,
Humla, Bhajang, Darchula & Baitadi.
NATIONAL TRANSPORT CORPORATION
The primary aim of this corporation is to play the leading role in traffic operation. Therefore, it has set the
following policies:
(a) To carry out its business in a healthy atmosphere emphasizing the trade motive;
(b) To operate the vehicles on new highway and other roads by just covering the operating costs; and
(c) To base the means of transport as far as possible on resources available in the country.
In accordance with these policies, the Transport Corporation has included the following projects in the
Fourth Plan:
(a) Extension of truck and bus services on Sunouli-Pokhara (Siddartha) and other highways;
(b) Extension and expansion of railway line ( if justified by the feasibility study); and
(c) Operation of Trolly-bus service (if justified by feasibility study)
2.
3.
4.
1. Extension of Truck and Bus services in the Siddartha (Sunouli-Pokhara) and other highways:
The provision of transport facilities o new completed highways will be a desired goal of the
Government, keeping in mind the road network and volume of traffic. This will facilitate the movement of
men and materials, as well as reducing bottlenecks.
Furthermore, the Transport Corporation will be strengthened and made more efficient, thereby
enabling the accessible areas to get the supply of needed materials for construction, industry, etc. in time.
This will also bring uniformity in the shipment of goods and restrict the setting of arbitrary rates.
About 125 additional trucks will be made available for service on the roads to be completed
during the Fourth Plan period. This will help to strengthen the trucking units, and help to complete
construction works in different zones in time.
Extension of Railways (if justified by feasibility study)
Railway services are constructed to be one of the important means of transport. It has occupied a
prominent role in the transportation system of neighbouring countries. In Nepal, it has been possible to
operate railway services in only two places because of the high costs of construction and maintenance. The
railway services operating between Amlekhjung and Raxaul (N.G.R.) has virtually closed down since the
development of parallel surface road in the area. On the other hand the Janakpur-Jayanagar railway service is
operating successfully and has been further extended. In the context of highways expansion, there seems to
be little ground for the further development of railways, although necessary surveys will be undertaken to
study the expansion of such services to feasible areas. In this regard, the feasibility survey for construction of
a broad gauge railway line between Raxaul and Hetauda and Hetauda and Kathmandu will be completed. A
feasibility study will also be undertaken for the extension of railway line from Mahinathpur to Chisapani.
Operation of Trollybus (if justified by feasibility study)
This bus is operated with the use of hydro- electric power. Since the supply of hydro electric-power
in the country is increasing and the need for large quantities of diesel and petrol have necessitated
dependence upon foreign countries, it might be more economic to develop a transport system based upon the
utilization of power. An initial survey will be done about setting up an electrical trolly bus service along
Kathmandu-Bhaktapur route. this route has a large volume of traffic and a wide road is recently being
constructed. Attempts will be made to operate an electric trolly bus service if it is found to be feasible by the
study. Similar surveys will be done in other parts of the country if this project is found to be feasible.
Financial Outlay:
It is estimated that Rs. 2.6 million will be required for the implementation of the above mentioned
projects.
(1) Purchase of additional trucks
Rs. 2.4 million
(2) Survey for railway (Raxaul-Kathmandu ) and
feasibility study of electric bus service
Rs. 0.1 million
Total
_____________
Rs. 2.6 million
TABLE 94
THE ALLOCATION OF OUTLAY FOR THE 125 TRUCKS PURCHASE
DURING THE PLAN PERIOD
Fiscal year
No. of trucks
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
30
25
25
30
25
___
125
Total
Estimated cost
6,00,000
5,00,000
5,00,000
6,00,000
3,00,000
_______
25,00,000
CHAPTER XI
CIVIL AVIATION
The importance of civil aviation is providing easy and speedy transportation facilities to the remote and
inaccessible areas of Nepal is steadily increasing. It is difficult to provide road transportation facilities in a short
period of time to every district in a rugged country like Nepal. Since a long time is often needed (especially in the
initial stages of the construction of roads in the hilly terrans), it has become essential to operate air services in
these regions before making road facilities available. Efforts will thus be continued during the Fourth Plan period
to make available air services in those districts which are considered most essential from the point of view of
economic, social, administrative and national development and to eliminate the transport bottlenecks which have
been standing as a stumbling-block to the overall development of the country.
These has been encouraging development in the fields of civil aviation in the past few years. Air service at the
present time is not limited to domestic flights and flights to India. Services are linked to Pakistan, Burma and
Thailand illustrating an encouraging entry of Nepal into international air-service. In this regard, some of the
existing airfields will be improved and extended, making the take-off and landing of large jet aircrafts possible.
Some other airports will be modernized and renovated as required and will be provided with communication
facilities, aerial navigation instruments and buildings.
equipped with communication, navigational aid, and other facilities. To implement these projects, Rs. 161
million has been allocated during the Plan period. In addition, the Asian Development Bank (ADB) will make
available a loan of Rs. 60.701 million and technical assistance worth Rs. 3.535 million for development of the
airports at Tribhuban (Kathmandu), Pokhara, Simra, Biratnagar and Bhairahawa.
1.
Tribhuban Airport:
The regular service of large aircrafts like Fokker, Caravelle and DC-9s has already begun at the airport.
Since such services are expected to be continued in the future, this airport will be converted into an international
airport. The present runway will be expanded to 3,048 metres from the present length of 1,036 metres. In
addition, the internal and external terminal buildings, the control tower, the cargo terminal, the approach road,
the car parking areas, the hangar and other buildings will be constructed. In addition, provision will be made for
water and the disposal of sewage. This project is estimated to cost Rs. 43.836 million.
2.
During the Plan period, new airports will be constructed in Pokhara, Simra and Nepalgunj. The runway
of these airports will be 1,524, 2,286 and 1,524 meters
(5,000 ft., 7,500 ft., and 5,000 ft.) respectively. New sites will be required for their construction, since the present
airfields are not suitable for further extension. In these airport, taxiway, terminal building, staff quarters,
workshop communication and fire station buildings fuel storage etc. will be constructed.
Pokhara:
After Tribhuban airport, Pokhara is the second busiest airport in the hilly region of Nepal. Recently, the
increase in economic activity and the growing demand for air service to Pokhara has made the operating of
planes bigger than DC-3 necessary. It has been planned to construct an airport with a 1,524 metre (5,000 ft.)
runway at a suitable site. It is estimated that Rs. 24.087 million will be spent during this Plan period for the
various works to be undertaken for the development of Pokhara airport.
Simra:
Simra airport is the nearest to Kathmandu and has thus become essential to construct it as an alternative to
Tribhuban Airport. In case the jet aircraft cannot land at Tribhuban airport, this airport will be used as the
alternative- landing site. The cost of the major construction work to be undertaken at this airport is to be Rs.
29.7825 million during the Fourth Plan period.
Nepaljung:
Nepaljung occupies on important place in the development of far western Nepal. It is not only the main
center for importing and exporting in this area, but also the transportation center for the extension of different
development projects. Moreover, it is centrally located between Dhangadi in the west, Surkhet in the north and
Dang in the east and acts as an operating base for STOL service in that region. For these reasons, this airport
needs reconstruction and modernization to make it an all-weather one. It is estimated that Rs. 16.045 million will
be spent for this purpose.
3.
The runways in Biratnagar and Bhairahawa airports will be extended to 1,525 meter (5,000 ft.). The
approach roads and terminal buildings will also be renovated. These projects are estimated to cost about Rs.
29.51-125 million. During this Plan period Rs. 14.756 million will be spent for each airport.
4.
The construction of a runway at Tumlingtar airport was begun during the Third Plan period in hopes of
providing Dacota (DC-3) air service to the Eastern hilly region of Nepal. The completion of this airport is
envisaged during the Fourth Plan period. For this purpose, about Rs. 2,60,000 will be spent in the Plan period.
This airport will provide additional transport facilities to the inaccessible areas of Mechi, Khoshi and Sagarmatha
Zones.
5.
In addition to the above mentioned airports, airfields at Janakpur, Rajbiraj, Jhapa, Plaungtar, Bharatpur,
Dang, Dhangadi and Surkhet will be modernized and equipped with staff-quarters, fire-stations, N.D.B., and
generator building, etc. All these improvement would make the take-off and landing of aeroplanes of higher
capacity possible. The implementation of this calls for Rs. 3,271,525 which includes Rs. 775,000 for Janakpur,
Rs. 465,000 for Rajbiraj, Rs. 911,525 for Jhapa, Rs. 80,000 for Palungtar, Rs. 140,000 for Bharatpur, Rs.
130,000 for Dang, Rs. 340,000 for Dhangadi and Rs. 430,000 for Surkhet airfield.
6.
STOL air services play an important role in the provision of transportation facilities to Nepals
inaccessible hilly regions, where big aircrafts cannot land. At present, there are 24 such STOL air- fields in the
Kingdom. The three airstrips at Jumla, Baglung and Lamidanda of Khotang have been constructed by the
Department, and two other airstrips at Dipayal in Doti and Safebazar in Accham, are now being renovated by the
Department. In addition, 19 other airstrips constructed by voluntary labour from the local people are now under
regulations of the Department. These include: (1) Mahendra Nagar, (2) Soltar in Kailali, (3) Tikapur, (4)
Ghorahi,
(5) Dhorpatan, (6) Jomsom, (7) Rampur, (8) Hetauda, (9) Goltar in Ramechhap,
(10) Jiri, (11) Ranibas in Dhankuta, (12) Chisapani in Dhankuta, (13) Hardi-Nath in Dhankuta, (14) Kurula in
Udaipur, (15) Amtai in Sirha, (16) Rumjatar, (17) Lukhla, (18) Kampughat and (19) Handiya. In the Fourth Plan
10 additional airstrips will be constructed in Baitadi, Bhajang, Humla, Dailekh, Dolpa, Tribikot, Bhajura,
Rukum, Jomsom and one district in Mechi zone. Jomsom in Mustang, has its own airstrip which simply needs
renovation. This project are estimated to cost Rs. 5,520,000. Airstrips will be constructed only on those sites
which are found by surveys to be feasible.
During the Second Plan, it was planned to construct 20 STOL airstrips but the construction of only four
such strips was completed. The target of the Third Plan for the construction of STOL airstrips was also revised
and the number of airstrips to be constructed was reduced from 20 to 11. The progress achieved so far in this
field is not encouraging. Therefore, the target in the Fourth Plan has not been ambitious so that it can be totally
achieved.
7.
The provision of communication and navigational aid will be undertaken in this Plan period in order to
make air service more secure and efficient. Such facilities have already been provided in Kathmandu and seven
other places. However, the airfields still need them. The airfields that have already been navigational aids are not
fully equipped at present. These airfields will be provided with the necessary communication and other materials.
This project is estimated to cost Rs. 6.9 million.
8.
Administrative building:
The need for an administrative building for the Department has been felt for a long time. Construction of
it is planned during the Fourth Plan period, and it is estimated to cost Rs. 400,000.
9.
Other Arrangements:
Arrangements for the provision of necessary furniture, means of transport, and other machines and
equipments for maintenance will also be made at different airports. For this purpose a sum of Rs. 1,386,474
(including Rs. 250,000 for furniture, Rs. 400,000 for means of transport and Rs. 736,475 for the maintenance of
equipment) has been earmarked in the Fourth Plan.
10.
Manpower:
To implement the above projects an addition of 271 individuals will be required.
TABLE 95
Type
Metre
Feet
1.
Tribhuwan Airport
All-weather
3,048
10,000
2.
Simra Airport
All-weather
2,286
7,500
3.
Pokhara Airport
All-weather
1,524
5,000
4.
Bhairahawa Airport
All-weather
1,524
5,000
1.
Biratnagar Airport
All-weather
1,524
5,000
2.
Nepalgunj Airport
All-weather
1,524
5,000
3.
Janakpur Airport
All-weather
1,006
3,300
4.
Rajbiraj Airport
Fair-weather
1,006
3,300
5.
Jhapa Airport
Fair-weather
1,006
6.
Palungtar Airport
Fair-weather
1,006
3,300
7.
Bharatpur Airport
Fair-weather
1,006
3,300
8.
Fair-weather
1,006
3,300
9.
Surkhet Airport
Fair-weather
1,006
3,300
10.
Dhangadhi Airport
Fair-weather
1,006
3,300
11.
Tumlingtar Airport
Fair-weather
1,006
3,300
12.
STOLS
Fair-weather
3,300
TABLE 96
Actual
Percent
60,00
70,71
118
2,50,000
2,28,00
91
7,00,00
18.13*
Budget Amount
Expended
Remarks
1965-66
1,19,13
1,05,77
1966-67
49,53
30,06
1967-68
14,14
15,28
1968-69
58,73
29,93
Revised
1969-70
3,53,79
2,78,30
Estimated
5,95,32
4,59,34
Total
TABLE 98
(ADB)
Development Bank
To
Project
be
provide
d
by
ADB
as loan
To be borne
by
HMG
Other
Expens
es on
the
project
Estimated total
Expenditur
e
1.
Tribhuwan Airport
2,46,20,000
1,82,15,000
10,00,000
4,38,35,000
2.
Simra Airport
1,40,50,000
1,52,12,500
5,20,000
2,97,82,500
3.
Pokhara Airport
1,12,80,000
1,21,87,000
6,20,000
2,40,87,000
4.
Bhairahawa Airport
1,70,25,000
76,06,250
1,25,000
1,47,56,250
5.
Biratnagar Airport
70,25,000
76,06,250
1,25,000
1,47,56,250
6.
Janakpur Airport
6,40,000
1,35,000
7,75,000
7.
Jhapa Airport
6,40,000
2,71,525
9,11,525
8.
Rajbiraj Airport
3,20,000
1,45,000
7,85,000
9.
STOLS
54,00,000
1,20,000
55,20,000
3,20,000
1,57,25,000
1,60,45,000
2,60,000
2,60,000
1,40,000
1,40,000
1,30,000
1,30,000
3,40,000
3,40,000
80,000
80,000
4,30,000
4,30,000
69,00,000
69,00,000
4,00,000
4,00,000
13,86,475
13,86,475
2,88,53,000
16,10,00,000
17. Communication
other arrangement
and
4,00,000
Transportation
2,50,000
7,36,475
6,40,00,000
6,81,47,000
TABLE 99 (A)
ANNUAL EXPENDITURE FOR THE AVIATION DEVELOPMENT DURING
THE FOURTH PLAN (1970-75)
(In Rupees)
Project
Projects to
be financed
separately
by HMG
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
1.
Tribhuwan Airport
10,00,000
Simra Airport
5,20,000
10,00,00
0
2.
5,20,000
6,20,000
6,20,000
1,25,000
1,25,000
1,25,000
2,71,525
1,25,000
1,30,000
1,35,000
1,41,525
1,45,000
1,35,000
1,20,000
1,45,000
1,57,25,000
1,20,000
2,60,000
18,40,00
0
36,75,00
0
51,65,00
0
50,25,000
20,000
1,40,000
2,60,000
1,30,000
1,15,000
25,000
3,40,000
1,00,000
30,000
25,000
80,000
1,15,000
2,00,000
30,000
4,30,000
50,000
30,000
69,00,000
2,25,000
1,75,000
2,95,000
4,00,000
21,70,00
0
18,70,00
0
14,45,00
0
11,20,00
0
4,00,000
6,95,000
4,35,000
1,91,475
35,000
57,76,52
5
56,00,00
0
53,41,47
5
67,00,0054,35,000
0
3.
Pokhara Airport
4.
Bhairahawa
Airport
5.
Biratnagar Airport
6.
Bhadrapur Airport
7.
Janakpur Airport
8.
Rajbiraj Airport
9.
STOLS
10.
Nepalgunj Airport
11.
Tumlingtar Airport
12.
Bharatpur Airport
13.
Dang Airport
14.
Dhangadhi Airport
15.
Palungar Airport
16.
Surkhet Airport
17.
Communication
Material
18.
Administrative
Building
13,86,475
30,000
19.
Capital
Equipments on item 10 of
the budget
Total
2,88,53,000
TABLE 99 (B)
(Rs. in Thousand)
Project
A.D.B.
H.M.G.
Total
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
1. Tribhuwan Airport
2,46,20
1,82,15
42835
12835
10000
10000
10000
2. Simra Airport
1,40,50
1,52,12
29262
12165
6000
6000
5975
3. Pokhara Airport
1,12,80
1,21,87
23467
8500
5000
5000
4967
4. Bhairahawa Airport
70,25
76,06
14631
5000
3500
35000
2631
5. Biratnagar Airport
70,25
76,06
14631
3100
4000
4000
3531
6. Bhadrapur Airport
6,40
640
450
190
7. Janakpur Airport
640
640
640
8. Rajbiraj Airport
320
320
320
9. STOLS
5400
5400
1080
1080
1080
1080
1080
10.
Nepalgunj
Airport
320
320
320
Total
64000
68147
132147
44410
29770
29580
27307
10,80
Total of Table A
28843
5776
5600
5341
6700
5435
161000
50186
35370
34921
34007
6515
TABLE 99 (C)
DEVELOPMENT OF AIRFIELDS DURING VARIOUS PLAN PERIOD
Achievements
Projects
prior
Plan
to
First
1.
Allweather
1- Kathmandu
Achievements of
First Plan
Achievements
of Second Plan
Achievements
of Third Plan
Total
3-Biratnagar,
Janakpur,
Bhairhawa. In
addition, the
runway
at
Tribhuban
Airport
has
been extended
to 6,600 ft.
airfield
2.
Fair
weather
4Pokhara
Bhairhawa
7Bharatpur
Dhangadhi
airfield
Simra
Dang Rajbiraj
Biratnagar
Janakpur
Palungtar
3.
STOLS
1- Jhapa
3- Surkhet
11
Meghauli
Tumlingtar
(Under
Construction)
3- Jumla
3- Khotan
Baglung
Doti Achham
Jiri
(Improvement
activities going
on)
TABLE 99 (D)
TARGETS OF THE AVIATION DEVELOPMENT IN THE FOURTH PLAN
Project
Position
Targets of
Expected Position
As of 1969-70
of 1974-75
No.
No.
No.
Location
Location
Location
4-
11-
3. STOL airfield:
5-
Kathmandu,
Janakpur,
Bhairahawa
Biratnagar
3&
Simra, Pokhara,
Nepalgunj,
Bharatpur,Dang,
Surkhet,
Dhangadhi,
Rajbiraj,
Palungtar, Jhapa
& Meghauli
Jhapa, Baglung,
Jiri, Lamidanda
of
Khotang,
Dipial of Doti
110-
Simra, Pokhara
&
Nepalgunj.
Also, run-way
length will be
increased in all
airports.
79-
Tumlingtar
Baitadi,
Baglung,
Humla, Dailekh,
Dolpa, Tibrakot,
Bajura,
Rukum,Jomsom.
One place in
Mechi Zone.
Kathmandu,
Biratnagar,
Simra,
Bhairahawa,
Pokhara,
Janakpur &
Nepalgunj.
Dang,
Surkhet,
Dhangadhi,
Rajbiraj,
Palungtar,
Bhadrapur,
Bharatpur
Financial Outlay:
The Royal Nepal Airlines Corporation will invest Rs. 123 million to execute the above programme during
the Fourth Plan period. The total outlay will be spent as follows:
(a) Purchase of Additional Aircrafts (one medium size jet, three
STOL planes and spare parts)
Rs. 1,00,000,000
Rs.
2,000,000
Rs.
10,000,000
Rs.
500,000
Rs.
300,000
Rs.
250,000
Rs.
1,300,000
Rs.
2,000,000
Rs.
1,500,000
Rs.
2,500,000
Rs.
100,000
Rs.
2,5000,000
Rs.
123,000,000
Total
Source of Finance
The sources of finance for the education of the above total programmes are given below:
(a) Compensation of AF-27 and sale of DC-3 plane
45,000,000
3,350,000
10,000,000
64,650,000
Total
Rs. 123,000,000
All the above mentioned programmes for the development of air transportation are related to each other.
Therefore, the programmes of both the Department of Civil Aviation and the Royal Nepal Airlines Corporation
need to be implemented in order to achieve the target of the Plan. It is evident that if the target of one were to
remain unfulfilled, it would be difficult to meet the target of other.
Therefore, attempts will be made to implement the projects by coordinating the efforts of the two agencies.
Though the Royal Nepal Airlines Corporation is an autonomous organization, His Majestys Government has
given due consideration to its importance and has given it necessary protection and aid many times. The tradition
will be continued during this Plan period as well.
Although only Rs. 100 million will be spent by His Majestys Government during the Plan period, the
willingness shown by His Majestys Government in making additional amounts available to the Royal Nepal
Airlines Corporation and to the provision of assistance and facilities of other kinds have proven to be great
support and will remain so in the future.
CHAPTER XII
TELECOMMUNICATION
Telecommunication service was first started in Nepal in the year 1913. Telephone service between
Kathmandu and Raxaul, extending for a length of 110 Km. was established in 1914. Telephone lines, extending
for a length of 518 Km. between Kathmandu and Dhankuta were installed in the year 1936. In addition, a 240
Km. telephone line was installed linking Palpa and Kathmandu in 1951. Similarly, 25 automatic telephone lines
were also installed in Kathmandu in the year 1935.
Another chapter in the development of telecommunication service in Nepal extends from 1951 to 1956.
An additional, telephone line was established in 1953 linking Palpa with Bhairahawa. In the same manner, a 29
Km. long telephone line was installed from Kathmandu to Dhulikhel. A Central Battery (C.B.)telephone
exchange was eatablished in Kathmandu in the year 1950 and telephone service was made available to the
general public. Further extension of telephone lines to a capacity of 300 was completed in 1957.
Wireless service in Nepal was started in 1950. At that time, the service was limited to Kathmandu,
Bhairahawa, Illam, Dhankuta and Biratnagar. This service was further extended to Doti, Dang, Jumla, Dailekh,
Sallyan, Okhaldhunga and Rajbiraj in the year 1952 and to Jaleshwar, Ramechhap, Bandipur, Terathum,
Taplejung, Dandeldhura and Baitadi at a later date. Three more such stations were set-up in Baglung, Palpa and
Dhangadi in the same year. Similarly, new stations were added in Pokhara, Bhojpur and Birgunj.
Formerly, telecommunication services were under the Department of Communications, which also had
the responsibility of looking after the postal services of the country. The national development of
telecommunication services in a planned, coordinated, and controlled way was started after 1959 when the
Department of Telecommunication was established.
Present Position
1.
With the implementation of the First Plan, new turns in the development of telecommunication service had
taken place, not only to meet the needs of administration and security but also to develop different facilities
for education, industry, trade and the general public. Accordingly, an automatic telephone exchange system
with a capacity of 3,000 lines was installed in Kathmandu. So far, 1,120 lines, including 120 lines in Singha
Durbar have been installed.
2.
In the Second Plan period, the construction of different wireless stations started in the First Plan was
completed, replacing the 28 existing stations which were out of order by that time. In addition, 50 satellite
stations in different districts and 7 area control stations in Kathmandu, Jaleswor, Biratnagar, Pokhara,
Bhairahawa, Nepaljung and Dhangadi were also installed. An International Telecommunication service was
started with the establishment of two circuit to Calcutta and Delhi in India. Also, two teleprinters were
installed to excahange message quickly as possible.
In the field of telephone services, a telephone exchange was established in Bhaktapur. In
Kathmandu, 12 local centers were set up for the use of the general public. The establishment of
telecommunication stations between India and Nepal was also completed. Within this period, major work
regarding the establishment of telecommunication service between Nepal and Pakistan was also completed.
3.
In the Third Plan period, since the existing exchange of 100 lines telephone service proved very
insufficient in meeting the demand, an additional 4,000 lines in Kathmandu city and 600 lines in Lalitpur
(Patan) were installed. In Biratnagar, the total capacity of the telephone lines was increased to 400 with the
installation of an additional 100 lines. The establishment of the Kathmandu-Raxaul Trunk Line was also
completed as scheduled. In the Birgunj automatic telephone project, estimates on the installation of internal
and external equipment were completed, together with 30 per cent of the construction work on the main
building. The Kathmandu-Calcutta wireless project has been completed ahead of the schedule and the
services have been operated on an experimental basis with the installation of all necessary equipment. By the
fourth year of the Plan, wireless stations have been installed in five more districts. By the end of the Third
Plan, wireless services have been made available in about all of the 14 zones and 75 districts. The annual
achievements of the Plan accordance with the targets are given below:
TABLE 100
PHYSICAL TARGET AND ANNUAL PROGRESS OF THE THIRD PLAN
Name of the Projects
Target 1965-66
1966-67
1967-68
1968-69
1969-70
1. Wireless
23
12
2. Kathmandu Telephone
372
128
437
849
3. Biratnagar CB Telephone
400
300
100
Work
Done
Being
-
completion of
construction work
50 % completed
Target
To be completed
Kathmandu
2.
Bhaktapur
3.
Hetauda
4.
Malangwa
5.
Janakpur
6.
Rajbiraj
7.
Dharan
8.
Biratnagar
9.
10. Pokhara
11. Nepalgunj
12. Bhairahawa
To be completed
To be completed
To be completed
The target of annual programme of the above mentioned projects will be as follows:
TABLE 101
ANNUAL PROGRAMME OF THE TELECOMMUNICATION DURING
Name of the Projects
1. Kathmandu Telex
1970-71
-
2.
BhairahawaGorakhpur
&
Nepalgunj-Lucknow
Telephone service
3. Local Telephone
exchange:
(a) Kathmandu
(c) Bhaktapur
Building
construction,
design estimate
Order
for
goods
&
design estimate
Site selection,
building
(d) Hetauda
(e) Malangwa
(f) Janakpur
(g) Rajbiraj
(h)Dharan
Site selection,
building
construction
-
Building
construction,
design,
estimate
-
1973-74
Fitting works
1974-75
-
Sites election,
building
construction,
design & order
Fitting works
Design
estimate, order
placement &
fitting
Estimation
order
for
projects
execution
Do
Fitting works
Construction,
order
for
design
estimate
Do
Fitting works
Fitting works
Do
Order
goods
fittings
Do
Do
Do
Do
Do
Fitting works
Do
Building
construction,
design,
estimate
Order for gods
Site selection,
building
construction,
order
placement.
Do
Order
placement
goods
Fittings
(i) Biratnagar
Site selection,
building
construction
Do
(j) Jhapa
Do
Do
Do
(k) Pokhara
Order
goods
(l) Bhairahawa
Land
acquisition for
building
constructin
Design
estimate,
building
construction
Do
of
for
&
for
(m) Nepalgunj
4.
KathmanduNepalgunj Wireless
services
5.
KathmanduBhaktapur carrier
6. Microwave
Land
acquisition,
building
construction.
Order
for
goods
Order
design
estimate.
Order
for
goods
Land
acquisition,
building
construction.
for
Fitting works
Fitting works
Fitting works
Completion of
Fitting works
Order place
Design
estimate,
building,
construction.
Order
goods
Complete for
fitting works &
in service
Service
available
for
The cost of establishing, maintaining, and repairing the Telex system is higher than the
wireless system. However, this system is used mostly by individuals or institutions connected
with trade and industry, and the service is highly beneficial to such individuals or institutions.
In Kathmandu, an International Telex System with 100 lines capacity (which can be increased
to 300 if necessary) will be established to cater to the increasing needs for trade, hotel
services, tourism, industry etc. This form of communication service will help to directly
increase the revenue of His Majesty's Government by helping in the extension of trade and
industry.
5.2 Tele-Communication Training Centre
In Nepal, Tele-communication services has been expanding at an increasing rate in the
last eight years. The local exchange lines have increased from 300 lines to 5,400 lines, and the
number of wireless stations has gone up from 26 to 70. International services have been
established as well. The telecommunication services will definitely be expanding at an
increasing pace in the future. Therefore, it is obvious that many trained people are needed to
implement new projects and to continue the services smoothly. At present, the number of
trained people is very limited, compared to the expansion of this service. Naturally it is not
possible to implement any new projects effectively or to run the existing services effectively.
At present there is no institute to provide training or study courses in the field of
telecommunication, nor is here any programme to establish one in the future. The problem is
to establish a training center in accordance with the needs of the Department. Training
facilities will be provided in different fields according to needs. The duration of the t raining
course will be two to three years. Training will be provided to thirty persons annually.
Necessary funds, in the form of assistance, will be made available for this purpose from the
United Nations Special Fund. This will include the service of technical experts and
equipments. The local expenses, on the other hand, will be borne by His Majesty's
Government. Arrangements for training regarding telephone services will be made as a part of
the present engineering Institute. This will reduce the administrative expenses of setting up a
separate training center and will enable the Institute to run at full capacity.
5.3 Bhairahawa-Gorakhpur and Lucknow-Nepalgunj wireless service:
Except Tribikot Wireless services have been established in all districts of Nepal. But,
international wireless services and the telex service are conducted only through Kathmandu.
This has put an excessive pressure upon Kathmandu and it has not been possible to make
International Telecommunication service as prompt as in other countries. Because of rising
demand, the problem will become more acute. The only solution is to make international
telecommunication services available in the Eastern and Western parts of the country through
the construction of an East-West microwave system. At present, there should be direct linkage
between Biratnagar and Calcutta in the East and Nepalgunj and Lucknow in the West. In order
to achieve this, it is necessary to conclude necessary arrangements between Nepal and India,
and necessary arrangements should be made for the construction and the establishment of
telecommunication offices at Bhairahawa and Nepalgunj. With the completion of the project,
it would be very convenient to quickly exchange conversation and promptly deliver messages.
It would also help to generate excess revenue to the Government. Naturally, it will help the
Government in its efforts to increase revenue.
5.4 Local Telephone Exchange:
In accordance with the need to establish telephone exchange projects in different zones
and districts in order to meet the need of increasing trade and transaction and expanding
industrialization, it has been planned to install local telephone exchange at 13 places:
Kathmandu, Lalitpur (Patan), Bhaktapur, Hetauda, Bhairahawa, Janakpur, Rajbiraj, Dharan,
Biratnagar, Jhapa, Pokhara, Malangawa, and Nepalgunj. Out of this, there is a programme to
install three exchange projects within Kathmandu Valley, one in the inner Terai, six in the
Eastern Terai, two in the Western Terai, and one in the hilly region.
Kathmandu:
5,600 telephone lines (including 600 in Patan) have been installed by the end of
the Third Plan. However, it became necessary to install 5,300 additional telephone lines
within a decade. The main reason behind this is the increasing volume of trade and
transactions, the activity in social and other sectors, andin the administrative matter of being
the capital of the country. In view of growing number of transactions aand the increasing
demand for telephone lines, 5,000 additional automatic telephone lines will be installed in the
Plan period. It will help in the expansion of trade and industry and indirectly increasing
Government revenue. It will also provide a facility of the modern era to the general public.
Lalitpur (Patan)
Because Lalitpur is one of the three main cities of the Kathmandu Valley, the
600 telephone lines installed at present are not sufficient to meet the increasing demand.
Therefore, 400 additional lines will be installed in the Plan period.
Bhaktapur:
Bhaktapur, is one of the other important cities of Kathmandu Valley and is
located 13 kilometres away from the city of Kathmandu. In spite of its importance as a
commercial city, it has not yet been provided with telephone facilities. Therefore, telephone
lines will be distributed after the installation of one telephone exchange with the capacity of
200 lines.
Hetauda:
Hetauda is one of the main industrial centers of Narayani Zone. It has been felt
that local telephone and trunk telephone lien facilities should be made available at this town if
possible. A manual telephone exchange project with a capacity of 100 lines will be
implemented to meet the growing needs of trade and industry in this area.
Malangwa:
Since a microwave communication system will pass through this area, to make
available telephone and trunk telephone service, telephone exchange is essential to establish.
A capacity of 50 lines telephone exchange will be installed during the Plan period on the basis
of population, industry and commercial development.
Janakpur:
Biratnagar:
Although a C.B. telephone exchange with a capacity of 400 lines has already
been installed, the present capacity has not been sufficient to meet the growing demand caused
by the increasing population, trade and industries in this city. Therefore, an automatic
telephone exchange with the capacity to distribute up to 5,000 lines, as required, will be
installed in the near future. At the initial stage, it will supply 2500 lines only.
Jhapa:
Taking into account the volume of trade and industrial expansion, it can be
considered to be one of the important centers of the country. In addition, as the East-West
Microwave will pass through the city, it is necessary to establish telephone exchange station.
Therefore, a manual telephone exchange station with the capacity of 100 lines will be installed
during the Plan period.
Pokhara:
Besides being an unique tourist spot, its importance has been further increased
by the construction of the Sidhartha and the Prithvi Highways which have brought rapid social
and economic change, thus the target of the Fourth Plan is to install a manual telephone
exchange station with a capacity of 150 lines.
Nepalgunj:
Nepalgunj is an important commercial and industrial center in Western Nepal.
To meet local requirements one manual telephone exchange station with a capacity of 200
telephone lines will be established.
Bhairahawa:
Bhairahawa is one of the important commercial centers in Mid-Western Nepal.
A telephone exchange with a capacity of 100 telephone lines will be established during the
Plan period.
5.5 Kathmandu-Nepalgunj Wireless Station
The target of the Fourth Plan is to operate trunk telephone lines in order to
make direct conversation between Kathmandu and Nepalgunj possible. It will help increase
Government revenue, provide facilities for commerce and industry, and reduce some social
inconveniences.
5.6 Kathmandu-Bhaktapur Carrier Service:
Considering the growing population and the increasing trade of Bhaktapur city,
another of the important centers in Kathmandu Valley, it is now necessary to join the
Bhaktapur exchange with that of Kathmandu. Therefore, a necessary trunk line will be
installed to link Bhaktapur telephone exchange project with Kathmandu. This will help
increase the Government revenue.
5.7 East-West Microwave:
Since the existing telecommunication line has proven insufficient to meet
increasing demand, it has been deemed necessary to install a modern trunk telephone line.
Accordingly, this project is formulated to install a micro wave system which will help to link
important centers within the country and also make it possible to establish direct contact with
outside world. Its speciality is the establishment of a system which makes quick delivery of
messages and conversations between different parties simultaneously without any wire
connections. With the installation of this project, as in the case of trunk telephone lines, it will
help to overcome the deficiencies of the present wireless system in which conversation is
possible only between two persons. It will have 120 channels initially, although necessary
equipment will be installed to enable its capacities to be increased to 600 channels.
In the Fourth Plan, a microwave system will be installed in Kathmandu,
Birgunj, Janakpur, Rajbiraj, Biratnagar, Dharan, Jhapa, Pokhara and Ghairahawa. The
installation of a high level microwave system will help to increase the flow of communication
and also to increase Government revenue directly. In the coming five year period, a 100 per
cent increase in revenue from the communication service is expected.
5.8 Kathmandu-Raxual Trunk Telephone System and Birgunj Telephone
Exchange:
Table 102
PHYSICAL AND FINANCIAL TARGET OF THE TELECOMMUNICATION
DEVELOPMENT IN THE FOURTH PLAN
(Rs. in Thousand)
Name of the project
Target
Expenditure
1. Kathmandu Telex
Establishment
11,85
Establishment
4,000
1. Bhairahawa-Gorakhpur &
Nepalgunj-Lucknow
Telecommunication servie
2. Local Telephone Exchange:
(a) Kathmandu
11,200
(c) Bhaktapur
(i) Biratnagar ( )
7,50
6,50
8,40
2,50
Establishment
51
6. Microwave
Establishment
1,26,06
7. Kathmandu-Raxual Telephone
3. Kathmandu-Bhaktapur
Carrier Service
4. Kathmandu-Nepalgunj
Wireless service
Exchange
Total
3,67,50
Expenditure up to date:
Out of the total resources for communication development Rs. 235,26 million
was allocated for telecommunication. By the fourth year of the Plan, about Rs. 152.61 million
or 65 per cent of the total allocation has been spent. Expenditure incurred in the different
projects is given below:
Table 103
ANNUAL EXPENDITURE INCURRED IN THE TELECOMMU NICATION
DEVELOPMENT IN THE THIRD PLAN
(In Rupees)
1966-67
196768
1968-69
Total
196970
30740
1299760
Telephone
65
1203605
Exchange
218290
21437
46903
1. Central
2. Wireless
Extension
90001
1157680
495354
70972
107620
23321
Extension
Complet
0
77
ed
4. Kathmandu-
46445
81572
Not
Not
Decided
Telecommunicati
on
7. KathmanduCalcutta
teleprinter
service2
8. Kathmandu-Delhi
Wireless service
9. BiratnagarCalcutta
Telephone
Service
773500
520838
360340
49000
81572
168100
81000
250200
Implementat
ion
For
6. Nepal-India
476500
spent
5. Nepal-Pakistan
14614
17399
240868
Telephone
800000
C.B. -
3700000
99905
3. Biratnagar
600000
643152
Total
35441
2868463
04
33925
5460654
71
152656
104800
92
According to the above table, it is clear that Rs. 152.65 million have been spent
by the fourth year of the Plan. In each succeeding year there has been an increase in the
capacity to spend in the field of telecommunication development. The budget estimates and
expenditure incurred are given below:
Table 104
BUDGET ESTIMATES AND EXPENDITURES DURING THE
THIRD PLAN PERIOD
Fiscal Year
Budget
Expenditure
Per cent
1965-66
38,56,690
35,44,004
92
1966-67
34,14,790
28,64,463
84
1967-68
39,78,000
33,99,571
85
1968-69
1,66,58,000
54,60,654
33
1969-70
1,04,78,000
Unavailable
Total
3,83,85,480
1,52,68,692
Although allocations for the telecommunication sector have increased by 63 per cent, there has been
only a 39 per cent increase in actual expenditures as shown in the above table. However, if the expenditures
incurred in the Kathmandu-Calcutta Telex project are also included, the total expenditure would be in much
closer accord with the budget.
In the Fourth Plan Rs. 367.5 million will be spent in the different projects shown in the following Table:
Table 105
ANNUAL ALLOCATION OF EXPENDITURE IN THE FOURTH PLAN
Project
1.
2.
Kathmandu Telex
Bhairahawa-Gorkkpur,
Nepalgunj-Lucknow
telecommunication
3. Local
Telephone
Exchange:
(a) Kathmandu
(b) Lalitpur (Patan)
(c) Bhaktapur
(d) Detauda
(e) Malangwa
(f) Janakpur
(g) Rajbiraj
(h) Dharan
(i) Biratnagar
(j) Jhapa
(k) Pokhara
(l) Bhairahawa
(m) Nepalgunj
4. Kathmandu-Bhaktapur
Carrier Service
5. Kathmandu-Nepalgunj
Wireless Service
6. East-West Microwave
7. Birgunj
Telephone
Exchange
Total
Total
Expenditure
1,185
400
10,600
1,120
740
650
398
850
650
1,670
2,760
650
750
650
840
250
51
12,606
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
137
200
300
400
137
200
30
1,260
296
400
185
376
198
400
137
570
1,100
376
200
137
400
150
21
2,400
593
1,325
500
370
137
200
240
376
500
1,000
137
400
376
240
100
5,000
296
200
4,100
220
185
137
300
200
150
137
2,400
200
4,175
1,546
36,750
CHAPTER XIII
POSTAL DEVELOPMENT
Role of Postal Service in the development of the country:
There has been a considerable increase in the number of educated and literate persons in modern Nepal.
The importance and necessity of the postal services has been increased because of a larger number of persons
going outside the country for the purpose of traveling or for earning a living an increase I the internal and
external trade of the country, as well as several other reasons. Since surface roads are an important means of
transportation, there is great need for the promotion and development of the postal service as a means of
communications. It has occupied an indispensable place in the society by providing an easily available and cheep
service to the general public. In a country like Nepal, with an undeveloped system of transportation and a rugged
topography, the postal service is the most easily available and extensive method of contact at Governmental,
institutional, family, and person to person levels. In addition, the postal service is the only means of establishing
contact in most parts of the country. Furthermore, this sate of affairs is likely to continue for a few more decades.
Since the availability of a postal service constitutes an integral part of the necessary development infrastructures,
the postal service programme must be implemented as vigorously as in the previous Plan period.
Historical Review:
Historically speaking, regular postal services in the country seem to have originated from the system
established by Prithvi Narayan Shah to exchange news which was essential to the process of national unification.
There was no big problem of internal communication between small principalities and states into which Nepal
was then divided. On the other hand, a regular system for the exchange of letters and news from one place of the
country to the other became necessary for administrative and national security reasons after unification made the
country larger. Although the postal service was originally established to meet the requirements of administration
and national security, it has now developed into a large-scale national system for the service of the people, as
well. It has become essential and indispensable for public service.
Historically, the origin of the present post office dates back to the year 1878. The first postage stamps of
1,2 and 4 annas were issued after the establishment of the General Post Office in 1881. After six years, post card
were introduced in 1887. In 1913, postmen were paid to carry mail all over the country, except for the district of
Jumla. In 1900, (Bairung service), and in 1933, money order services were introduced on an experimental basis.
But these services could not continue for long. Although postage stamps of different denominations had been
issued, there were not, however, for a long period recognized in the outside world. In order to get recognition of
Nepalese postage by neighbouring counties a Nepal-India bilateral agreement was signed in 1936 with regard t
correspondence and unregistered mail. Post exchange offices were established in eight different border areas of
the two countries. This was, undoubtedly, an important step for Nepal in the development of an international
postal system. Two more important steps in the modernization of the postal administration were taken with the
establishment of sub-inspectors office in 1935 and seven postal circle offices in 1940.
After the revolution of 1950, the postal services were further expanded. Nepal obtained membership in
the World Postal Union in 1956, and about two years later, eight additional exchange offices were established in
the southern border areas. Changes were also made in the precious bilateral agreements with India. The new
agreement included some supplementary ones and was made more applicable to the modern world. Since April
1959, Nepals international postal services have widened as a member of World Postal Union. With the aim of
increasing the sale of Nepalese stamps in the national and international philatelic markets, the Nepal Philatelic
Bureau was established in 1962. Internal airmail was introduced in 1958 and external air mail in 1959. Instead of
the former Postal Circles, Postal Control Offices were organized in seven zones in 1960 in order to make postal
administration more efficient and scientific.
The pace of development in the field of postal services has been faster since 1960. The Postal Training
Centre was set-up during the Second Plan in 1962. in the same month, mail service was carried with the help of
the third organization (party) and the Indian railways in order to speed up internal service. The internal insurance
service was started in 1962. Postal legislation confirming to international regulations and the modern age was
passed in April 1962. Bairung service was resources-started throughout the Kingdom in April 1963. in
accordance with the Nepal-India agreement, international insurance mail and parcel service were started in April
1965. Consequently, the Indian Embassy Post Office which had functioned for the last 150 years was closed
down, and the Kathmandu Foreign Post Office was established. Since it was necessary to set-up a Central Office
for carrying the mails to the proper destinations and for the timely sorting of mail coming from surface or air
routes, the mail center was established on September 1965. The Postal Inspection Office was set-up in 1966 in
order to prevent postal crimes and to settle any case which arises. A Postal Commodity Store as also established.
With the aim of providing a facility to consumers for easy monetary transaction in small amounts, the Postal
Order Service was started in April 1966. A Dead Letter Centre was established in 1968 in order to investigate
undelivered mail, to find the proper address, and to deliver it.
2. Main Posts
14
90
4. Branch Posts
198
5. Extra Posts
153
6. Cooperative Posts
244
7. Other Offices
26
_________________
Total:
726
With the exception of 20 administrative offices, there are 706 regional (area) offices providing services
for the public use. The total population of the country before the beginning of the Fourth Plan has been estimated
to be 11,44,000 over an area of 54,362 square miles. Accordingly, each postal office is serving a population of
15,643 and in area of 77 square miles,
Present
position
90
198
153
37
35
Target of
the Plan
5
50
550
25
2
1
30
Total
95
248
703
62
2
1
65
2
2
1
5
-
2
2
1
5
-
Sub post:
The ratio between sub and branch post offices has been determined to be ten to one. This is the same as
the ratio between the government and additional post. But in some strategic areas it has become essential to setup
sub-post offices and to upgrade some of the branch offices because of growing responsibility during the Plan
period. Keeping in view all these pros and cons, about 20 sub-post offices are urgently needed. It has been
envisaged to set-up 5 sub-posts during the Plan period (or one per year) and to expand them more economically
as soon as possible.
2.
Branch posts:
In the previous Plan, about 100 sub-post offices were established. But in accordance with the policy of
establishing the less expensive post, during the Fourth Plan, only 50 post offices will be established.
3.
Additional post:
Because of the above mentioned reasons, about 550 additional post offices will be established during this Plan
period. According to estimates, one post office is supposed to serve for a population of 3,000 to 5,000.
Therefore, the number of posts should be increased considerably, keeping in view the pattern of scattered
settlement and the rugged topography of the country. Thus in this Plan period efforts will be made to set up 550
posts.
After completion of three projects dealing with the extension of postal services mentioned above, the total
number of postal offices will be 1,331. The population of Nepal during the Fourth Plan has been projected to
reach 12 million. The area of Nepal is 54,362 square miles, each postal office will serve on the average, an area
of 41.5 square miles and a population of 9,153.
4.
Postal line:
In a country like Nepal with a decentralized administrative system at the local level, the exchange of letters
within and between the units via a speedy and direct route of communication is essential for development
programmes and administration. Thus in the Fourth Plan, 25 additional postal lines will be set up in order to set
the distance of postal routes.
5.
Mail services:
Some portions of the Mahendra Highway, the Prithvi Highway, the Siddartha Highway and the Zonal
& district roads are nearing completion. They will be serviceable for all weather , therefore, mail service in 10
divisions will be carried out on a contract basis. Similarly, in the remote and inaccessible area, new STOL airfields are being constructed and made serviceable. This will mean that air mail will be made available in 6
divisions.
6.
Commodity Store:
The necessary resources will be made available to acquire papers, stamps, mailing bags, weights and
other measures and counter machines etc., which are essential for carrying out the administration of the postalservices.
7.
The Central Commodity Store, which has to act as a Super Commodity Store in supplying the needed
materials for several offices scattered in 75 districts of the country and inside the country and then in storing them
for later distribution throughout the country. It has, therefore, been planned to set up regional offices in
Biratnagar and in Nepaljung.
8.
Commodity Workshop:
The necessity of being self sufficient in such technical goods such as stamps and letter boxes has been
recognized, and therefore, a Commodity Centre will be set up in a miniature form, having only limited production
capacity. This will be operated on an experimental basis.
9.
Building Construction:
The lack of Government buildings for postal services is one of the major bottlenecks. Also the available
buildings often cannot fulfill the requirements of the area. This has been creating a problem in the efficiency and
skill of administration. About 80 per cent of the postal buildings are now rented. Therefore, in this Plan period,
greater emphasis will be given to the construction of new postal buildings. Under the building construction
programme, about 30 postal buildings will be completed in the following districts:
1. Kathmandu
2. Sindhupalchowk
3. Parsa
4. Routahat
5. Ramechhap
6. Sarlahi
7. Bhojpur
8. Okhaldhunga
9. Illam
10. Dhankuta
11. Sunsari
12. Gulmi
13. Gorkha
14. Shyangja
15. Baglung
16. Dang
17. Sallyan
18. Surkhet
19. Dailekh
20. Jumla
21. Doti
22. Baitadi
23. Dadeldhura
24 . Bhaktapur
25. Janakpur
26. Manang
27. Banke
28. Sindhuli
1
Total:
30
outside and inside the country. Moreover, a sales organization in the philatelic center of the United Nations will
be made through a bilateral agreement with the United Nations.
11. Training Development Programme:
In view of increased demand for trained personnel in the postal services during the Fourth Plan period,
efforts will be made to make the present training system more productive both qualitatively and quantitatively.
The following work will be included under training:
1.
2.
3.
To modernize the postal training Center, providing audiovisual equipment and other needed materials for
training.
4.
5.
To arrange the specially trained and other needed staff for training .
To organize and conduct the internal insurance letter programme which was started in previous years
and to make it more widely used as soon as possible.
2.
To improve and give wide recognition to the postal order services which proved to be successful in
the Third Plan.
3.
4.
To set up the postal savings banks if proved feasible by experimentation at a selected post office.
Entering into two extensive multilateral agreements regarding international insurance letters and parcel
services formulated under the sponsorship of U.P.O. and to make such agreements (which had been only
bilateral in the preceeding plan period) complete and extensive.
2.
3.
To establish three exchange postal offices in the three northern or southern border centers for
international postal exchange.
4.
To operate money order services on the basis of a bilateral agreement with India.
Target of
Amount in the
_______
Plan
Thousands of Rs.
1.
Sub-post
210
2.
Branch post
50
5,486
3.
Additional post
550
4,600
4.
Postal Line
25
1,400
5.
Mail Service
1,200
6.
2,500
7.
22
200
8.
Commodity Workshop
500
9.
30
3,000
10.
Philatelic Development
Building Construction
500
11.
250
12.
50
13.
Postal Museum
125
14.
200
15.
Internatinal Service
350
16.
50
17.
3,850
Total:
24,451
N.B.: Of the total outlay, expenditure relating to No. 9 and No. 11 projects come under development according
to newly adopted budget definition. Hence, in the Fourth Plan, Rs. 3,250,000 only has been shown as an outlay
for Postal Development.
TABLE 106 (A)
POSTAL DEVELOPMENT
ANNUAL ALLOCATION OF EXPENDITURE DURING
FOURTH PLAN PERIOD
Project
Total
1970-71
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
3,00,000
6,00,00
0
8,00,000
2,50,000
5,00,00
0
7,00,000
Training Development
4,00,00
0
15,464
84,872
50,000
52,900
46,764
4,50,00
0
5,52,90
0
6,46,76
4
7,15,464
8,84,872
Grand Total:
32,50,000
ANNUAL BREAK DOWN OF PHYSICAL & FINANCIAL TARGET OF THE FOURTH PLAN 1970-75
Amount in Rs.
Project
1. Sub-post
2. Branch-post
3. Additional post
4. Postal line
5. Building Construction
6. Commodity Supply Store
7. Mail Service
(a) Additional Inspectors
(b) Means of Mail Service
1.
Mail van
2.
Mailester
3.
Bicycle
(c) Land/Air Rout
1.
Land Rout
2.
Air Rout
8. Regional Office Of the
Commodity Store
9. Commodity Workshop
10. Philatelic Development
(a) Philatelic Bureau
(b) Regional Branch
11. Training Development
(a) Qualitative
Physical
Target
8
80
3
4
12%
1970-71
Amount
3,13,486
2,43,708
64,615
4,00,000
3,00,000
Physical
Target
1
9
100
4
5
16%
1971-72
Amount
1972-73
Amount
1973-74
1974-75
19,091
6,66,157
5,48,343
1,50,769
5,00,000
4,00,000
10,000
10
30,000
15
60,000
20
1,00,000
50
2,00,000
3
4
50
1,35,000
30,000
17,500
3
5
50
1,35,000
37,500
17,500
4
5
100
1,80,000
37,500
35,000
5
6
300
2,25,000
45,000
1,05,000
15
20
500
6,75,000
1,50,000
1,75,000
1
1
1
-
3
-
5
1
10
6
20,000
-
1
-
80,000
-
1
1
80,000
2,50,000
20,000
2,50,000
2
1
2,00,000
5,00,000
12%
-
33,000
-
16%
-
44,000
-
20%
-
55,000
-
24%
1
66,000
75,000
28%
1
77,000
1,50,000
100%
2
2,75,000
2,25,000
Publication of
course books
50,000
50,000
Library
Establishment.
40,000
Construction of hostel
Completion of
hostel
construction
50,000
1,90,000
Conduct of
high & low
level session
Bhairahawa
34,872
60,000
33,500
50,000
Adaptation of
savings bank
system in
some main
office
Establishment
of exchange
post office &
other works
20,000
1,00,000
1
-
1,25,000
2,00,000
1,50,000
3,50,000
Furnished
with
modern
equipments.
Physical Target
Amount
57,273
14,89,057
12,49,003
3,87,692
7,00,000
6,00,000
Physical
Target
2
12
140
7
8
28%
38,182
10,58,015
8,83,441
2,58,462
6,00,000
5,00,000
1
11
120
6
7
24%
Amount
95,454
19,59,286
16,75,505
5,38,462
8,00,000
7,00,000
Physical
Target
5
50
550
25
30
100%
1970-75
Amount
Physical
Target
1
10
110
5
6
20%
2,10,000
54,86,000
46,00,000
14,00,000
30,00,000
25,00,000
(b)
Quantitative
1 Instructor
2,900
Addition of
staffs
6,764
3 Instructors
15,464
Biratnagar
16,500
Kathmandu
Extension of
postal order,
insurance
service
45,000
35,000
Extension
of postal
order
service
20,000
35,000
20,000
20,000
20,000
10,000
2 Exchange
post offices
50,000
50,000
7,66,000
1
-
4,546
7,66,000
9,091
7,66,000
1,00,000
Modernizati
on of
internal
post parcel
service.
Initiation of
Postal order
with India
& money
order
service.
1
-
13,636
7,66,000
2
-
22,727
7,66,000
5
-
50,000
38,30,000
22,50,809
34,69,306
46,04,954
62,08,125
79,17,806
2,44,51,000
CHAPTER XIV
1971-72
1972-73
1973-74
1974-75
Total
Middle Level:
Civil Engineering
60
46
58
46
60
60
270
Electrical Engineering
60
30
30
30
90
Telecommunicating Engineering
60
60
120
30
120
120
120
120
120
600
Plumbing
120
120
120
120
120
600
Wood Working
120
120
120
120
120
600
Telephone Operating
24
24
24
24
24
120
12
12
10
10
12
56
Teleprinter operator
10
10
10
44
Aviation Communicator
10
10
10
10
10
50
36
36
Skilled Workers:
Telex:
As the demand for technicians and skilled workers will be partially met, it is hoped that it will be helpful
in the implementation of development projects such as the construction of roads, buildings, irrigation facilities,
etc. In order to expand the training available, machinery, a concrete laboratory, a soil-testing laboratory, and
hydraulic laboratory will be setup in the Institution during the Plan period.
It is estimated that Rs. 23.3 million will be spend on the projects concerning this Institute, including Rs.
17.929 million to be contributed by UNSF. The remainder will be borne by His Majesty's Government.
CHAPTER XV
INDUSTRY
Industrial development is essential in order to increase production and per capita income at a rate fast
enough to provide a basis for the economic development of the country; to decrease the populations dependence
on the agricultural sector; to provide profitable employment for the increasing number of educated persons in the
community; and to better utilize the resources of the country. On one hand, it could be said that industrial
development of the maximum possible extent is necessary to increase the pace of development of the country; on
the other hand, the infrastructure required for industrial development is not entirely present in Nepal. The need of
raw materials for healthy industrial development of the country has been acknowledged, but no substantial
deposit of those ray materials essential for the mineral industry have yet been discovered. The industrial
feasibility study of forest resources in the country has been started only recently, and it has not yet been possible
to fulfill the demand of agro-based industries. The market for any large scale industrial development is also
lacking and the extension of purchasing power and marked development require time. In this context, it may be
added that the marked in the country has become more accessible because of improvements in transport and
communications facilities. The industrial development of a developing country like Nepal, which has need of a
market and raw materials, requires facilities for international trade and transit. For this purpose, the Trade and
Transit Treaty with India and its proper implementation is especially important. Our experience in industrial
development has been very short and the country still lacks experts in management affairs. All possible efforts for
industrial development have been made in preceeding years, even with the mentioned difficulties.
Progress up-to-date
The real industrial development of Nepal started as a result of the establishment of some industries due
to the extraordinary international demand created during the Second World War. Several industries which had
been started locked a solid base and disappeared in the post war period. Thus, there was no progress worth
mentioning in the industrialization of the country until the year 1956 when the idea of planned economic
development was initiated. Several industries were to be set up during the last Plan period, primarily in the
private sector. However, most of the targets could not be attained because of the underdeveloped nature of the
fundamental infrastructure in the private sector and because industrial policy had not been classified in an
extensive manner. Certain industries also registered growth which had not been included in the Third Plan and
which therefore, could be only of limited help in the development of the country. In the public sector, a sugar mill
and agricultural implements factory at Birgunj, a cigarette factory at Janakpur, a leather and shoe factory and the
brick and tile factory at Kathmandu were set up. In accordance with the priorities fixed in the Third Plan, a
beginning was made in the establishment of a cement factory at Kathmandu, and special facilities were being
provideds for the establishment of cotton textiles factory at Bhairahawa. Industrial districts were setup in Patan,
Balaju and Hetauda as envisaged in the Second Plan, and preliminary work to set up industrial districts at Dharan
and Nepalgunj was also started during the Third Plan period. There have been some important achievements in
the creation of a basis for industrial development. As raw materials constitute one of the basic prerequisites of
industrialization, it is necessary to have information about the countrys natural resources and their development.
A survey of forest resources in the Terai arrangements for a detailed feasibility study of their industrial utilization
were made during the Third Plan period. Because soil surveys are of utmost importance in the feasibility studies
of commercial agriculture and preliminary works in this field has been started in the country. The study of
mineral resources has also been continuing. With progress in the agricultural sector, the purchasing power of
framers should be augmented which in turn should help to increase the demand for industrial goods. The
development of transportation has also brought markets throughout the country nearer to one another. Legislation
regarding the provision of facilities to industries and research work done in this field will also be of help in future
industrial development. The Nepal Industrial Development Corporation (NIDC) has been set up. As industrial
credit is extremely essential for the development of this sector, industrial loans amounting to Rs. 543 and 113
million have been made available during the Third and Second Plan Periods, respectively.
Table 108
LOAN APPLICATIONS APPROVED BY NIDC TO INDUSTRIES AND
PAYMENT MADE IN DIFFERENT CURRENCIES DURING
THE THIRD PLAN PERIOD
Year
Payment on loan
1965-66
5.066
8.134
1966-67
29.923
8.360
1967-68
7.758
3.891
1968-69
14.603
1.322
1969-70 (estimated)
57.700
19.338
Total:
115.05
41.045
The following amounts of foreign exchange have been utilized by industries taking loans through
foreign agencies:
(Rs. In Millions)
1965-66
1966-67
1967-68
1968-69
1969-70
German mark
1.500
0.157
0.079
0.022
3.5
Dollars, US
0.122
0.027
0.009
Indian Rs.
1.082
3.989
2.160
0.211
10.0
Granted
Investment in
Equity
1965-66 0.68
1.23
1966-67 2.75
0.572
1967-68 0.155
0.339
1968-69 1.331
0.214
1969-70 -
10.0
Total
4.916
12.355
Table 110
Unit
1965-66
1966-67
1967-68
1968-69
1969-70*
1. Jute
M.T.
17,325
12,191
12,179
13,958
15,000
2. Sugar
9,912
4,410
3,279
9,656
24,000
3. Cigarette
000 sticks
6,35,964
9,54,021
11,14,936
16,76,575
20,00,000
4. Match
Gross
N.A.
4,64,595
4,24,431
4,67,993
5,00,000
5. Shoe
Pairs
29,838
20,095
28,654
32,102
50,000
6. Stainless Steel
Kg.
2,32,000
3,81,000
7,38,000
24,19,071
7,50,000
7. Refined Leather
58,979
56,975
64,219
99,815
1,60,000
8. Textiles
Metres
12,93,494
20,98,004
24,92,680
35,41,423
25,00,000
9. Tea
Kg.
N.A.
N.A.
13,641
12,100
18,000
Tons
1,279
2,500
5,000
Gross
1,88,409
2,77,791
4,00,000
12. Soap
Md.
5,743
9,068
7,000
13. Wool
Kg.
35,300
14,446
3,840
11,067
N.A.
14. Wine
Gallons
30,654
4,658
11,371
52,747
*The figures for the year 1969-70 represent estimation of annual production made on the basis of date available
up to the month of December.
Fourth Plan
Industrial
Policy
of
the
Fourth
Plan
and
Facilities
to
Industries:
It has been the objective of the Fourth Plan to encourage the establishment of industries mainly in the
private sector. If found to be necessary, only one or two industries would be setup in the public sector. No
specific industry has been named in this respect. The following industries in the private sector will be encouraged
during the Plan period:
a.
Agricultural industries based upon indegenious raw materials which would help in the industrialization of the
country, as well as the development of agriculture. Such industries as tea and jute which would increase
exports after fulfilling the requirements of the country will be give greatest priority.
b.
Industries based on natural resources of the country such as forest products and drugs will be established.
c.
Industries based on such national resources as minerals will be established. Those industries which would
produce basic materials and increase exports would be given preference.
d.
Industries like textiles, whose products are being imported in large quantities, which would produce
materials needed for every-day life, and which would decrease imports will be established.
e.
Industries producing basic materials necessary for development (e.g. fertilizers, agricultural implements and
cement) will be established.
It is essential that the private sector should be encouraged to set up such industries as mentioned above, giving
them priority over the kinds of industries. In this context, priority will be also given to labour intensive industries.
For this purpose, current legislation dealing with the facilities to be given to industries will be further extended
and classified. It will be published after categorizing the large and small scale industries according to production.
The facilities to be provided to industries in each class would be clearly stated in view of the long term
requirements of the country. In other words, a definite and firm industrial policy will be followed. This will be
done early in the Fourth Plan period. In accordance with the policy to give more assistance to the Plans priority
industries (including foreign exchange and tax and loan facilities from different government departments and
agencies), implementation will occur only after clearly stating the kinds of such assistance arrangements will also
be made so that assistance clearly stated in this manner will be made automatically available after obtaining a
license from the Department of Industries, andit will not be necessary to get separate approval from other HMG
departments for this purpose. Arrangements will be made for industries getting financial assistance or special
facilities to have part of theirs profits so as to increase the capacity of already existing industries or to create new
industries.
1.
It is necessary to make different services available for the coordinated and well planned establishment and
development of industries. During the Fourth Plan period, technical services, consulting services, feasibility
studies, quality controls, etc. will either be provided through NIDC or a new autonomous organization.
The following services will be provided by this organization in the beginning:
a.
It would make reports about different projects, after feasibility studies by Nepalese and foreign
specialists were made available to the industrialists. This will be to prepare different projects for the
establishment of new industries.
b.
Quality Control:
Arrangements will also be made during the Plan period to start quality controls on all industrial
products, those for exports and those intended to be consumed in Nepal. This will be implemented with the
cooperation of laboratories and the Royal Drug Research Institute. Other laboratories will be set up as needed.
c.
As it is quite expensive for both small and large scale industries to repair their machinery in their own
workshops and to have their own equipment for packing and weighing, industries would be helped greatly if
cooperative services (Sajha) of this kind were to be made available at a reasonable cost.
2.
During the Plan period, industries in the public sector and some industries in the private sector will be
improved in the following manner:
a.
Sugar Industry:
There are at present three sugar mills in Nepal, including one in Birgunj in the public sector and one
eachg in Bharahawa and Morang in the private sector. The production capacity of Birgunj Sugar Mill will be
increased by 50 per cent which will mean a total capacity of 1500 metric tons. A fifty per cent increase in the
capacity of Bhairahawa Sugar mills will also make it self-sufficient.
b.
c.
The production capacity of Agriculture Implement Factory at Birgunj which is in the public sector, will increase
by 50 per cent. New kinds of agricultural implements will also be produced.
d.
It has becomenecessary to increase the production capacity of the factory, as well as to establish a slaughter
house in Kathmandu in order to operate this factory profitably. That is why the production capacity of this factory
will be doubled during the Plan period. Necessary facilities will also be provided to establish a slaughter house in
Kathmandu in the private sector.
e.
The production capacity of the Brick and Tile Factory situated at Harisiddhi will be doubled.
f.
Jute Factory:
The Jute Mills at Biratnagar will be modernized and assistance including loans will be made available to start
production of new goods, such as carpets.
g.
Tea Industry:
During the Plan period, the Nepal Tea Development Corporation will cultivate tea on additional land in the Terai
at Chilimkot and near the East-West Highway in Jhapa District. As tea grown in the hilly regions is suitable for
export, it would be cultivated at Kanyam Area in Ilam Districts after the land is obtained for this purpose.
Facilities including loans will be provided to tea plantations in the private sector for their expansion. The aim is
to fulfil Nepals internal demands for tea and increase exports by the year 1980 by extending tea plantations,
including those in NTDC and in the private sector.
3.
It is not possible to speak definitely, as yet, above the industries to be setup in the private sector. Detailed
studies have yet to be done in those industries, which have been found to be feasible at the present time. There is
also the possibility that several other industries which have not been found to be feasible at the present time may
be found to be so sometime in the future.
Taking all these factors into consideration, the target for the establishment of industries in the private
sector is as follows:
Table 111
INDUSTRIES TO BE ESTABLISHED DURING THE FOURTH PLAN
PERIOD
Class A
(1) Import Reducing Industries
Textiles
20 million Yards
Flour Mill
9,000 tons
Iron Pipe
3,000 tons
Soap
2,000 tons
Sugar Crushing
Brewery
1.8 million
Leather Tanning
11,000 Hides
Tobacco Refining
12,000 tons
Cigarettes
10,000 tons
Strawboard
6,000 tons
Ghee Refining
Ginger Refine
1,500 tons
65,000 tons
20,000
40 million
Hotel
Class B
Whole Plan period
Class C
(1) Agriculture
Modern Rice Mill
24,000 tons
Cold Storage
Bakery Industry
Vegetable ghee
7,500 tons
15,000 tons
Saw Mill
Plywood
--
(2) Forests
2,000 tons
Glass
20 tons/day
Note: The above mentioned industries have been only given as examples. License may be issued for setting up
other industries which might fall in any of these categories.
4) Industrial Investment and Loans
It has already been mentioned that the private sector is going to be given the main role in setting up
industries during the Plan period. It has also been stated that currend legislation wouold be revisede I accordance
tiht the policy to set up more industries in the preivate sector. NIDC would also provide loans according to this
policy. The approximate amounts of loans and investments to be mabe available by NIDC in the next five year is
estimated to be as follows:
Table 112
INVESTMENT OF NIDC
(Rs. in million)
Unit
Loans Shares
1. Cement
22.8
2.4
2. Textiles
40.0
100
3. Animals
2.958
0.7
4. Plywood
4.345
50.0
120.103
13.1
Total
It cannot be said that the private sector will set up all the basic and feasible industries capable of making
special contributions to the industrial development of the country. The Government will attempt to establish
paper, fertilizer and cement industries with the aim of gradually selling them to the private sector in the future.
Rs. 15 million has been allocated for such investment in the public sector during the Plan period. In addition, a
factory utilizing molasses obtained from Birgunj Sugar Factory will be established.
5) Industrial Districts
Industrial districts equipped with basic facilities are quite important in view of the consumption of
industrial products in the country, experience in th eoperation and management of industries, the requirement of
regional development, and the development of small and large scale industries, since such districts tend to reduce
imports by utilizing indegenious raw materials and help to create an industrial environment in the country,
attention will be devoted to giving more assistance for the development of feasible sites outside Kathmandu
Valley, a fact which would also contribute to regional development. The following programme has been
included in the Fourth Plan under this concept:
a)
To construct twenty additional buildings at the Balaju Industrial Distric of Kathmandu and to expand Patan
Industrial District,
d) To complete preliminary work in establishing one more industrial district in the country based upon a
feasibility study in about the third year of the Plan period.
6) Project for the development of raw materials
Difficulties arise for many industries operating in Nepal because of the inadequacvy of raw materials. In
view of this factor, concrete programs should be implemented during the Plan period investigating quality contro.
These should be done in collaboration with the agricultural sector on such products as jute, sugarcane, tobacco,
oilseeds, cotton, silk, etc.
7) Industrial Training
Necessary training of a short duration and of medium standard will be given in different industrial
subjest at various technical training institutions which have been set up on the country. The ability of
Kathmandu, Birgunj and Hetauda Centres to give training in useful and necessary subjects will be increased.
During the Plan period, managerial training being provided by NIDC will also be made more extensive.
8) Labour Welfare Scheme
The contribution of labourers to the economic development of the country is very important. The all
round development of the country is possible only if there is an environment of good-will between employers and
employees. Concrete steps will be taken during the Plan period in the guidance of the interest of labourers, and
attempts will be made to provide them with necessary training and assistance as far as possible.
9) Arrangement for Evaluation of Industrial Activities
The progress and contribution to the development of the national economy made by industries in public
or private sector (those operating at the present time and those to be set up on the future) will be evaluated
periodically by a committee consisting of independent and impartial experts. The committee will also review the
industrial development programs of HMG and the operations of financial institutions in providing investment and
loan facilities.
50
38
4. Industrial Districts
15
6. Industrial Training
Total
1
Rs. 108.5
CHAPTER XVI
COTTAGE INDUSTRY
Most of the farmers are busy in farming only for few months during the year an dreaming idle the rest of
the time. Cottage industry could play an important role in solving this problem, as well as raising the national
income and creating a sound basis for industrialization by mobilizing idle resources and manpower in the
agricultural sector. It could help to fulfil the local demand for consumers goods, to raise production by fully
utilizing the leisure time, to develop cottage industry and handicrafts by collecting the skills scattered in the
village and suburban areas, and to prepare the skilled and semi-skilled workers needed for industrialization of the
country.
Progress to date
Since 1957 His Majesty's Government has been taking different steps to develop cottage, village an
small scale industries in the country. Up to the end of the Second Plan, emphasis was given to the establishment
of Cottage Industry Centres and the training of people. But the trained personnel did not or could not be utilized
and the knowledge that they acquired from training was wasted. Due to the lack of proper arrangements to utilize
the trained personnel and the lack of coordination between planned training and the demand, the trained people
remained unemployed, thereby ruining the usefulness of the programme. To develop and manage the village and
cottage industries in a planned and effective manner and to avoid all the previous shortcomings, programmes,
were formulated in the Third Plan on the basis of the report prepared by foreign experts. These programmes were
tied to foreign aid for implementation, but the programmes could not be implemented due to the unavailability of
aid money in time to be appropriated to the projects. The rate of development of village, cottage and small
industries remained stand still during the Third Plan.
Fourth Plan
In fact, it seems that the revised programmes of the Third Plan were not executed according to the Plan.
It is necessary to operate the continuing projects with timely revision and to clarify the sphere of activities of the
Cottage Industry Department in the development and expansion of the village and cottage industries during the
Fourth Plan. Emphasis will be given to the establishment and development of different types of industries which
will produce various handicraft goods, such as carved image, framing, casting, decorative, wood, metal, stone,
paper, soil and cloths etc. this will reduce import requirements by the utilization of locally available raw
materials, as well as supporting the export oriented village industries based on forest, agriculture, animal and
mineral resources. Priority will also be given to those industries which will decrease imports and provide services
such as the maintenance of radios, transformers, electric motors and produce goods other then those listed above,
such as leather shoes, suit-cases and brief-cases. Thus the revised programmes of the Third Plan shall have to be
implemented during the Fourth Plan. But, to make training more effective, to make the existing sectoral
programmes more useful, to improve the quality of commodities, and to select the objectives for the local work,
the following five year policy has been framed.
Policy
(1) The traditional handicrafts which use locally available raw materials will be developed. Simultaneously, local
raw materials surveys will be conducted. Economically beneficial and import reducing industries will be
developed on the basis of feasibility of location. Government assistance will not be provided to industries which
may not turn out to be economical.
(2) Emphasis will be to strengthen and to make viable the existing cottage industries rather than to set up new
ones during the Plan period.
(3) Under the training programme, emphasis will be given to increasing the numbers, together
with improving the standard and type of training.
Programme
The development programme of cottage industries is divided into five main categories:
1.
2.
3.
Training Programme
4.
5.
1.
The industrial services programme will be given high priority under this programme. The following
projects are included:
(a)
Under this programme low interest loans, machines and implements will be provide on installment basis for the
development and establishment of existing and new industries. In the second year of the Fourth Plan, an
autonomous organization (Small Industries Financial Corporation) will be established to perform the tasks of
loan, investment and hire-purchase in a planned way:
Target:
(b)
Under this programme, the following projects will be implemented feasibility and industrial survey, project
preparation and distribution, consultation, quality control and standardization, calendaring service, and the
establishment of pilot industries. For a period of five years, target will be as follows:
i.
Twenty detailed reports on industries will be prepared on the basis of industrial feasibility surveys.
ii.
iii.
One hundred and fifty industrial project reports will be prepared and distributed, including 45 for
handicrafts, 30 for village industries and 30 others.
iv.
v.
Quality control and standardization through laboratory and other means will be initiated.
vi.
A cotton textile calendering service will be managed and run and preliminary work on the establishment
of calendaring service to potteries at Thimi and Bhaktapur will be done.
vii.
Some small industries which use indigeneous raw materials and which help to reduce the level of
imports will be established in the form of pilot projects.
2.
The village industry programmes will be implemented for the economic development and reconstruction of
special industries such as carpet, pashmina, hand made paper etc. under this programme, training will be given in
three occupational trades which have employment opportunities in the local markets and have local specialties in
every district of the country. The existing ten village industry and offices and thirteen zonal cottage industry
centers will be converted in to Village Industry Centres. During the Plan period, twelve such Centres will have
permanent buildings. Under the programme, training will be given; as far as possible, production and sales
activities will be managed through the private sector. For financial assistance, miscellaneous industrial services
and grants will be provided. During the Plan period, twelve viable village industry-production centers will be
established to provide jobs for the trained people and also to produce daily consumption goods. These centers
will be operated on the basis of detailed industrial surveys and existing village industry centers and zonal centers
will converted into village industry centers in the second year of the Plan after a full review of their working
subject and location.
The main emphasis of these centers will b eon industrial promotion and services. Attention will be paid
to the usefulness of training, rather than merely increase the number on the basis of local needs. This training will
usually be of one year in length.
3.
Training Programme:
Since 1957, various types of training programmes have been arranged by the Cottage Industry Department. How
far, the training programme has been beneficial for the development of cottage industry and for the provision of
jobs for the trainees according to the training they received has not been evaluated so far. This has been felt
necessary, on the basis of past experiences that overall improvement in the type and subject of training should be
made in order to meet manpower requirements and to increase the utility of training. The training programme in
the Fourth Plan, formulated after considering the form of such changes and improvements, shall be as follows:
(a)
Technical training:
By classifying training, improvements will be made in curriculum and standards. With this in mind, the training
will be of the following types:
I.
Mechanical
General training courses, for two years and one more year for diploma
Electrical
General training courses, for two years and one more year for diploma
General training courses, for two years and one more year for diploma
General training:
Hosiery and Sewing
Two years.
From the third and fourth year of the Plan training will be provided in the changed production
To operate the village industries more efficiently, training in some basic subjects, such as management, sale,
book-keeping, and accountancy in service training and other related to village industries will be provided. This
kind of training will be to provide to the concerned people through Village Development Training center at
Pokhara. A feasibility study will be done for the establishment of another center if it is deemed necessary. The
training will be based on organized curriculum in the form of short and long term trained programmes. Technical
training in a maximum of six subjects considered to be most useful to our country will be provided at the centere.
The function of this center will be to supplement the efforts to develop and expand village Industries. By the joint
efforts of district and village industry training centers, mobile teams will be sent to the different parts of the
country to train and develop traditional handicrafts, and also to provide new implements according to need.
4.
The design of goods, produced by various agencies such as private limited companies, loan receiving companies
and sub-branches of Cottage Industry Department are not centralized and controlled, and are therefore produced
in a random way without considering the demand of consumer. This hampers the future of industries. With the
objective of brining to life the production of Nepalese arts and culture and providing more publicity for these
goods, research work will be done concerning the tools and implements used in the development of handicrafts,
village and cottage industries and the control of design of the produced goods. The programme is as follows:
(a)
Control and preparation of new designs of sub-production branches under Cottage Industry Departmentfirst year
(b)
Control and preparation of new designs for Pvt. Ltd. Companies-second year
(c)
(d)
(e)
Collection of artistic goods, establishment of collection center for model designs and preparation of
design catalogue-fourth and fifth year
(f)
(g)
This programme will be done by the handicrafts design division of the Cottage Industry Department.
5.
Sales management must play an important role in the development of cottage industry and handicrafts. The
production of goods which can not compete in the market, will not lead to the permanent development of cottage
industry. However, there are certain goods whose sale, if made in an organized way, would reduce the gap
between production and demand in the market and would make it possible to better organize the market.
Considering these things, the department will encourage the production of such goods which can be sold within
and outside the kingdom. The following arrangements will be made for h sale of goods produced in this manner.
(a)
The technicians, posted in 13 centres outside the Kathmandu Valley, will study the market an will
provide technical advice and forward credit through cooperatives and other institutions in the private
sector in order to float goods in the market. This function is a responsibility of the village industry
centers.
(b)
A large number of handicrafts are produced in the small area of the Kathmandu Valley. It has been
necessary to coordinate the development programme of the Department with the procurement of goods
by the Cottage Industry Sales Emporium from the private craftsmen operating in the Kathmandu Valley.
It is also necessary to have real development as well as the profits, if the handicraft industry is itself to
be developed. The Department is consequently providing financial credit and technical advice to the
producers for the general development. The programmes are to be coordinated with the attempts to
encourage producers by improving market facilities. Thus the procurement of goods from producers by
the Cottage Industry Sales Emporium will be made in close cooperation and consultation with the
Cottage Industry Department.
Table 113
Estimated amount of Investment in Cottage Industry
Name of the Projects
In thousand Rs.
50,00
80,00
3. Training Programme.
a. Technical Training
40,00
35,00
22,00
___________
Total
2,27,00
CHAPTER XVII
TRADE
Both internal and foreign trade have a major role to play in the economic development of a country. A
developing country like ours cannot meet all of its requirements by itself. Thus, to fulfil the demand for the
necessities of life and for development works, the import of goods and services is necessary. It is also necessary
that exports be augmented considerably. However, the present market for Nepalese goods, is quite limited, even
though the development of internal resources depends upon foreign trade. Under such conditions, the
Government, in recent year, has been pursuing a policy of export promotion and diversification of trade.
Progress of date
According to the present policy of His Majesty's Government, trade relations with different countries are
being expanded as planned, while exports to over-seas countries have increased beyond expectations during the
Third Plan period. One year before the start of the Third Plan (1964-65), total exports were approximately Rs.
14.4 million. This increased 1967-68 and Rs. 146 million in 19966-67
Targets of the Fourth Plan
In addition to the traditional export item, the Government will provide necessary assistance as an
incentive to promote the export of manufactured goods and other goods. Accordingly, His Majesty's Government
will make arrangements to export semi-processed and processed goods instead of exporting them in the form of
raw materials. So, during the Fourth Plan period, it is planned to double the export trade with overseas countries
by gradually adopting the policy of commodity and country diversification.
In order to realize the above targets, a detailed survey of the conditions of the internal market and prod
capacity will be conducted. To raise the production of exportable goods, several objectives have been set; greater
uniformity of products will be achieved through the improvement of quality; godown facilities for storage will be
provided for exportable goods; credit facilities will be provide to attract export business; and godowns and
storage tanks will be made available to simplify the sales distribution pattern of necessary imported goods. For
the attainment of these objectives, the following programmes will be implemented.
Programmes
a.
A detailed national survey will be conducted to identify exportable goods, to estimate the exportable
capacity of these goods, and to fix the short and long term export targets on the basis of all exportable
goods.
b.
At a few important international commercial centres, Nepal Trade representatives offices will be
established to provide regular information on international market studies citing Nepals trade interest.
This is done in order to promote export trade and to formulate necessary policy adjustments
c.
Considering the compatibility between customs, taxes, and foreign trade policy, various steps will be
taken to promote export trade on a more consistent basis.
d.
A study for finding suitable markets for the export of those materials produced in Nepal and exported as
raw materials, or semi-processed materials, or such other materials which are not exported will be
conducted. Adequate assistance will be provided to the exporters of such materials, and export oriented
industries will be established.
e.
An institutional arrangement will be made to inspect the standard and quality of exportable goods before
they are dispatched to foreign countries.
f.
Godowns with 10,000 tons capacity at Biratnagar, 5,000 tons each at Birgunj and Bhairahawa, and
1,000 tons each at Janakpur and Nepalgunj will be constructed to protect exportable goods and to
promote exports.
g.
In order to encourage the production of cash crops and to provide better prices for such goods to
producers, godowns and credit facilities will be made available in some places
h.
Institutional development will be made to provide the necessary credit facilities and export guarantees to
exporters to encourage their business. The existing financial institutions will also become more active in
this field.
i.
Reserve tanks will be constructed at Kathmandu, Birgunj, Biratnagar, Bhairahawa and Nepalgunj to
have stocks of P.O.L. products such as petrol, diesel, kerosene, etc.
Capital Investment
The capital required for the smooth implementation of the above mentioned programmes will be Rs. 50
million during the Plan period. Of the above amount, Rs. 10 million is estimated for the construction of godowns,
Rs. 30 million for the construction of oil tanks, Rs. 8 million for the preservation of exportable goods, and Rs. 2
million Fourth Plan the promotional services and international exhibitions. Rs. 10 million from the public sector
will be invested, while Rs. 40 million will be met from internal loans for the construction of godowns and oil
storage tanks.
Transit Facilities
Transit facilities in a landlocked country like Nepal play a significant role in the expansion of trade with
overseas countries. To encourage the foreign trade of Nepal, His Majesty's Government will take necessary steps
such as the construction of better godowns at the Indian ports or the preservation of Nepalese goods, adoption of
adequate and smooth transportation facilities as well as simple procedures for the dispatch and delivery of
Nepalese goods at and through Indian territory, the simplification of import-export transit procedures and the
encouragement of the creation of a separate self-administered port area.
Trade Promotional Services
The necessary institutional system will be developed to provide regularly the necessary information and
studies to traders and trading institutions within the country regarding the trends of international markets. This
system will ensure success of the commodity and the country diversification policy and will strengthen Nepals
commercial relations with different countries. Royal Nepalese Embassies abroad can contribute quite
substantially to these efforts. Attempts will therefore be made to make them more active and capable in this sort
of work. The offices of Commercial representatives will also be set up according to the requirements of different
places. Such commercial information services will be provided and extended through the establishment of trade
promotional centres during this Plan period. By this method, more reliable information regarding foreign trade
and the international market will be made available to the public, and private sector within the country, for the
achievement of the Governments trade promotional objectives
Trade Development: State Trading and Private Sector:
Because foreign trade of the country can be conducted in a meaningful way only if internal trade is well
organized, internal trade will also be increased and organized in accordance with the needs of development
during the Plan period. Giving proper attention to its possible contribution to increase in exports from the private
sector, necessary facilities and incentives will be provided to this sector.
The National Trading Company Limited in the public sector will be made more export-oriented and will
play a major role in export promotional activities. Moreover, the private and public sectors will act so as to
compliment one other.
The public sector will also play an active role in the fulfillment of import requirements of the country.
But before taking such steps, equal treatment will be provided to both public and private sectors.
Table 114
TRADE DEVELOPMENT
(In Rupees)
Project
Investments
1. Godowns construction
10 million
8 million
2 million
Rs. 40 million
CHAPTER XVIII
TOURISM
A developing country like Nepal needs increasing amounts of foreign exchange during the process of its
development. Foreign exchange (especially convertible foreign exchange) is as important as it is difficult to earn.
There are four main sources of foreign exchange earnings at the present time. They are exploration-servicemen,
foreign aid, trade, and tourism. Of the above mentioned four sources, the first two are not very dependable. That
is why we have to be more dependent upon trade and tourism and should consider both to be permanent and
essential sources of increasing national income and earning the foreign exchange necessary for the development
of our country. It has thus become necessary to develop the tourist industry to the greatest possible extent.
Progress to date
A Tourism Development Board was established in Nepal in the year 1957 in order to develop the tourist
industry. Since the tourist industry could not be adequately developed by establishing Board, a separate
department was established during the First Plan period. After the establishment of the Department, Nepal got
membership in different International Tourist Organizations. Among the worthwhile steps taken in the preceding
year for the development of tourism have been, the setting up of abut 800 hotel beds of varying standards in
Kathmandu (out of which 206 have been five starred and 180 four starred). Also, the establishment of different
travel agencies, the continued development of Tribhuvan Airport, the operation of air services by foreign airlines,
and the increase in the international services of RNAC have been the major factors in the development of tourism
in the preceding decade. The development of places with tourist attraction like Nagarkot and Kakani, sight seeing
services, trained guides, and increasing publicity for Nepal in the international field undertaken by the
Department of Tourism have also contributed greatly in its development.
The foreign exchange earnings from tourism are the main sources of Nepals convertible foreign
currency, and have increased from Rs. 0.695 million in the year 1960-61 to Rs. 10 million by the end of the year
1968-69. The earnings of convertible foreign exchange in the years 1964-65 and 1965-66 was Rs. 1.624 million
and Rs. 3.029 million, respectively. On the other hand, the earnings in the year 1966-67 was Rs. 6.05 million, or
100 per cent more than that of the year 1965-66. The main reason behind a 100 per cent increase in foreign
exchange earnings has been due to the greater proportionate increase in the number of tourists resulting form the
operation of Fokker air service, the opening of Annapurna Hotel and the arrangement of necessary
accommodation facilities in other hotels. Since then, there has been a corresponding increase in earnings of
foreign exchange by tourism in proportion to the increase in the number of tourists, except in the 1964-65. The
earnings of foreign exchange from tourism in the year 1968-69 amounted to Rs. 110 million, which was 42 per
cent more than that in the preceding year. In the first five months of the fiscal year 1969-70, earnings amounting
to more than Rs. 4.8 million were reported and it is expected that Rs. 14 million will be earned by the end of the
current fiscal year, a figure which happens to be 40.6 per cent more than the preceeding year.
The number of tourists visiting Nepal and the earning of foreign exchange are shown in the following
Table:
Table 115
(Rs. In Million)
Fiscal Years
No. of Tourists
1964-65
10,356
1.624
1965-66
9,191
3.029
1966-67
15,577
6.038
1967-68
20,738
8.254
1968-69
28,189
10.00
16,607
4.8
Thus, foreign exchange earnings have increased along with the increase in the number of tourist.
Therefore, it has become essential to follow a well planned policy and programme during the Fourth Plan period
so that tourism can make its maximum contribution to the economic development of the country. The proper
implementation of programmes for the development of this industry is also essential.
Fourth Plan- Objectives and Programmes
A master plan will be prepared in the beginning of the Fourth Plan period in order to develop the tourist
industry in a planned way. Sites of tourist attractions would be constructed and developed, and facilities for
tourists in different parts of the country would continue to be created. While advertising at the international
standards the private sector would also be encouraged to develop attractive places such as parks, lakes, hunting
site and playground, and to make accommodation and travel facilities available to the tourists. The tourist
industry cannot be successfully developed by the programmes and implementations of the concerned department
alone. Because its success is related to the programmes of different departments, due attention will be given to
establishing complete coordination. In fact, the development of tourism is more dependant upon the programmes
of other departments that of the Tourism Department alone.
Taking into consideration the experiences gained in preceding years and the other arrangements to be
made during the Plan period, it is estimated that the number of tourists in Nepal will increase at an estimated rate
(annual) of 40 per cent for the next five years. The number of tourists visiting this country is likely to increase if
hotel facilities are made available, along with greater ease of air travel in the main places of the kingdom.
Table 116
(Rs. In Million)
Fiscal Years
No. of Tourists
1970-71
49,000
19.6
1971-72
68,000
26.0
1972-73
95,000
36.5
1973-74
1,30,000
50.0
1974-75
1,80,000
70.1
According to Table 116, it could be stated that, if foreign exchange earnings increase by 40 per cent
annually, corresponding to the annual increase in the number of tourist, the amount of foreign exchange as
estimated in the above mentioned Table could be earned. Also, the earning of foreign exchange might will
increase even if there were no considerable increase in the number of tourists.
If it were possible to lengthen the stay of tourists in Nepal, the earnings from tourism could be increased
even if the numbers of tourists visiting Nepal were not be increased considerably. According to the Tourism
Development Plan, it is obvious that I would take longer for tourist to look around if new tourists attractions
indifferent places could b developed. This would result in longer stays, leading to increased spending by them
and increased foreign exchange earnings by Nepal.
As envisaged in the current Tourist Development Plan, the duration of stay of tourists in Nepal would be
increased from an average of 3 days, at present to 5 days by the establishment of hotels in Pokhara, Lumbini and
Namche Bazar. As tourists have also been to some extent responsible Fourth Plan activating black market
activities, additional amounts of foreign exchange would likely to be earned if vigorous attempt were made to
control black market activities. Thus, it could be assumed that a foreign currency equivalent of Rs. 80 to 90
million could be earned in the last year of the Fourth Plan if the number of days on an average tourists stay in
Nepal could be increased along with the increase in the number of tourists. Since more than 80 percent of tourists
visiting Nepal come via air routes, an aviation development programme would be an important one for the
development of tourism during the Fourth Plan period. As jumbo jets are scheduled to fly via India in the
beginning of the first year of the Plan period, it has become essential to make special improvements in the current
services in order to provide facilities for the largest possible number of tourists to visit Nepal. For this purpose,
Kathmandu Airport will be further expanded and a 10,000 ft. runway will be constructed as well as other
necessary facilities to allow larger aircrafts to land.
As Kathmandus weather is sometimes unsuitable for landing of aircrafts. Simra Airport would be equipped with
modern facilities, including the construction of a new 7,500 ft. runway. This would help to bring more tourists in
Nepal. Other airports which receive improved facilities are Pokhara and Bhairahawa. These new facilities would
help to lengthen the duration of tourist stay in Nepal because of the picturesque Pokhara and Lumbini, the
birthplace of Buddha (situated near Bhairahawa).
It is necessary to increase the number of hotels varying standards available to tourists visiting Nepal during the
Plan period. In accordance with the programme of airport construction and the policy of lengthening the duration
of visits of tourists in Nepal, it has become more essential to build modern hotels in places other than
Kathmandu Valley.
In the Plan period, hotels with different standards would be established in Kathmandu Valley, making a total of
2600 hotel beds (600 beds in 4 and 5 stars, 1200 beds in 3 stars and 500 beds in 2 star). Arrangements would also
be made to set up hotels of different standards with a total of 460 beds in different places outside the Valley.
Because of this, the number of tourists from India would also increase due to increased hotel and transportation
facilities in different parts of the kingdom. The construction of the Bhairahawa-Lumbini Road would also be
completed during the Plan period, and the Lumbini Region would be developed.
The following programmes will be implemented by the Department of Tourism in the coming five years:
1.
The formulation of a long-term master Plan for the development of tourism in Nepal and the implementation of
development projects in accordance with this Plan has been begun after a systematic detailed study of tourism
development. This plan would deal with several aspects of the development of tourism: assuring improvement in
sites with tourist attraction, managing facilities in such places (i.e. transportation and hotels), and providing
necessary publicity to attract tourist to Nepal. Services of foreign experts shall also be utilized in drafting the
master plan experiended with the view to make tourism projects function more effectively in the future. It is
expected that the report dealing with the above mentioned master plan would be made available by the first year
of the Fourth Plan. Several new projects would be included in the master plan on the basis of the report, and
obviously these would be implemented during the Plan period. As it is not possible at this time to determine
which of these projects will be implemented in the public sector and the level of investments which will be
required by such projects, additional resources will be allocated after the preparation of the master plan for the
development of tourism.
2.
In accordance with the policy of increasing the number of tourists visiting Nepal annually, a programme has been
included to increase publicity of Nepal on the international level.
Places in Nepal with archeological, religious and cultural importance, as well as other places worth
visiting, will be publicized by means of books, posters, movies , tours advertisement and international seminars
and conferences. A photographic laboratory will also be established which should be helpful in this respect.
Since it is necessary to have more attractive posters, photos and movies and to discover new trekking routes in
different parts of the country will be surveyed by the staff of the Department for the purpose of obtaining the
necessary information and photographs for publicity.
3.
Existing information centres which have been established by this department to provide information to tourists
visiting the country will be extended, and the services of receptionists well-versed in different foreign languages
will be made available. Information Centres will also be set up in Birgunj and Pokhara.
4.
Since only Kathmandu Valley and to a certain extent Pokhara have been developed as tourist centres, the private
sector has provided sightseeing, transportation, and hotel facilities so that tourists may also see the forest and
wild-life at Meghauli in Chitwan District during the Third Plan period. During the Fourth Plan period, facilities
would be provided by the Government to the private sector to set up tourist centres at Khumjungin Solukhumbhu
District and two other places. These centres would be equipped with entertainment, hotel, and transportation
facilities.
5.
Training
About 150 people would be given professional guide training during this period. Training on the management of
primary and middle class hotel and restaurants will also be given.
6.
Entertainment
It is necessary to provide entertainment facilities for tourists. Steps will be taken in cooperation with the
Department of Culture to start programmes based on Nepalese art and culture for this purpose. A permanent
exhibition Costume of Nepal will also be opened.
TABLE 117
ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE
(Rs. In Million)
1. Master Plan of Tourism Development
0.900
3.776
0.114
5. Training
0.100
6. Entertainment
0.110
__________
Total
Rs. 5 million
CHAPTER XIX
GEOLOGICAL SURVEY & MINING
Agriculture, forest and mineral resources are the raw materials essential for the industrial development
of the country. Of these three natural resources, investment, time, technical knowledge, and experience are
required to a great extent in the development of mineral resources. Instances in several countries have been
observed when a major contribution to the economy has been through mineral resources which were able to earn
large amounts of money. The important reasons responsible for the lack of proper development of mineral
resources in Nepal have been the very small and unplanned amount of investment made in this sector, and the
lack of small and unplanned amount of investment made in this sector, and the lack of expert technical
manpower, and the capacity to use modern equipments in mineral exploration. The proper development of
mineral resources of the country would help the industrialization and in the earning foreign exchange could be
increased by exporting it as raw material to abroad.
Progress to date
Although mineral exploration in Nepal was started during the Rana regime, it was not until the beginning of
the First Five Year Plan period that it was done in a planned manner. However, no remarkable progress has yet
been made in this field. During the First Plan period, a sum of Rs. 5 million was allocated for work in mineral
exploration. American and Indian assistance were made available for this purpose. As stated in the Plan, some
mineral deposits were discovered, survey work was taken and work was soon to begin on those deposits. Possible
excavation sites of limestone, iron of Phulchoki and mica were found in an area north of Kathmandu. In addition,
after a study of the grade and quantity of the deposits, all necessary arrangements were to be made so that the
excavation of minerals could be started. The expenditure of the First Plan period amounted to Rs. 1.9 million.
Among its achievements was the discovery of mineral deposits worthy of being developed, including iron ore
deposits of Phulchoki, Labdi and those copper deposits at Wasa and Arkhaula, and gold on the banks of the Ridi
river, and slate deposits at Bandipur. Also deposits of nickel, cobalt, graphite, gypsum, salt, beryl and petroleum
were discovered. The construction of the building of the Bureau of Mines at Lainchaur was almost comleted
during this period. No progress worth mentioning was made regarding the starting in the near future of
exploitation of deposits which have already been discovered or even of the making of all necessary
arrangements before starting exploitation as was envisaged in the First Plan.
During the Second Plan, the development of mineral resources was included with the survey of other
natural resources, such as forest, soil and hydropower. The target of Second Plan was not as ambitious as that the
First Plan with regard to mineral development. It was planned to undertake a detailed survey of different mineral
resources, including pre-investment surveys of the more promising ones,and the establishment of a minerals
laboratory. Under detailed survey, copper deposits at Kulekhani, Nangre Bhorle, Samar Bhamar, Neta, Darling
and Tamghas; cobalt and nickel deposits at Arkhule; gas, lignite and groundwater in the Kathmandu Valley;
marble deposits at Godavari and placer gold on the Banks of Kali Gandaki were to be examined. On the other
hand, iron deposits at Phulchoki, Labdi and Those; copper deposits at Baglung, and mica deposits at East No.1
and West No. 1 districts were included for the pre-investment survey.
A sum of Rs. 1.3 million was spent for the development of mineral resources during the Second Plan
period. The achievements of this Plan period were the completion of construction of the building and laboratory
of the Bureau of Mines at Lainchaur, the investigation for petroleum in Dailekh and Surkhet districts, the
geological survey of 1,000 square miles, the completion of a preliminary survey of mica deposits at East No.1
and East No.2 districts, and the discovery of new mineral deposits at several different places.
During the Third Plan, Rs. 20 million was allocated for the development of mineral resources. A
geological survey was to be given top priority during this period. This survey was to be undertaken in search of
the basic minerals essential for industrial development. Among its targets were a pre-investment survey of
Phulchoki iron ore deposits; a detailed survey of copper deposits at Bandipur, Illam and East No. 1 and
preliminary work in the commercial exploration of the most profitable copper deposits; an investigation for gold
on the banks of Kali Gandaki and Rapti rivers; a detailed survey of mica deposits at East No. 1 and West No.1 in
order to start commercial production; a survey of the possibility of oil and gas at Piuthan and Chisapani; and a
feasibility study of industries based on mineral resources. Until the second year of the Third Plan, work regarding
geological surveys and mines was being undertaken by the Bureau of Mines. It was, however, decided to set up a
separate Geological Survey Department, thereby making the two departments responsible for the development of
mineral resources. A detailed survey of limestone deposits at Bhainse and Chobar, Magnesite deposits at
Kamphughat, Kharidhunga pyrite at Beringkhola and Karrakhola in Hetauda was completed in the Third Plan by
the Bureau of Mines. Placer gold in Marsyangadi and Seti rivers, brine at Lamjung, pegmatite and mica at
Lamjung and semi-precious stones in Sankhuwasabha district were also investigated. In the same way,
preliminary studies were made concerning the possible production of dead burnt Magnesite and fused magnesium
phosphate from the Kharidhunga magnestic deposits, glass from Karrakhola sand deposit, and sulphur and
sulphuric acid from the pyrite deposits at Bering Khola. Because the first cement factory to be sent up in the
country was to utilize limestone deposit from Chobar, detailed investigation work on the Bhainse limestone
deposit was discontinued. Since the Magnesite deposit of Kampughat turned out to be a low grade one, the
detailed survey of magnesitedeposit of Kharidhunga has been continued and will be completed by the first year of
the Fourth Plan period. A detailed investigation of lead and zinc deposits of Ganesh Himal is being conducted by
a private foreign company under the Nepal Mines Act. It is estimated that 0.25 million tons of Proved and 1.5
million tons of Semi-proved 8 per cent ore have been discovered by the end of the Third Plan. The Geological
Survey Department did regional mapping of 8,550 sq. miles of different zones including Mahakali, Seti, Gandaki
and Lumbini as well as reconnaissance mapping of 3,000 sq. miles. In addition, preliminary surveys were done of
copper deposits at Siddhikhani, Illam, Wapsa Khani in Solukhumbu, pegmatite deposits north of Kathmandu and
phosphate deposits at different places.
During the preceeding three plan periods, more attention was devoted to attempts to discover new mineral
deposit in different areas of the country, rather than to detailed planned investigation of deposits already
discovered in different geographic regions of the country. Consequently, it was not possible to get detailed results
on most of the deposits. It could be said that no detailed investigation and evaluation of mineral deposit could be
undertaken because of lack of trained manpower, unequipped laboratory facilities, and a program which was
inconsistent with the targets. Similarly, the geological survey was done in a scattered and unplanned way,
sometimes resulting in duplication and sometimes in no work at all being done.
Fourth Plan
The objectives of the geological survey are the preparation of geological maps, the systematic exploration
and investigation of the mineral resources of the country and the publication of geological data after their
collection. In accordance with the implementation policy of the Fourth Plan period, priority will be given to areas
found to be most feasible on the basis of previous studies. Intensive investigation will be limited to those areas
which have been given top priority. The operational objectives regarding mineral are to conduct the necessary
investigation and analysis of mineral resources of Nepal after a thorough study is done with respect to grade and
quantity, to make feasibility studies of mineral industries, to cooperate in the working of such industries and to
increase the national income by the development of such industries. In order to implement these operational
objectives of the Fourth Plan, preliminary investigation will be conducted on sites found to be feasible by the
Geological Survey. In addition, emphasis will be given to the preparation of reports on the mineral deposits
found to be feasible by those of preliminary surveys done so far and to the preparation of a study concerning the
industrial utilization of mineral deposits.
As surveys and studies in many areas with limited resources are not likely to result in solid achievements,
the Fourth Plan will try to make the programmes of the Geological Survey and the Bureau of Mines more
ambitious then previous plans, as well as try to implement objectives with concrete project. Attempts will also be
made to reach definite conclusions on the feasibility of different projects involving investigation of mineral
deposits. The tradition of continually including investigation unfeasible project in different plans will be
abandoned. The foreign technical assistance essential for the implementation of projects will be secured. In
addition, modern equipments will be imported in order to adopt new techniques in geological survey and mineral
investigations and to expand the laoboratory. It is hloped that increased investment and efforts in the
development of mineral resources during the Fourth Plan period will result in some concrete achievements which
will be helpful in the initialization and development of the country. It has also become essential to coordinate to
the maximum possible extent the programmes and operations of the two departments involved (i.e. Geological
Survey and Survey, and the detailed Geological-Mineral Survey under integrated Geo-effective. A separate
temporary project office utilizing foreign technical personnel will be responsible for the implementation of
Aeromagnetic Survey, and the detailed Geological-Mineral Survey under integrated Geological Minerals
Investigation. Although the Geological Survey will be primarily responsible Fourth Plan this, the cooperation of
the Bureau of Mines will also be sought.
A.
Geological Survey:
1.
In the context of investigation for petroleum in the Western Terai area between Koilabas and Nepalgunj,
exploratory drilling will be done as well as geophysical, magnetic and seismic studies. This area has been
considered to be the most probable site for the discovery Fourth Plan petroleum in Nepal. This view is also
shared by United Nations specialists who have visited Nepal. Preference will, therefore, be given to drilling in
this area. If petroleum were discovered the surplus production could be exported to foreign countries. This could
thus make a heavy impact upon the national economy. Rs. 24 million will be spent for this purpose during the
Plan period.
2.
Arrangement of Preliminary Investigation for Petroleum in Western Terai (NepalgunjDhangadhi):
According to the specialists, the area between Nepalgunj and Dhangadhi is worth investigating, although there is
less likelihood of discovering petroleum in this area than between Koilabas and Nepalgunj. With regard to
progress made in the search for petroleum in the Koilabas-Nepalgunj area, preliminary work will be done on this
project.
3.
The fuel problem in Kathmandu Valley could be partially solved if a gas reservoir could be located. Even at the
present time, limited amounts of gas are being utilized as fuel. The equipment made available for this programme
could be utilized for other projects as well. A geophysical survey and exploratory drilling will be conducted for
this purpose.
4.
Phosphate Exploration:
Exploration for phosphate rocks will be done in Lumbini, Seti and Mahakali zones. The discovery of phosphate
rocks could be helpful in the development of agriculture, as it is utilized in the manufacture of fertilizers.
5.
Regional Mapping:
Under this project, detailed surface geological surveys of different places Rapti, Bheri, Karnali and Dhaulagiri
zones will be conducted. Since it deals with the preparation Fourth Plan a detailed geological map of the country,
it could be considered to be a basic for the development of mineral resources.
6.
Reconnaissance Mapping:
Under this project, through Scale geological mapping will be done in different places in Sagarmatha, Kosi,
Mahakali and Seti zones. Surveying of this kind will provide a base for detailed geological mapping at a later
time.
7.
Deposits found to be promising on the basis of geological survey (e.g. Phosphate at Dharan) will be further
investigated in detail in order to utilize them as soon as possible.
8.
Various equipments necessary Fourth Plan ruse in the laboratory will be made available under this project. In
order to increase the utility of data and samples collected in the field in the context of geological survey works, it
is necessary to study them in detail in the laboratory equipped with modern equipments is a must for the
successful implementation of any geological survey.
B.
1.
An aeromagnetic survey of about 128,000 sq. km. (50,000 sq. miles) of territory in different parts of Nepal will
be conducted on contract. Detection of mineral deposits from the surface level alone is often time consuming and
neither systematic nor practical.
The magnetic anomaly obtained with the help of an aeromagnetic survey aids in the detection of the
presence of iron, lead, copper and zinc deposits. On the basis of such anomalies it is easy to conduct surface
exploration in a systematic manner and to give priorities to different areas for further work. Such detailed mineral
exploration and investigations will be conducted at some selected localities. After the preparation of an
aeromagnetic map Fourth Plan the country, foreign mining companies might be expected to conduct detailed
exploration of mineral resources in different parts of the country.
2.
Under this programme, 25,000 sq. km. of territory in Gandaki, Dhaulagiri and Lumbini zones will be studied in
detail by integrating geological-physical and geochemical methods. As the well-known old copper deposits of
Baglung, Okharbot and vicinity are located in this area, it will be easier, to study the density of deposits,
including those deep beneath the earth.
3.
This is similar to the project envisaged for Western Nepal. Under this Project, preliminary work on the
investigation of mineral resources will be conducted by integrating geological, geophysical and geologicalchemical methods.
C.
available under this project. As it is not possible to conduct any detailed mineral exploration
effectively without this equipment and machinery, this project is an important and unseparable
part of the detailed exploration programmes of mineral resources.
10. Laboratory and research:
This kind of service product which includes setting up reinforcing or expanding chemical, mineral, ore
dressing, and physical testing laboratories; drafting , duplicating and photo services; repair shops, and a mineral
museum and library. As no work dealing with the development of mineral resources could be implemented
successfully without well equipped laboratories and research facilities, this is an essential and important project.
11. Feasibility Study of Mineral Based Industries:
Feasibility studies of the following mineral based industries will be done under this project:
(a)
Feasibility study of those industries based upon the Magnesite deposit of Karidhunga and the cement
industry based upon the limestone deposit of Bhainse.
(b)
Reviews of the iron and steel industry based upon the iron ore deposits of Phulchoki, the glass industry
based upon Karrakhola deposits in Hetauda, the utilization of pyrite deposits at Bering Khola and the
nitrogeneous fertilizer industry.
(c)
Feasibility studies of paint, building stone, marble, concrete products, lime (small scale), ceramic,
pesticide and fertilizer blading industries.
(d)
Feasibility study of newly discovered deposits (i.e. the industrial utilization of phosphate). This will be
done in different stages and coordinated with the detailed investigation of related mineral deposits. As
soon as proper technical and economic justification is established by the Department on the basis of
preliminary study in the first stage, the services of qualified and experienced foreign consultants will be
made available fro a detailed feasibility study.
Geological Survey:
39.5
24.0
0.2
5.0
4. Phosphate Exploration
0.25
5. Regional Mapping
1.2
6. Reconnaissance Mapping
0.25
4.0
5.0
22.7
12.5
10.0
.2
11.9
2.
0.15
3.
0.35
0.02
4.
1.0
5.
6.
0.6
0.05
7.
0.2
8.
0.6
9.
2.0
10.
4.6
11.
2.05
12.
0.1
_________________
Grand Total
Rs. 74.5
CHAPTER XX
POWER
Electricity occupies an important place in the development of the national economy. It is essential for the
industrialization, agricultural development, and for the development of other sectors. Hydro-electricity is one of
the most economical sources of power in Nepal because of its abundance. Its potentiality is estimated to be 80
million kilowatts. In spite of this, the total hydro- power generated so far has been insignificant. Compared to the
demand, only small hydro- power development have been undertaken so far. This results in the high cost and low
consumption of electrical consumption of electrical power. Keeping in view the development of different sectors,
it can be said that in future, this important source of energy will be harnessed gradually.
Progress to date
Before the commencement of the First Plan, the total power generation in Nepal was 6280 Kw., out of
which hydel- power was 2077 Kw.
In the First Plan, throughout the execution of hydro- electric projects in Trishuli, Thadokhola, Panauti,
Seti, Tinau and other rivers the target for power development was fixed to be 20,000 Kw. For this purpose,
rupees 80 million (9 per cent of the Plan outlay) was allocated. Though some work was done on some projects in
the First Plan, only Teku and Bhaktapur diesel stations were established, generating only 970 Kw. of additional
power. In addition, a preliminary survey of the Karnali, Kali river and Kathmandu Hetauda- Birgunj
transmission line was conducted. In the First Plan, no progress was made in electrical power development in
comparison to the targets. In the interim year between the First and the Second Plan, 1056 Kw. of diesel power
were made available. The target for the Second Plan (Three year) was 22,000 Kw. of additional power, and the
monetary allocation was 91 million rupees. During the Plan period, Panauti project, Thadokhola project, Trishuli
project and other hydro electric projects were to be undertaken; and in Hetauda, Birgunj, Nepalgunj and
Biratnagar, diesel installations with a capacity of over 10,000 Kw. were to be established. In addition, four small
diesel installations, four small Hdel projects (Micro plants ), and the Kathmandu Birgunj 66 Kv transmission
line were to be constructed. In the Second Plan period, Panauti project with a capacity of 2400 Kw., Patan diesel
plant with a capacity of 1470 Kw., and Birgunj diesel plant with a capacity of 560 Kw. were brought into
operation. In addition to this, construction on the Kathmandu Birgunj transmission line was started , and the
Sunkoshi and Karnali project surveys were continued.
In the Third Plan it was proposed to increase the generated power by 60,000kw and Rupees 260 million
or 15 per cent of Plan outlay were allocated for this purpose. The targets for the Plan period were to generate
18,000 Kw. at Trishuli, 10,000kw at Gandaki, and 7500 Kw. at Koshi; to conduct detailed surveys of
Marshyangdi, Kali and Kulekhani to select the most economical for execution of project thereby adding 18,000
Kw. of power; to complete the construction of KathmanduHetauda-Birgunj 66 Kv transmission line, to
complete the survey of Gandak- Bhairahawa-Butwal and Gandak- Hetauda transmission lines; to conduct the
survey of Kankai project; to electrify Jhapa, Illam, Rajbiraj with small diesel plants; and to complete construction
and survey work of Karnali. Later, the revised Third Plan fixed the target of increased power capacity to 36,000
Kw. or 60 per cent of the original target of 60,000 Kw. The Sunkoshi Hydel project, the Gandak project and the
Gandak-Hetauda and Gandak-Bhairahawa transmission line construction were scheduled for this Plan period.
The Sunkoshi- Ramechhap- Udaipur- Garhi- Janakpur transmission line project was referred in this Plan.
By the middle of the Third Plan, the total supply of power has been increased by 19,960 Kw. primarily
from Trishuli project (12,000kw) from Pokhara Hydel project (1000kw) from Hetauda Diesel station (4470 Kw.)
and from Patan and Biratnagar diesel installations (2490kw) . The revised Third Plan targets have not been
completely fulfilled because the Koshi and Trishuli project could not deliver power as scheduled. In this Plan
period, construction work was started on the Sunkoshi project and the small hydel project at Dhankuta. The
Kathmandu Birgunj 66 Kv transmission line is almost complete, and construction of the Dharan-Dube
transmission line has been started. The survey work in Kulekhani project was completed, and survey work for
Kankai project is being continued. Koshi power was made available to Rajbiraj and the electrification of
Janakpur, Bharatpur and Bhairahawa was started. In different hilly areas, surveys were conducted for small
hydro- power projects (micro- plants).
Considering the power development schemes so far executed, the achievements during the First Plan
period were insignificant. The targets fixed for the First Plan were highly ambitious, and the technical and
economic feasibility studies for most of the projects had not been done. In the Second and Third Plan progress
can be said to be satisfactory compared to the original targets. In these two Plan periods, the achievement of
targets has been short due to the non-availability of power from projects like Trishuli, Koshi and Gandak.
Fourth Plan
In Nepal the objectives of power development are to make power available for the development of
national economy by utilizing the water resources; to make power available in urban and rural areas, thereby
helping in the development of agriculture and industry; and to utilize water resources properely in order to
increase national income. In order to fulfill these objectives, the following policy will be followed in the Fourth
Plan.
In Bagmati and Narayani zones during the first half of the Plan period, power generation will exceed
demand. Hence priority will be given to transmission and network improvements in order to increase the
consumption of power for industrial, agricultural and domestic purposes. By the end of the Plan, power
consumption in this area will increase. Therefore, in the fifth year of the Plan, construction work in Kulekhani
project will be started. In order to increase consumption of power while considering the domestic fuel problems,
the imposition of a power tariff would be made more practical. In order to fulfill the power demand of the
industrial area of the Eastern Terai, construction of Kankai hydel project will be undertaken in this Plan period,
as well as making power available from the Koshi project. Since the execution of a big project like Karnali in the
near future does not seem likely, the construction of a medium sized hydel project like Babai will be undertaken
to meet increasing domestic and industrial demand in the Western Terai. In order to increase the consumption of
generated power, transmission lines will be constructed. Demand in those Terai areas away from hdel power
project sites will be met by diesel installations, and pending other arrangements by buying power from India.
Only after completely utilizing the stand- by diesel sets from Bagmati and Narayani zones, new diesel power
plants involving foreign exchange will be imported from abroad. In the hilly areas, two small hydro- power plants
(micro- plants) will be constructed (one in the West and one in the Far West). Construction of a small hydropower plant was started during the Third Plan at Dhankuta in eastern Nepal. At the end of the Fourth Plan period,
efforts will be made to make power available in at least at one place in 12 of the 14 zones in the country.
In the Fourth Plan period, a total of 40,300 Kw. of power will be generated as follows: Trishuli
(additional) 9000kw, Gandak 10,000kw, and Koshi 6,800kw, diesel installations 4,000kw, and small hydel
projects 500kw (including Dhankuta). The importance attached to power development in the Plan is reflected by
the fact that construction on projects like Kankai, Babai and Kulekhani, which have a combined capacity of
68,000kw, will be started in the Fourth Plan period. Since the technical and economic studies of the projects
included in the Plan (as well as the load forecasts) have been more reliable, it can be expected that the difference
between targets and achievements during the Plan period will not be much. It can be said that the projects
included in the Plan will be successfully implemented. The new projects which will be started in this Plan period
are Kankai, Babai and Kulekhani. In the eastern part of the country, Biratnagar has become a foremost industrial
area, but the power supply there has been in shortage and expensive. It is estimated that the demand by 1975 will
be over 11,000kw and by 1980 about 20,000kw. It will be met by inexpensive power from Kankai. The Babai
project in Nepalgunj area will be initiated in the Fourth Plan to meet the demand of that area in the Fifth Plan
period. In Bagmati and Narayani zones, the power generation capacity will be 36,540 by 1976 and the peak load
demand by 1977 will be 38,400kw. Therefore, the Kulekhani Hydel Project will be started in the final year of the
Plan.
During the Fourth Plan perod, the power development projects are divided into five categories as
follows: construction, transmission line, small hydel projects, diesel installations and survey. The detailed
description of the projects included in these five categories are as follows:
A. Construction
1. Sunkoshi Hydel Project
This project has been continuing since the Third Plan period. 10,000kw of power will be generated
by the construction of a dam on the Sunkoshi river and 57 kilometers of transmission line will be constructed. It
will fulfill the increasing demand of the Kathmandu Valley after its completion in the second year of the Fourth
Plan period.
2. Kankai Hydel Project (Multipurpose)
In this project 30,000kw of power will be generated by the construction of a 60 meter high dam in the
Kankai river of Jhapa district. In addition to power development, irrigation for 46,000 hectares of land will be
made available. Of the total cost of Rupees 100 million, 60.5 million will be spent in this Plan period. The
project will be completed by the Fiscal Year 1975-76. Accorking to preliminary reports, construction cost per
unit will be 52 paisa, and the unit cost of power will be 5 paisa. Power will be made available to the industrial
areas of Biratnagar, Illam and Bhadrapur. Since the demand of this area is mostly industrial, and the demand by
1975 will exceed 11,000kw and by 1980, 20,000 Kw., the project will satisfy the demand by making available
inexpensive power for industrial and domestic purposes.
3. Babai Hydel Projec
Under this project, power will be generated from the Babai River in the western part of the Dang
Valley and will be distributed to Nepalgunj and the Dang Valley areas. Due to a lack of arrangements for
financing and marketing facilities, construction work on the Karnali Hydel project, may not materialize in the
near future. Hence a medium-sized project such as Babai has been undertaken to meet the industrial demand of
Nepalgunj and adjoining areas. This will be completed in 4 years and the estimated cost will be about Rupees 45
million. During this Plan period Rupes 10 million have been allocated for this project.
4. Kulekhani Hydel Project
Under this project, 32,000 Kw. of power will be generated by diverting the water of Kulekhani river
through 4250 meter tunnel. The total investment for the project will be Rupees 245 million, the construction cost
per unit will be 1.43 rupees, and the cost of generated power per unit will be 13 paisa. In consideration of the
domestic and industrial demand of the Bagmati and Narayani zones, construction on this project will start by the
final year of the Fourth Plan period and will be completed during the Fifth Plan period.
B. Transmission Lines
1.
10,000 Kw. of power from Gandak project will be made available to Nepal. It has been mentioned
in the Gandak project agreement between India and Nepal that the power house in Gandak will be transferred to
Nepal when the load factor attains 60 per cent. So long as the load factor does not attain 60 per cent, Nepal has to
buy from Idia the power generated from this project. From this project, power will be distributed to the Chitwan
Valley and it will meet the demand in Hetauda, Birgunj and Kathmandu areas.
2.
Parasi-Butwal 33 Kv Line
Under this project, power from Gandak project will be brought to Butwal by the construction of a
transmission line.
3.
4.
Under this project, power generated in the Kosi project will be brought to Etahari, Inarwa, Rangeli
and Dharan areas by the construction of a transmission line. Work on this project was started in the Third Plan
period.
5.
Kankai-Biratnagar 66 Kv Line
A transmission line will be constructed to transmitpower from Kankai to Biratnagar. This project
with a total cost of Rupees 11 million will be completed by the Fiscal Year 1975-76.
6.
A transmission line will be constructed to carry power from the Kankai Project to meet the domestic
and industrial demands of the Bhadrapur areas.
7.
Under this project, power will be distributed to different areas by the construction of transmission
line between Siraha and Janakpur.
8.
Kathmandu-Birgunj 66 Kv Line
This is a continuing project, the last phase of which is the construction of a sub-station, to be
completed by the first yeat of the Fourth Plan periob
9. Pokhara-Khaireni 33 Kv Line
Under this project power from Pokhara Hydel Project will be transmitted to the agricultural
development project at Khairenitar.
C. Small Hydel Project Based on Development Growth Axis
1. Dhankuta
Under this project a small hydel project (240Kw) construction started at Dhankuta during the Third
Plan period will be completed in the Fourth Plan period.
2. Baglung
Under this project, a 150kw small hydel power station will be constructed to electrify
Baglung and the adjoining areas.
3. Jumla
Under this project, a small hydro- power station to be completed by the Fiscal Year 1973-74 will be
constructed in the far west of the country in Jumla.
Under this project, one diesel plant with a capacity of 2980kw will be shifted from Hetauda to
Biratnagar, and a new diesel plant will be set up at Biratnagar and to distribute power to that area.
2.
Under this project, work will be completed by the second year of the Fourth Plan period to meet the
demand of the area until power from the Gandak project is available.
3.
Under this project, 500kw diesel sets will be shifted from Kathmandu to Bhairahawa, and power to meet
the deficit will be bought from India and distributed.
4.
To fulfill the demand of power in this area until the Babai project is completed a 500kw diesel station
will be established by the fiscal year 1971/72.
6.
Under this project, 500kw diesel sets will be shifted from Kathmandu Valley to this area. The
electrification of Janakpur will also be carried by purchasing power from India. This work will be completed by
the first year of the Plan period.
7.
Under this project, a 200kw diesel station benifitting 4,000 people at Fatehpur in Sagarmatha zone will
be established by the first year of the Plan period.
8.
Under this project, power will be made available to Mahendranagar in Mahakali zone by purcahasing
from India. This project will be completed by the second year of the Plan period.
9.
Under this project, a new 200kw diesel station will be established in Tansen Palpa. Since the Siddartha
Rajmarga is almost completed, and since this town lies on the growth axis and the development of the town from
the view point of tourism is also well recognized, this project will be completed during the first half of the Plan
period.
10.
Besides completing the Kathmandu Birgunj Transmission line available power will be distributed to
Kalaiya, Birgunj, Simra, Parawanipur, Pathlaiya, Jitpur and other places by constructing 11 Kv and 440 Volt
Lines.
E. Survey
1.
After the completion of the Karnali project,generated power will exceed demand in the eastern Terai
area for some years. It is essential that a feasibility report of a hydel project should be on hand in order to fulfill
the demand of this area after 10 years. Therefore, the detailed survey of Puwa Khola is included in the Plan.
2.
A preliminary survey of this project was conducted by experts in 1960. A detailed survey of Kali
Gandaki loop near Deoghat will be conducted in order to meet future demand in Palpa, Syangja, Tanahun,
Gorkha, Lamjung and other places and to make available power for electrification in Bagmati and Narayani
zones.
3.
A detailed survey of Kali Gandaki loop near Ridi will be conducted in order to meet the future demand
of power in Baglung , Myagdi, Parbat, Gulmi, Arghakhanchi districts, and Pokhara and its adjoining areas.
4.
A preliminary survey of the Chamelia river will be conducted for a medium-sized hydel project which
might meet demand for power in Baitadi, Dadheldura, Darchula, Doti, Kailali and Kanchanpur.
5.
Preliminary Survey for a hydel project on the Tamur and Arun rivers will be conducted. This would
enable future demand for power in the hilly regions in Mechi, Koshi and Sagarmatha zones, and Biratnagar area
to be met.
6.
Under this project a survey will be conducted in the hilly areas of Nepal regarding the possibility of
establishing micro-plants.
7.
A survey of a transmission line from Narayani zone to Mechi zone to connect the defferent power
systems operating in central and eastern Nepal into a single grid will be conducted.
8.
In order to meet the increasing demand of the adjoining areas and to utilize the power to be available
from Kali Gandaki in the future, survey will be done for the construction of a Butwal-Pokhara transmission line.
9.
A survey will be conducted to transmit the power generated in Sunkoshi which has not been consumed
in Bagmati and Narayani zones to Janakpur.
10.
Under this project, the survey of essential transmission lines will be conducted keeping in view the
demand at different places, as well as the excess power in other areas.
TABLE 119
PROPOSED INVESTMENT IN POWER DEVELOPMENT
(Rs. In Million )
A. Construction
1. Sunkosi Hydel Project
57.5
65.0
10.0
2.5
Total
135.0
B. Transmission Line
1. Gandak-Hetauda 132 Kv Line
30.0
2. Parasi-Butwal 33 Kv Line
3.3
5.1
3.5
5. Kankai-Biratnagar 66 Kv Line
3.0
2.5
5.0
1.5
1.0
Total:
55.0
1.1
2. Baglung
1.6
3. Jumla
2.0
Total:
4.7
Biratnagar Diesel Power Installation (one old and one new plant)
2.
4.0
0.3
1.8
1.9
6.
2.1
2.4
0.3
1.4
1.0
3.0
Total:
18.2
E. Survey
1. Detailed Survey of Puwa Khola Hydel Project (Jhapa)
2.0
2.0
2.0
1.0
0.5
0.4
2.5
0.5
0.5
1.0
Total:
12.4
225.3
Appendix I
150
Dube
-
Rangele
-
1968-69
2700
100
2800
1969-70
3300
200
3500
1970-71
3900
230
330
490
170
5120
1971-72
4600
260
360
560
200
6000
1972-73
5500
300
440
650
220
7110
3000
5980
Demand in Ilam area within the next 5 and 10 years will be 200 Kw. and 440 Kw. respectively. For the same
period in Bhadrapur area, the demand will be 700 Kw. and 1400Kw, respectively.
2.
6800 Kw. of power will be available from Kosi project. Since this power will be genearated from the canal,
expert opinion suggests that it will not be abailable all the time. Heavy silt deposit problem will make it a not
very dependable source of power.
3.
260 Kw. diesel set belonging to Morang Hydro Company, as well 900 Kw. diesel and 1400Kw steam set
belonging to Biratnagar Jute Mills are old.
4.
The target for Biratnagar is such that 2980 Kw. of power from diesel will available by the Fiscal Year 197172, and still 2900 Kw. more wil be available by the Fiscal Year 1973-74.
5.
It is targeted to make available hydel power from Kankai project by the Fiscal Year 1975/76.
Appendix 2
APPROXIMATE MAXIMUM DEMAND OF KATHMANDU VALLEY AND THE ADJOINING AREAS
Year
Power available
in Kw.
1969-70
12,600
11,500
15,540
1970-71
14,600
13,700
21,540
1971-72
16,800
16,200
31,540
1972-73
19,100
18,900
36,540
1973-74
21,500
21,900
36,540
1974-75
26,350
25,400
36,540
1975-76
29,200
29,200
36,540
1976-77
32,100
33,600
36,540
1977-78
35,600
38,400
36,540
1978-79
38,890
43,600
36,540
1979-80
42,500
1980-81
46,300
Notes
1.
The approximate estimates for Kathmandu Valley and adjoining areas made by Nippon Koei include Hetauda,
Birgunj area as well as Butwal and Bhairahawa areas.
2.
In Kathmandu Valley and adjoining areas Nepal Electricity Corporation, Kathmandu Valley and adjoining areas
includes in addition to Kathmandu such areas as Banepa, Trishuli, etc. which are being supplied by the
Corporation now.
3.
Available hydel power capacity has been included as provided by the Corporation. According to this approximate
estimate, only 5000kw out of power from Gandak will be distributed to Kathmandu Valley and adjoining areas.
As some of the diesel plants from the Valley will be transferred to Terai areas and some will be left as standbys
they are not included in the chart.
4.
The construction of Kulekhani project will be started by the Fiscal Year 1974-75.
Appendix 3
APPROXIMATE MAXIMUM DEMAND IN NEPALGUNJ AND ADJOINING AREAS
According to Electricity Department
Acording to Nippon
Year
Koei In Kw.
General
Industrial
Demand
Demand
Available power
in Kw.
1967-68
260
1968-69
1969-70
100
1970-71
330
628
1971-72
400
705
1972-73
480
845
600
1973-74
570
1017
1974-75
690
1216
4000
1975-76
820
1334
1976-77
960
1472
1977-78
1130
1619
1978-79
1320
1741
1979-80
1510
1959
1980-81
1740
2167
Notes
1.
According to estimates by Nippon Koei, maximum demand in the first five year period will rise by 20 to 25 per
cent annually and after that by 15 to 20 per cent. All the existing industrial demand at present is not included in
this report. In Electricity Department study, the demand of Dang and Sallyan is included.
2.
An industrial estate in Nepalgunj will be established in the near future. The demand created by this estate has not
been included in estimates. Maximum demand of Balaju Industrial Estate in Kathmandu is about 125 Kw. Since
there is the possibility of a paper mill being established in Nepalgunj during the Fourth Plan period, there may be
quite a large demand for power.
3.
500 Kw. of diesel power will be made available in Nepalgunj by the Fiscal Year 1971-72.
4.
It is targeted to make available 800 Kw. of hydel power from Babai project by the Fiscal Year 1976-77.
CHAPTER XXI
HYDROLOGY AND METEOROGY
Hydrological data are indispensible in the successful implementation of any hydro electric or
irrigation projects. No design of the production hydro-electric power or the area to be irrigated and distribution
system of canals could possibly be done without relevant data on the discharge of the stream, including the
periodic fluctuations and minimum amount of water to be available. Although the importance of such data seems
to be somewhat limited at first glance, it would not be an exaggeration to state that hydrological data is the most
fundamental data in any project dealing with the development of water resources. Such data have also been found
to be useful in the design of bridges and in the forecasting of floods. By the proper study of data on
sedimentation; dams and reservoirs could be designed in such a manner that they will control silting. The utility
of meteorological data is in such divers fields as civil aviation, agriculture, and weather forecasting. The
exploration and utilization of ground water resources in a systematic way can result in large scale increases in
agricultural production.
Progress to date
To collection and study of hydrological and meteorological data in a systematic manner was not
started in Nepal until the beginning of the Second Plan. In the Second Plan, hydrological surveys were included
along with soil surveys, forest resources surveys and mineral surveys. During the Second Plan, 51 steam gauging
stations were built and Rs. 2.68 million were spent for hydrological surveying. American Aid was also available
from the beginning of Second Plan to the first half of the Third Plan for this purpose. In the Third Plan, Rs. 14
million were allocated for hydrological survey and included in the Plan under a separate chapter. The target of
the Third Plan was to establish 49 stream gauging stations, meteorological stations, a laboratory to analyze the
quality of water and sediment samples, to begin weather forecasting, and to assess the possibility of utilizing
ground water resources in Kathmandu Valley and the Terai. In the revised version of the Third Plan, it was
envisaged to start an extensive exploration for groundwater in the western Terai, to continue collecting data on
sedimentation, and to start preliminary work on setting up a laboratory.
Among the achievements of the Third Plan, there has been satisfactory progress in establishing
hydrological and meteorological stations. Weather forcasting was started durng this Plan period. Four booklets
consisting of the surface water records of Nepal were published annually. Also, one booklet on climatological
records of Nepal was published. But there has been hardly any progress in the collection of data on sedimentation
and the interpretative study of this data as envisaged in the Third Plan. Preliminary data on ground water
resources in the Terai area of Lumbini, Bheri, Seti and Mahakali zones was collected. A detailed explration of
ground water in the Rupandehi district of Lumbini zone (Bhairahawa area) was also started in the final year of
the Third Plan with American assistance.
Fourth Plan
The objective of hydrological surveys is to Nepal by collecting data on surface and ground water and
making available such data as it is needed in the implementation of development projects in power, drinking
water and irrigation. The main objective of the meteorological survey is to make meteorological data (rainfall,
temperature, humidity etc) available and to make daily weather forecasts. The following policy will be adopted in
order to implement these objectives during the Fourth Plan period. The number of stream gauging stations to
collect hydrological data will be further increased as needed on a regional basis. Futher emphases will be put on
the interpretative study of hydrological data so far collected. The number of stations for the collection of
meteorological data will also be increased, and data thus collected will be studied in an analytical manner.
1. Surface Water Investigation
Under the Fourth Plan, 10 stream gauging stations, 20 crest gauge stations, 10
Stream gauging stations, 10 cable way, 15 automatic recorders, and 15 sediment sampling stations will
be established. In addition, maintenance work on 55 stream gauging stations established in the preceeding years
will be continued.
2. Meteorological Investigation:
Under the Fourth Plan period, 193 additional meteorological stations (for measurement of temperature
rainfall etc) will be established in different parts of Nepal, and maintenance work on 70 already existing
meteorological stations, will be continued. Weather forecasting will be made more reliable.
3. Ground Water Investigation of Terai Portion of Lumbini, Bheri, Seti and Mahakali Zones
Implementation of this project was started in the final year of the Third Plan period with American
assistance. Ground water investigation in Nawal-Parasi and Kapilvastu districts of Lumbini zones, Banke and
Bardia districts of Bheri zone, Kailali district of Seti zone, and Kanchanpur district of Mahakali zone will be
completed in the first phase of the Fourth Plan period. It is hoped that agricultural production in the
comparatively dry western Terai area of Nepal will be increased with the utilization of ground water developed
from data collected under this programme with ground water the crops in this area will not have to depend solely
upon the monsoon.
4. Preliminary work on Investigation of Ground Water Resources of Chitwan (Rapti Valley) and Dang
Valley
This two valleys constitute important agricultural areas of Nepal. One of the main problem in this area is
a lack of an adequate amount of water for irrigation. A systematic survey of ground water resources of the two
valleys will be undertaken and followed by a preliminary investigation at the end of Fourth Plan period.
TABLE 120
ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE IN HYDROLOGY AND METEOROLOGY
Estimated expenditure
(Rs. In Million)
1. Surface Water Investigation
6.0
2. Meteorological Survey
4.0
3. Groundwater Investigation of Terai Portion of Lumbini,
Bheri, Seti and Mahakali Zones
13.0
4. Survey and Preliminary Investigation of Ground Water
Resources of Chitwan (Rapti Valley) and Dang Valley
1.0
_______
Total:
Rs. 24.0
CHAPTER XXII
EDUCATION
Education plays a very significant role in improving the quality of the population. The primary
necessity in the process of education development is the preparation of the educated manpower required for the
all round development of the country and the provision of basic minimum education to the masses. The
experiences and achievements of earlier plans have made us aware of the need to bring about basic changes in the
present education system. But it is not possible to bring about changes in the education system in the short run. It
is a long-term continuing process and requires some basic changes. The following targets in various education
programmes are set forth in the Fourth Plan, taking these long-term objectives into consideration. It is not
possible to achieve the necessary objectives within the Plan period because of limited financial resources. It is
hoped that some of the policies adopted in the Fourth Plan will form the basis for future development.
Primary Education
The progress made so far in the field of primary education is very encouraging. The number of
primary schools in the kingdom has reached 7,000. About 32 per cent of the primary school-age children have
been provided with primary education facilities. Free and compulsory primary education programmes have been
introduced in the village panchayats of Chitwan and Jhapa districts and in 107 other village panchayats. Fifteen
model primary schools have been set up. However, inspite of this progress, primary education faces a number of
problems. First of all, the number of drop-outs is very high, with a tendency for more drop-outs in the lower
grades. The quality of teaching has suffered considerably due to an inadequate number of teachers in the schools.
The percentage of government aid to the schools reaches a maximum of 93 per cent in some cases, indicating that
local resources have not been adequately mobilized. The lack of adequate finance for other education inputs is
quite obvious since more than 80 percent of the revenue is spent on salary.
Considering the above facts, HMG has adopted a number of specific policies towards the
development of primary education. The target of free and compulsory primary education seems difficult to attain
in the near future. The Fourth Plan aims to provide primary education to 45 per cent of the primary school-going
age children. To achieve this target, 7000 additional classes and a smilar number of teachers will have to be
improved. In remote northern regions, it is not practical to establish schools on the basis of population, and
special provisions will be made to open 250 classes on the basis of distances between villages.
TABLE 121
PRIMARY SCHOOL STUDENTS AND CLASSES
Year
Total
Children receiving
primary education
Increment
Plan period
Population
1969-70
1,10,48,000
14,36,000
5,03,000
1974-75
1,21,56,000
15,80,000
7,11,000
1.
in
Percent of school
going age children
No. of classes
or teachers
35%
20,000
2,08,000
45%
27,3000
So far, HMG has been providing grants to the primary schools according to the number of teachers.
Though the schools spend a majority portion of their income on salary, the salary scale of the teachers is very low
when compared to other professions. As a result, the schools cannot obtain the services of able teachers, thereby
making a great obstacle to the qualitative development of education.
Keeping this in mind, instead of providing grants to the schools, the Government will gradually
provide trained teachers whose salaries will be paid directly by the Government. The regular grant would become
40 percent of the teachers salary in those schools where trained teachers are not available. The number of trained
teachers in the Fourth Plan period would reach 12,300.
2.
Other programmes for the development of primary education, in the Fourth Plan include building
construction, provision of education materials to 2000 primary schools, and improvements in curriculum.
3.
Scholarships
To meet the shortage of teachers in the northern border regions, scholarships will be provided to
students of those areas to enable them to study in the nearby high schools or training centres.
Secondary Education
There were 22 high and 203 middle schools in the country prior to the year 1951. With the advent of
democracy the development of secondary education has been very rapid. By the end of the Third Plan, the
number of high and middle schools is estimated to be 444 and 534 respectively. The secondary school enrolment
is not 18 per cent o f the primary school enrolment. There has been some improvement in the quality of teaching
as a result of the various teacher training programmes organized during the Third Plan period.
The Fourth Plan aims to increase the secondary school enrolment to 20 per cent of the primary school
enrolment. As more of the students terminate their studies after secondary education, the need to emphasize the
quality of teaching, rather then the quantity has become apparent. Therefore, during the Plan period necessary
restrictions will be made concerning the opening up of schools and emphasis will be given to consolidation and
improvement of the existing ones.
1.
So far, the Government grant is only 20 per cent of the total expenditure of secondary schools, with
the remaining 80 percent being borne b the public. It has not been possible to run the secondary schools in an
organized way, because of limited Government aid. Therefore, instead of the present system of grants, it is
roposed to provide 50 percent of the salary of the secondary school teachers in the form of grants. For this, it is
essential that the Educaiton Department make the necessary arrangements for the salary to be paid directly to the
teachers.
2.
Intensive training in various fields has been provided to the teachers during the last few years with the
objective of making the secondary school teachers more proficient in their subjects. About 1500 additional
teachers will be given short-term training in science, mathematics, English, nepali and social sciences during the
Plan period.
3.
As 20 per cent of the existing secondary schools do not have their own buildings, it has been difficult
to run them effectively. His Majesty's Government will provide grants to build 30 school and 30 hostel buildings
during the Plan period. The grants will cover 50 per cent of the total cost of the project.
4.
Others
a.
With a view to
improve the quality of secondary schools, 500 schools will be provided with furniture and
education materials.
b.
A model residential
secondary school with a high standard of teach- about necessary improvements in the
curriculum
c.
Education
inspector
offices will be strengthened for the regular inspection and guidance of secondary schools.
d.
Provision will be made
to reward teachers with prizes and other facilities of the basis of their work.
Budhanilkantha School
A model residential secondary school with a high standard of teaching will be established at
Budhanilkantha under foreign assistance during Fourth Plan. Altogether 470 students will be accommodated in
the school, and special provisions will be made to secure adequate seats for students coming from outside the
Kathmandu Valley.
Secondary Multipurpose Education
Under the present system of education, the requirements of manpower in various vocational areas
cannot be met from high school graduates alone. In the absence of vocational knowledge, they cannot be self
supporting and tend to depend on Government jobs. So far, twenty-nine multipurpose schools have been set up to
improve this situation. As the operating cost of multipurpose schools is very high, it is not possible to establish a
large number of such schools in the near future. Therefore, during the Fourth Plan, only a few additional
multipurpose schools will be established, although separate provisions will be made to include one vocational
subject (in grade 9 and 10) in as many secondary schools as possible.
Adult Education
The adult education programme aims at gradually reducing the rate of illiteracy in the country. During
the Third Plan, 1,00,000 adults are expected to become literate, and the literacy rate is expected to reach 11.8 per
cent. The programme has received active support from various Class Organizations. The Fourth Plan aims to
raise the literacy rate to 15 per cent. Some of this increase will be due to the primary education programme.
There are, at present, 37 permanent adult education centres in the country. During the Fourth Plan , these will be
further consolidated and improved and 38 additional centres will be opened.
In addition a special work-oriented adult education programme will be started in Chitwan district with
UNESCO assistance, and on the basis of the experience in Chitwan, such functional literacy programmes will be
expanded in other areas.
Higher Education
Progress in higher education has been mainly in terms of quantity during earlier Plans. In comparison
to 29 colleges at the beginning of the Third Plan, the number of colleges at present has reached 40. A high
percentage of the high school graduates are enrolled in the colleges with a majority of them taking liberal art
subjects. The higher education programme in the Fourth Plan will be formulated with a long-term view to make
it qualitative and more practical. Emphasis will be given to vocational oriented education at the secondary level
in order to control the increasing trend towards the non-vocational type of higher education. Arrangement will be
made to allow the students to enter higher education only on the basis of merit. In order to fulfil the above
objectives, the following steps will be taken in the Fourth Plan period:
1.
His Majesty's Government will formulate a specific policy on the expansion of higher
education
2.
The opening up of new colleges during the Plan period will be generally restricted.
3.
Institutions of post S.L.C. standard offering diplomas and degrees in various vocational
subjects will be established.
4.
An effective policy of science education aimed at facilitating its spread in the colleges will
be formulated.
1.
Improvement of Colleges
The colleges of Kathmandu Valley seems to attract a large number of students from outside the Valley
because of a lack of facilities for various subjects in the colleges outside the Valley. In order to provide better
facilities for higher education on a regular basis, five colleges lying outside Kathmandu Valley will be improved
to include most faculties and subjects, with laboratory, library and hostel facilities.
The financial aid provided to the colleges will be regulated by enforcing a set criteria on the subjects
studied in the college, the number of students, and the general standards.
2.
Tribhuvan University
Tribhuvan University, being an autonomous institution, will implement the higher education
development programme in the Fourth Plan in accordance with the policy set by His Majesty's Government. His
Majesty's Government will provide finances for specific improvements.
Teachers Training
The quality of education and teaching depends largely on the efficiency of teachers. As a primary step
towards improvements in education, it is necessary to increase the number of trained teachers in the primary and
secondary schools. During the Plan period, necessary arrangements will be made to provide training to 6500
primary school teachers.
1.
College of Education
The College of Education established in the yrear 1956, provides I. Ed. And B. Ed. training for
secondary school teachers. It also has an extension for I. Ed. Classes in Birgunj. The College of Education will
provide training to 320 secondary school teachers during the Plan period.
2.
Laboratory School
A laboratory School is being operated as a demonstration institution for all the secondary schools of
the country. This institution will be further developed.
3.
The center gives training in subjects like agriculture, education, home science and industrial trades.
The Centre established in 1966 has produced 206 vocational teachers, 375 diploma holdes, and110 persons
miscellaneous subjects by the end of the Third Plan. During the Fourth Plan a regular two years diploma couse
training programme has been arranged to train 500 candidates and to prepare them as semi-skilled technicians. In
addition, in-service training will be provided to 500 trainees in various vocational subjects.
Physical Education
Various sports events are being organized in various schools and colleges, with the objective of
improving the standard of sports and developing the health of the students and youths. This programme will be
implemented more efficiently during the Plan period.
To fulfil the gap of trained instructors in Physical Education in various schools, emphasis will be
given to teacher training. A stadium will be constructed. Since no survey has yet been conducted on the activities
of physical education in various schools of the kingdom, such survey will also be undertaken.
Examination Improvement Programme
Improvement in the present examination system will be done by formulating long-term and short-term
programmes. Steps towards improving the question papers, research on the better methods of conducting
examinations, and modern and scientific ways of evaluation will be attempted in this programme. In addition,
research will be carried out on various reactions to the examination system.
Science Development
The standard of science education in the primary and secondary schools is very low. Moreover,
teaching of science as not been in accordance with the required objectives. The Fourth Plan aims to improve the
curriculum, the training of science teachers, the production of scientific and educational equipment and their
distribution, in order to make science education in the schools more useful and practical. The improvement of the
Science Education Centre located in Harihar Bhawan will be improved in order to execute this programme more
effectively.
The glass, metal, wood and electrical workshops, established to facilitate the repair and maintenance
of scientific apparatus as well as the production of some simple apparatus in future, will be better equipped..
A laboratory in the Science Education Centre for teacher training will be established. Training will be
provided to 500 secondary and 800 primary school science tteachers.
The science education development programme (STEP Programme) will be introduced to 50 middle
th
schools during the Fourth Plan. The text books for the 10 grade and other booklets will be prepared for
distribution.
Janak Education Material Centre
A press room will be constructed and the office building will be extended
Sanskrit Institute
Necessary arrangements will be made for the establishment of the Central Sanskrit Institute to
organize research in Sanskrit by coordinating the work of present institutions.
Planning, Statistics, Research Programme
Since educational statistics are of great value Fourth Plan planning, the collection and publication of
various kinds of educational statistics on an annual basis for use by general public will be continued in the Fourth
Plan.
TABLE 122
ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE IN EDUCATION
Projects
Expenditure in Rs.
1. Preliminary Education
41,00,000
2. Secondary Education
1,44,05,500
1,00,00,000
1,14,00,770
5. Adult Education
80,00,000
1,00,78,065
15,00,000
5,00,000
3,00,000
____________
Total:
11,97,52,335
CHAPTER XXIII
HEALTH SERVICES
The economic and social development of the country is possible only with the healthy physical and
mental condition of the people. So, the development of health services has a direct hearing on the economic
development of a country. The objective of health service development is to make available efficient manpower
for the development of the country. The long-term objective of His Majesty's Government is to make health
services available as widely as possible throughout the country by utilizing the available limited economic and
technical resources.
Health services programmes under the Fourth Plan can be roughly divided into three main categories.
These are preventive measures, curative services, and health education and training. .the Plan has given priority
to preventive measures since prevention of disease is simpler and less expensive than cures. In the field of
curative services, existing health offices will be improved and strengthed. The training programmes consisting
mainly of middle level technicians, will concentrate on meeting the increasing demand for health personnel.
At present, a number of health projects under the Health Services Department are running with
separate offices and personnel in every district. Since this arrangement seems too expensive in view of our
limited economic and technical resources, the various preventive health projects will be unified at the central and
lower operational levels.
Pattern of Health Service Programmes
a.
Zonal health offices have been established in Kosi, Janakpur, Narayani, Lumbini and Bheri zones to
prepare the health services programme according to the specific needs of each zone, to provide for the necessary
medicine, equipment and personnel for the various health programmes in each zone, and to bring about proper
coordination between the preventive and curative services in each zone. During the Fourth Plan, two new health
offices will be opened in Sagarmatha and Gandaki zones, and the existing offices will be strengthened by
providing building and other technical facilities.
According to the needs of each zone, 50 to 100 bed hospitals will be provided under the zonal offices,
and these zonal hospitals will be consolidated as referal centers to the 25 district level hospitals.
b.
The district health office aims to extend the health service programme as far as possible in each
concerned district. During this Plan period, district level public health offices will be established in the seven
zones referred to above.
c.
Health Post
The Health Post is the basic unit of health services at the local level. They will be established on the
basis of geographical situations, as well as population. The malaria eradication activities in many parts of the
Central zone have been completed, but due to the lack of proper health offices, these areas have not been able to
reach the maintenance phase. The case is similar in the eastern zone and, to some extent, in the western zone. The
Fourth Plan aims to establish health posts at the ratio of 1 to 25,000 people. Besides malaria maintenance
activities, these health posts will perform multipurpose activities such as primary medical care, health education,
control of our communicable diseases, collection of statistics, etc. This will economize on the resource utilization
by avoiding duplication of health institutions.
About 62,00,000 people of Nepal live in the malarious areas. On the basis f population, some 240
health-posts are necessary to take care of these areas. The number of health-posts in the country was 33 by the
end of the Third Plan period. Therefore, the Fourth Plan aims at establishing 200 additional health posts in order
to meet the requirement.
Five additional health posts will be established annually to provide basic health services in the hills.
Because of transport and communication problems in the mountain region, there will be one health post for every
8,000 to 10,000 person. Thus, the total of 225 health posts will be given training according to requirements in
some remote areas where health facilities do not exist, health centers with medical officers will be established
with the aim of brining about coordination between preventive and curative services in the area.
Preventive Health Services
a.
Malaria Eradication
By the end of the Third Plan, out of the total population of 6.2 million living in malarious areas in the
country, 45 percent has been covered by the consolidation phase and 46 percent has been reached by the attack
phase. It was originally planned to bring 50 percent of the malarious areas of the central and eastern zones into
the maintenance phase within the first year of the Fourth Plan. But, in the absence of a basic health infrastructure
to take over these activities, only 10 per cent of the areas is expected to enter the maintenance phase by the first
year of the Plan. Depending on the progress in establishing a health infrastructure by the end of the Fourth Plan,
75 percent of the malarious areas of the country will enter the maintenance phase with 25 per cent taken into the
consolidation phase. No area will remain in the attack phase.
b.
Leprosy Control
The leprosy control programme is in operation in Bagmati and Narayani zones. During the Fourth Plan,
the programme will be extended to Janakpur, Sagarmatha, Kosi, Mechi and Lumbini zones. Under this project,
programmes of school-health-activities to discover leprosy cases, population surveys, examinations of germs, the
establishment of new treatment centers, and the training of auxiliary health workers will be conducted. Other
programmes include reform of Khokana Leprosarium and the rehabilitation of able leprosy patients.
c.
Tuberculosis Control
During the Fourth Plan, a tuberculosis control programme will be continued in Kabre, Sindhupalchok,
Nuwakot and Rasuwa districts of the Bagmati zone and Bara and Parsa of the Narayani zones. Training on
tuberculosis patients will be continued intensively.
d.
Small-Pox Control
During the Third Plan nearly 5.4 million persons received vaccination against small-pos. in this Plan
period, the programme is to vaccinate 80 percent of population and to revaccinate them as necessary in various
parts of the country.
e.
The main objective of the family planning programme is to raise the living standard of the general
public by bringing about a proper balance between production and population growth. The family planning
programme was included in the National Plan for the first time in 1965. And since the fourth year of the Third
Plan, this programme has been intensively operated as the Family Planning and Maternity and Child Health
Project. During the Third Plan period. 60 F.P. & M.C.H. Centres were opened in 25 districts. In the Fourth Plan
period, 260 clinics will be established in different parts of the country. The number of district offices will be
raised from 25 to 40. The programme intends to provide family planning services to 15 per cent of married
couples. The facilities of B.C.G., small-pox, Polio, D.P.T. vaccinations and other treatment will be provided to
4,00,000 children under 5 years of age. Maternity services will be made available to 10 villages. Other
programmes include the training of health personnel of different levels, the construction of necessary buildings,
and wider publicity on the values of family planning.
Curative Services
Attempts will be made to bring about greater coordination between the preventive and curative services,
although the preventive health service is given in the Plan.
Progress in the field of health services in Nepal during the last few years has been considerable. At
present there are 54 hospitals with about 1875 hospital beds, and the number of doctors has reached 300. Since a
large number of these are centered at Kathmandu and a few other urban areas, the facilities for curative services
in other parts of the country are negligible. So keeping in view the growing demand of the people curative health
services, the Fourth Plan aims to increase the number of beds and other facilities in the existing hospitals and to
provide some facilities for specialized treatment at the zonal hospitals.
The existing hospitals will be developed into three categories: 50 to 100-bed zonal hospitals, 25 and 15bed hospitals. As far as possible, uniformity will be maintained in the provision of similar technical and other
facilities in all hospitals of the same category.
a.
50 to 100-bed hospitals
At present there are 50-bed hospitals in Butwal, Jaleswar, Pokhara, Biratnagar, Birgunj and Nepalgunj.
But they do not posses all the facilities necessary for 50-bed hospitals. So in the Fourth Plan, all the 50-bed
hospitals will be developed into referal hospitals, and the necessary technical personnel, apparatus and other
facilities will be provided. Due to the increasing number of patients and the growing demand for hospital beds,
the Biratnagar hospital will be converted into 100-bed hospital by providing 50 additional beds, similarly the
Rajbiraj hospital will be converted into a 50-bed hospital by adding 25 maternity beds.
b.
25-bed hospital
At present, there are four 25-bed hospitals in Lalitpur, Bhaktapur, Gaur, and Hetauda. In the Fourth Plan
period, Bhadrapur and Janakpur hospitals will be converted into 25-bed hospitals. The 25-bed hospitals of
Lalitpur, Bhaktapur, Bharatpur, Hetauda and Gaur will be provided with better facilities.
c.
15-bed hospital
At present there are eighteen 15-bed hospitals in Ilam, Kalaiya, Dang, Dhankuta, Rangeli, Sirha,
Bhojpur, Doti, Taulihawa, Baglung, Sarlahi, Jumla, Dadeldhura, Parsai, Kailali, Bhairahawa, Dharan, and
Bandipur but many of them are not functioning satisfactorily due to the absence of necessary personnel,
equipment, and other facilities. In the Fourth Plan period, these hospitals will be provided with the necessary
facilities. The hospitals of Shivraj, Bardia, Inarwa, currently with less than 15-beds, will be converted into 15-bed
hospitals.
d.
Bir Hospital
During the Third Plan, a new surgical block was created with an addition of 70 beds. Some more beds
will be added during the Fourth Plan in order to provide an intensive training center for the Nurses Training
School and to meet the growing demand for hospital beds. Other programmes for the development of Bir
Hospital include the development of its various units, the creation of a coronary unit, the provision of some
equipment, and construction.
e.
Health Centres
In the Plan period, there is no programme for establishing new health centres. The existing health
centres and dispensaries will be converted into 15-bed hospitals or health posts.
Training
Special attention will be given to a training programme to execute the proposed programmes of the
health services in a more organized and planned way. Within the Plan period, it is not possible to provide the
services of doctors in all parts of the country because of economic, technical, and administrative constraints. The
number of doctors available during the Plan period will, therefore, be sufficient to run the proposed programme
of health services. At present, the doctors are primarily in the curative services. Courses of public health
orientation and graduate and post graduate training in various public health subjects will, therefore, be arranged
in order to secure sufficient doctors in the field of preventive services. Some will be sent abroad for specialized
training, but only according to needs.
a.
Nurses Training
It is estimated that within the Fourth Plan period, the number of graduate nurses will reach 200. To
reach this, the present intake of 40 students in Nurses Training School will be increased and additional facilities
such as a staff building, educational materials, and apparatus will be provided to the School. Along with the
graduate nurses training, provisions for postgraduate training will be arranged. Special attention will be given to
public health nurses training for the running of regional health programmes and other preventive health services.
b.
According to the target to open 225 additional health posts within the Plan period, 450 auxiliary health
workers will be needed. Moreover, since auxiliary health workers have to be provided in each of the zonal offices
and hospitals, 150 more auxiliary health workers will be required. So within this Plan period training will be
given to about 600 auxiliary health workers. To achieve this new hostels and other buildings and an increased
staff will be provided to the Auxiliary Health Workers School. The capacity of the school will be increased in
order to organize refresher training courses for malaria inspectors and supervisors working under the Malaria
Eradication Programme and for the existing dressers, compounders, and health assistants. Practical public health
training will be provided in two village panchayats.
c.
The Assistant Nurse Midwife Training Schools at present are running in Bharatpur, Biratnagar and
Nepalgunj. They have a capacity of training 15 people semi-annually. As some 80-85 A.N.Ms can be produced
annually from these schools, a total of 400 A.N.Ms will be made available during the Plan period. But during the
Plan period, 900 additional Assistant Nurses Mid-wives will be needed, 500 A.N.Ms will be required for the 225
health posts, 250 will be needed for hospitals and zonal health offices, and 150 will be needed for existing health
institutions. This additional requirment will be met by the candidates sent abroad on training under the Family
Planning Programme.
Since the Nepalgunj training center does not possess its own building, a new building will be
constructed.
d.
To meet the shortage of laboratory technicians in the country, training was started in 1968 at the local
Central Health Laboratory, and in the current Plan period, training will be given to 60 laboratory assistants.
Training will also be given to 500 health assistants and 60 other persons for a period of 3 and 6 months
respectively.
e.
There are, at present, 14 X-ray machines in the country, but many of them are not in operation becuae of the
shortage of technicians. During the Plan period, emphasis, will therefore, be given to the training of X-ray
technicians.
Miscellaneous
a.
Epidemiology Section
An Epidemiology section will be created to examine prevalent diseases of the country. This section will
be created under the public health section of the Directorate of Health Service in order to make public health
administration effective.
b.
Health Education
A planned health education programme is important for the successful implementation of health service
activities. The health education programme of the Fourth Plan includes school health education, training, and the
production of educational materials. The zonal health education section will also be developed.
c.
During the Plan period, the Central Health Laboratory will be developed. Investigations and research on
different kinds of diseases, germs and other public aand health problems will be studied. The chemical
examination of foodstuffs and blood will also be conducted.
d.
Ayurvedic Medicine
In our country where the facilities for medical services are not adeaquate, Ayurvedic treatment is very
important. According to the policy of encouraging Ayurvedic treatment, attention will be given to Ayurvedic
research. For this, the necessary arrangements for medical herbs and other materials will be made and a few
dispensaries will be established in some districts. To raise the standard of Ayurvedic teaching, steps will be taken
towards the conversion of Ayurvedi School into a College. Baidyakhana will be provided with modern equipment
for the production and sale of medicines.
e.
Homeopathic Hospital
A 25-bed hospital with facilities for maternity and child health will be established
f.
g.
Mental Hospital
In this Plan period, the purchase of land and other necessary provisions will be made for the
establishment of a mental hospital
h.
Some of the hospital buildings will be repaired and some new constructions will be made. Hospitals will
be provided with additional facilities.
i.
Medical College
The purchase of land and provision of other necessary facilities will be made during the Plan period for the
establishment of a medical college in Nepal.
TABLE 123
FOURTH PLAN EXPENDITURE IN HEALTH
Project
Expenditure in Rs.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Zonal Offices
12,00,000
b.
District Offices
15,40,000
c.
Health Posts
Preventive Health
1,60,00,000
4,00,00,000
a.
Malaria Eradication
13,70,000
b.
Leprosy Control
10,42,000
c.
Tuberculosis Control
d.
e.
Family Planning
27,00,000
20,00,000
1,10,50,000
4,09,74,000*
a.
50 to 100-bed Hospitals
15,30,000
b.
25-bed Hospitals
30,00,000
c.
15-bed Hospitals
40,00,000
d.
Bir Hospital
40,00,000
Training
23,05,000
a.
b.
5,00,000
c.
10,00,000
Miscellaneous
12,25,000
4,50,000
a.
Health Education
2,00,000
b.
1,50,000
c.
Ayurvedic Medicine
d.
Homeopathic Hospital
e.
f.
Mental Hospital
g.
h.
Medical College
1,00,00,000
50,00,000
15,12,36,000*
Total
* In the Nepali edition, the expenditure figures for Family Planning and the total should be corrected as above.
CHAPTER XXIV
DRINKING WATER AND SANITATION
There is a need for the adequate provision of drinking water and the proper management of sewerage
system for the protection of health and sanitation in the community. In the absence of such services, there are
possibilities of cholera, typhoid, dysentry and other communicable diseases.
Since it is the objective of His Majesty's Government to expand these services as much as resources
permit, various drinking water projects have been started since the beginning of planning in our country. The
following table shows the progress in this field during the various Plan periods.
TABLE 124
PROGRESS DURING THE DIFFERENT PLAN PERIODS
Plan period
Achievement
(In gallons/ per day)
14,52,000
14,95,000
49,48,000
It is estimated that 10 million gallons of water per day will be available by the end of the Third Plan.
The number of drinking water projects implemented by the Government will reach 50, and about 6,00,000 people
will benefit from them. The above figures make it clear that only six per cent of the countrys total population
have been provided with piped drinking water with the average per capita consumption rate of about 16 gallons
per day. This can hardly be called satisfactory.
The Fourth Plan intends to expand the facilities of pure and adequate drinking water and sewerage
which are so vital from the creation of a healthy society. The drinking water and sewerage programmes
formulated for this Plan period have kept in mind the existing transportation facilities, and the level of
administrative and technical capabilities. Surveys of the water resources of the country will be conducted and
reports on feasible projects will be prepared. The programmes of drinking water and sewerage for the Fourth
Plan have been broadly divided in the following way:
1.
New Projects
(a)
Drinking water:
Drinking water projects have been undertaken or are in progress in 12 zonal and 33 district
headquarters out of a total of 14 and 75 respectively. During the Plan period, 37 drinking water
projects in district and zonal headquarters and selected village panchayats will be started. An
outline summary of the main drinking water projects to be implemented during the Plan period,
the quantity of water available, the number of people to benefit and the cost of estimate are
given in the following table:
TABLE 125
PROPOSED PROJECTS
Availability of Estimated
Project Name
water
(in Population
to
gallon per day) benefit
1.
Lalitpur Drinking water Project
27,00,000
1,08,000
2.
Bhaktapur Drinking water Project
20,00,000
80,000
3.
Surkhet Drinking water Project
1,05,000
7,000
4.
Dailekh Drinking Water Project
45,000
3,000
5.
Sallyan Drinking Water Project
1,05,000
7,000
6.
Other Project *
7.
Miscellaneous Projects
Total
Estimated Cost
50,00,000
35,00,000
8,50,000
5,00,000
11,00,000
65,00,000
10,00,000
1,84,50,000
(b)
Sewerage System:
In the Fourth Plan sewerage disposal has been given priority in those urban areas where
drinking water facilities already exist. A project report will be prepared after a survey regarding sewerage has
been conducted.
A Master Plan for Kathmandu Valley will be prepared in connection with the long-term
planning of drinking water and sewerage with the assistance of the United Nations Development Fund.
2.
Continuing Projects
Numerous projects that were started during the last Plan remains to be completed during the Fourth Plan
period. A summary of these continuing projects, the estimated production of water, and the number of people to
benefit from them is presented in the following Table:
TABLE 126
CONTINUING PROJECTS
Name of the Project
Estimated
production of water
(in gallon per day)
Estimated No. of
population to
benefit
Estimated cost
Estimated
expenditure in the
Fourth Plan
1.
Dang Tulsipur
1,24,500
5,500
7,92,580
7,00,000
2.
Nepalgunj
2,00,000
9,000
14,93,000
2,00,000
3.
Bhadrapur
2,00,000
8,000
13,03,600
4,00,000
4.
Dhangadhi
1,40,000
2,000
4,77,000
1,00,000
5.
Banepa
1,50,000
12,000
7,25,000
2,00,000
6.
Mahendra Nagar
1,80,000
12,000
13,20,000
10,00,000
7.
Sunakothi Thecho,
Chapagaon
1,56,700
15,000
11,25,200
4,00,000
50,000
3,000
2,87,000
1,00,000
8.
Palpa
4,50,000
18,000
20,20,000
16,00,000
9.
Butwal Kharyauli
4,000
700
1,20,296
50,000
8,00,000
40,000
9,71,000
4,00,000
24,55,200
1,25,900
1,06,61,876
51,50,000
After completion of these projects, the supply of drinking water will be increased by an additional
24,55,200 gallons per day and 1,25,900 additional people will be provided with piped drinking water facilities.
3.
With a view to providing drinking water in as many different places as possible, feasibility reports
containing project maps and estimated costs will be prepared after field surveys are done.
4.
Establishment of Laboratory
A laboratory will be established during the Plan period to conduct the examination of chemical
composition of the water, various technical studies necessary to maintain the standard of water, and provision of
easy means for the maintenance and repair of different projects.
5.
Miscellaneous
Necessary arrangement for the improvements and modernization (e.g. fixing of metres, filteration etc.)
and for the repair and maintenance of the existing drinking water projects will be made during the Plan period.
Appendix
OTHER DRINKING WATER PROJECTS
Zone
1. Bagmati
District
Kathmandu
Lalitpur
Bhaktapur
Kabhre
Kaski
Lamjung
Syangja
Prabat
Baglung
Gulmi
Argha-khanchi
Project Site
1.
Chobhar, 2. Syuchatar
1.
Lubhu
1.
Dhadkhikot
1.
Phalane, 2. Ratmate, 3. Deorali
1.
Puranchaur
1.
Gilung, 2. Yangjakot
1.
1. Karendanda 2. Darsing (Bharthan)
1.
Mallaj
1.
Phalebas
1.
Righa, 2. jughung, 3. Rupakot
1.
Balkot
5. Rapti
6. Seti
7. Narayani
8. Janakpur
Piuthan
Achham
Chitwan
Dolakha
Sindhuli
1.
1.
1.
1.
1.
Lung
Ririkot
Narayanghat
Namdu
Madi, 2. Netrakali Andanda
9. Sagarmatha
Udaipur
Bhojpur
1.
1.
Udaipur
Bhojpur
10. Kosi
Moran
Tehrathum
Sunsari
Panchthar
Illam
1.
1.
1.
1.
1.
Sakphara
Chuhan Danda
Choukibarigaon
Phidim
Illam Bazar
2. Gandhaki
3. Dhaulagiri
4. Lumbini
11. Mechi
TABLE 127
ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE IN DRINKING WATER AND
SANITATION
Project
Expenditure Estimated in Rs.
1. Continuing Projects
2. Proposed New Projects
a.
Bhaktapur Drinking Water Project *
b.
Lalitpur Drinking Water Project **
c.
Surkhet Drinking Water Project
d.
Dailekh Drinking Water Project
e.
Sallyan Drinking Water Project
f.
Other Projects (24 districts)
g.
Miscellaneous Projects
3. Survey of Drinking Water Projects
4. Sewerage and Drainage Survey
5. Laboratory
6. Master Plan of Drinking Water and Sewerage for
Kathmandu Valley
7. Improvements and Modernisation
Total:
40,65,200
1,84,50,000
2,00,000
1,00,000
3,00,000
91,45,000
50,00,000
3,72,60,200
CHAPTER XXV
PANCHAYAT
The Panchayat system is an important medium for the mobilization of the countrys local resources and
for the successful implementation of national development plans. For the real success of the partyless Panchayat
system, it is essential to create a sense of mutual cooperation and coordination between the various villages and
districts, as well as between the various Class Organizations. The objective of the Panchayat development
programme is to bring about eh proper mobilization of manpower and resources and to secure active participation
of the people in social welfare and national development. Considerable progress has been made in the generation
of local financial and other resources during the Third Plan. Project implementation by local panchayats on their
own initiative has greatly contributed to the success of social and economic development activities. During the
Plan period, greater emphasis will be given to those programmes initiated at the zonal, district and village level in
accordance with the principle of decentralization.
Development Grant
The central government will provide development grants in order to involve the various district and
village panchayats in development activities and assist in their local efforts. The districts will receive this grant
according to the number of village panchayats within each district and geographical region in which they are
situated. The development grant ratio range will not exceed 75 percent of the total investment of the project in
case of A grade districts (Himalayan region), 50 percent to the B grade districts (Hilly region), and 30 percent for
the Terai and Kathmandu Valley (Table 128). In the above classification, a district is taken as a unit of
administration except in the case of Mustang, Gorkha and Dhading districts. In Mustang district, the village
panchayats north of Jagat (including Tukche) will receive grants according to grade A. similarly, in Gorkha and
Dhading districts the village panchayats north of Jagat (including Jagat) will be taken as grade A and those south
of Jagat as grade B districts. In addition to this regional classification, agricultural development projects may
receive up to 75 percent of the total investment of the project in the form of Government grants. The priority for
the development grant will be determined on the basis of the local effort in terms of project formulation as well
as on project feasibility. In addition to the above categories, a system of competition in the utilization of
development grants will be introduced. During the first year of the Fourth Plan period priority will be given to
those districts what have submitted maximum number of village panchayat projects forms (Table 129). Form the
second year of the Plan, 14 districts will be selected annually, one from each zone on the basis of local efforts
and progress evaluation. These 14 districts will receive priority for development grants:
TABLE 128
Grade A
1
CLASSIFICATION OF DISTRICTS
Grade B
Grade C
2
3
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Darchula
Bajhang
Bajura
Humla
Jumla
Mugu
Tibrikot
Dolpa
North Mustang
(Village Panchayat north of
Tukuche)
10.
Manang
11.
Rasuwa
12.
Dolakha
13.
Solukhumbu
14.
Sankhuwa Sabha
15.
Taplejung
16.
North Gorkha
(Village Panchayat north
of Jagat)
17.
North Dhading
(Village Panchayat north
of Jagat
1.
Baitadi
2.
Surkhet
3.
Dadeldhura
4.
Doti
5.
Achham
6.
Dailekh
7.
Jajarkot
8.
Sindhuli
9.
Rukum
10.
Udaipur
11.
Salyan
12.
Rolpa
13.
Myagdi
14.
Baglung
15.
Piyuthan
16.
Gulmi
17.
Argha-Khanchi
18.
Palpa
19.
Parbat
20.
Kaski
21.
Lamjung
22.
Gorkha (South of Jagat)
23.
Dhading (South of Jagat)
24.
Tanhu
25.
Nuwakot
26.
Makwanpur
27.
Sindhupalchowk
28.
Kabire
29.
Ramechhap
30.
Okhaldhunga
31.
Khotang
32.
Bhojpur
33.
Dhankuta
34.
Terathum
35.
Panchthar
36.
Ilam
37.
Mustan
(South
to
Tukche)
38.
Syangja
1. Kanchanpur
1.
Kailali
2.
Dang Deokhuri
3.
Nawal-Parasi
4.
Chitwan
5.
Bardia
6.
Banke
7.
Kapilvastu
8.
Rupandehi
9.
Parsa
10.
Bara
11.
Rautahat
12.
Mahottari
13.
Sarlahi
14.
Dhanukha
15.
Sirha
16.
Saptari
17.
Sunsari
18.
Jhapa
19.
Kathmandu
20.
Lalitpur
21.
Bhaktapur
22.
Morang
TABLE 129
DISTRICTS TO RECEIVE PRIORITY DURING THE FIRST YEAR OF THE PLAN
S.N. Districts
Zones
Percentage
of grants
1.
Darchula
Mahakali
75%
2.
Bajura
Seti
75%
3.
Tibrikot
Karnali
75%
4.
Jajarkot
Bheri
50%
5.
Rukum
Rapti
50%
6.
Baglung
Dhaulagiri
50%
7.
Gorkha
Gandaki
50%
8.
Gulmi
Lumbini
50%
9.
Rasuwa
Bagmati
75%
10.
Parsa
Narayani
25%
11.
Sindhuli
Janakpur
50%
12.
Udaipur
Sagarmatha
50%
13.
Sankhuwasabha
Kosi
75%
14.
Ilam
Mechi
50%
197071
197172
197273
197374
197475
Total
Training Centres
1.
Rampur
436
427
396
509
367
2,135
2.
Chandragadhi
474
566
490
472
528
2,530
3.
Nepalgunj
573
550
497
264
560
2,444
(at college level) and also to the womens workers, womens organization workers and to the women volunteers,
825 persons aer expected to receive training under this programme.
Volunteer Service
For the smooth implementation of village and district level projects, volunteers with technical knowledge and
skill will be sent to the projects for a period of 2 years. To achieve this, the Plan aims to obtain 192 overseers and
technical volunteers.
Remote area development programme
The panchayat system is making efforts towards all-round development for the people, and it will naturally take
time to spread the development benefits to those wider area of the country which have remained underdeveloped
for a long period. There are many areas in the country that need direct and special attention, without which their
development would lag far behind. Therefore, the Remote Area Development Committee has been formed to
provide greater attention to these neglected areas.
It is necessary to establish training centres in the border areas in order to meet the local needs of underdeveloped
areas. In those areas, where multi-purpose high schools exist, training in subjects like animal husbandry, pasture
development, dairy production, weaving of woolen products, agriculture and horticulture development,
preservation, collection and sale of medicinal herbs, building construction health and education, will be given in
close coordination with the various departments. In areas where such training schools do not exist, training
facilities will be provided with the help of the training division of the Panchayat Ministry.
Taking into consideration existing local facilities and needs, this training programme will be launched on an
experimental basis in four places such as Jumla, Jomsom, Jiri and Salleri where hostel building need to be
constructed. The technician will be rotated to those Training Centres for two to four months, and practical
training will be provided either to the ward members of village panchayats or th their nominees.
TABLE 131
ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE IN PANCHAYAT
Project Expenditure in Rs.
1.
Development Grant
2.
3.
4.
2,00,00,000
15,00,000
a.
Rampur
40,46,500
b.
Chandragarhi
14,14,000
c.
Nepalgunj
30,57,500
d.
25,25,000
e.
5,14,000
5.
Volunteer Service
6.
50,00,000
27,000
30,00,000
__________
Total
Rs. 4,10,84,000
CHAPTER XXVI
HOUSING AND PHYSICAL PLANNING
Housing problem in urban areas has assumed an urgent dimension as a result of the rapid growth in
population. This problem has become particularly acute in Kathmandu and the neighbouring towns of Patan and
Bhaktapur. The family residential limit density here is much higher than in any other part of the country because
of natural increase as well as migration from outside. If timely attention is not paid to this problem, considerable
difficulties will arise in the management of human and land resources and public service facilities. Housing
programme was included in a small scale during the Third Plan. The revised Third Plan intended to construct 16
model residential buildings, but this target could not be attained because of technical and administrative
difficulties. It was also felt that the increase in the construction of buildings in the private sector might advesely
affect the physical structure of the city, so greater attention was paid to strengthening the administrative capacity
of the Department to work for the planned development of the urban areas. Accordingly, the Building
Department was reorganized as the Department o f Housing and Physical Planning and a report, entitled. The
Physical Development Plan for Kathmandu Valley, was prepared to guide policy formulation.
Housing and Physical Planning activities during the Fourth Plan period will deal with the necessary control and
direction of the citys expansion and the establishment of standard residential areas.
Physical Planning
Physical planning is very essential for the planned development of housing. Therefore, the following projects will
be implemented during the Plan period in order to maintain necessary standard with regard to the density of
settlement, modern amenities, and physical environment.
a.
Parking Space
Kathmandu being the center of administration and business and containing the storehouses of ancient and modern
Nepalese crafts, the number of vehicles is increasing rapidly. The occurrence of traffic congestion and
inconvenience in human mobility tend to increase if the transportation programme is not planned in accordance
with the increase in the number of vehicles. A parking lot will be constructed in Kathmandu city as a supplement
to transportation planning
b.
Town Planning
If timely attention is not paid to the increased urbanization accompanying the process of development, it will
create numerous problems in the near future. In order to avoid this situation and to bring about planned
development of urban areas, steps will be taken for planned development of towns like Pokhara, Biratnagar,
Dharan, Bhadrapur, Inarwa, and other towns.
c.
Lumbini Area
In the context of developing places of historical importance, a detailed survey will be conducted in Lumbini, the
birth place of Lord Buddha, and a project will accordingly be prepared. Facilities like drinking water will be
made available in the new development area.
Housing
The following Housing activities will be implemented during the Plan period.
a.
Kathmandu Valley
In view of the increase in population and density in the urban areas of Kathmandu, an intensive survey between
Balaju and Kalimati will be conducted, and land will be sold at reasonable rates to middle and low income
government employees. The necessary infrastructure of building construction in the area will also be provided.
b.
Other Towns
Housing plans for new settlements will be prepared in the areas delineated in the master plan for physical
planning in places like Pokhara, Biratnagar, and Birgunj, which have commercial and industrial importance.
TABLE 132
ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE IN HOUSING AND PHYSICAL PLANNING
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1,00,00,000
15,00,000
Rs. 1,28,00,000
CHAPTER XXVII
PUBLICITY AND BROADCASTING
Publicity and broadcasting plays an important role in national development. It is important to provide
information on plans and programmes in order to make the people conscious of national development and to
receive their cooperation in the development activities.
During the Third Plan period, the publication of 130 booklets, 19 folders and 25 scenic posters were undertaken.
Also, 2 feature films and 19 documentaries were prepared. These documentaries and films were shown in various
parts of the country through the mobile teams. Similarly, machinaries worth about 56,000 were made available
for the development of H.M.G. Press. One lino-type machine was provided to Gorkhapatra Corporation. By
means of the routing machine made available to H.M.G. Printing Press, 4,390 blocks and 1,655 photographs
were prepared. Similarly in the field of broadcasting, 374 community listening centres were set-up in different
panchayats. A 100 kilowatt shor-wave transmitter was installed facilitating transmission abroad as well. Some
officials were sent abroad for training on radio programming and other technical subjects.
Publicity
a.
During the Fourth Plan, new machinery and buildings will be provided in order to modernize and improve the
H.M.G. Press. Nice technicians will be sent to the U.K. for two years training so that there will be well trained
personnel to run the programmes of the new printing press. Construction of the building and installation of
necessary machines will be completed, and printing work will be started during the Plan period.
b.
Film Production
The interest of the people towards film production in Nepal has been growing over the past few years. His
Majesty's Government has also produced a number of feature films Film production is expensive, especially
when processed outside the country. So far, films produced by the Department of Publicity have been prepared in
Indian laboratories. If this work were done inside the country, there would be considerable savings in expenses
and time. Therefore, one of the programmes will be to produce and process films within the country. The main
objective of this project is to create the necessary facilities for the production of films inside the country by
constructing a studio and a laboratory a suitable building will be rented for the installation of the new film
laboratory.
Broadcasting
It is necessary to make broadcasting services more effective if local people are to be briefed about national
efforts. During this Plan period, the existing 10 kilowatt medium-wave transmitter will be converted into a
regional station, and another regional station will be established in the western hill.
TABLE 133
ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE IN PUBLICITY AND BROADCASTING
Project Expenditure in Rs.
Publicity
1. Films Production
22,00,000
2. H.M.G. Press
23,71,000
Total
45,71,000
Broadcasting
1.
32,00,000
28,00,000
2,50,000
c. Miscellaneous construction
1,50,000
Total
32,00,000
Grand Total 77,71,000
CHAPTER XXVIII
ADMINISTRATIVE REFORM
An efficient and effective public-service-oriented administrative mechinary is needed for the
implementation of policy decisions and directions for the economic and social development of the country. Some
essential projects dealing with administrative reform have been included in the Plan in order to bring certain
planned reforms. This has become necessary because of an unprecedented increase in administrative function
during recent years.
During the Third Plan, most of the central offices were surveyed with respect to their organization and
working procedure. With a view to regularizing posts of a permanent nature, 1200 out of 1500 posts which had
been on the development side were investigated. Several measures, such as the implementation of some
recommendation of the Administrative Reform Commission amendment concerning the Civil Services Act in the
context of Career Development, the preparation of a new type of confidential report, the implementation of job
classifications, the publication and distribution of the Civil Administrative Manual, the code of conduct, and the
new classification of typists have been undertaken. The survey of the Civil Records Offices has been completed.
Pre-Service training have been provided to 130 and 776 Gazetted Officers, respectively, in order to bring more
efficiency in administration. Similarly at the Non-Gazetted level, 463 persons received office assistants training,
55 shorthand, 1370 district training, and 1578 typing Officials were provided training in general administration.
Administrative Training
As a result of unprecedented increase in the functions of H.M.G., the following training programme will
be implemented during the Plan period in order to meet the demand for trained personnel and to bring about
efficient changes in administration.
The following projects regarding administrative reform will be implemented in hopes of increasing the
qualifications and work efficiency of the personnel.
a.
Gazetted Officers
Pre-service and in-service training will be provided to 500 and 200 persons, respectively, in order to provide
them with greater knowledge of the state of affairs and to enable them to bear greater responsibility. The shortage
of administrative courses in the pre-service and in-service technical training conducted by different departments
could be met from the above training. In case of gazetted special and first class civil servants, seminars will be
organized in different parts of the country for the exchange of ideas.
b.
Non-Gazetted Personnel
An efficient administration requires capable assistants and clearical staff. Therefore, training (including
shorthand and typing) will be given to 1200 junior employees of the Secretariat.
c.
District Training
The personnel in district and regional offices, will be provided training in administration and typing. Two mobile
teams sent from the center will provide this training in about twenty districts. This team will also prepare a survey
report regarding O & M (Organization and Management) of district-level officers.
Administration Reform
Steps will be taken after investigation of suggestions and recommendations given by specialist, seminars
and conferences regarding administration so as to bring improvement in administration.
The following projects regarding administrative reform will be implemented in hopes of increasing the
qualifications and work efficiency of the personnel.
d.
This survey will be very helpful in classifying jobs on the basis of efficiency and qualifications required. Besides
helping in the selection of the right man for the right post of for promotion, it will also increase the efficiency of
civil servants.
e.
After the completion of the job description survey, the required posts and working groups would be created. The
career development project would then be prepared for all groups of civil servants
Incentive to Civil Servants
1.
In order t develop a sense of security, job satisfaction and stability in the service and to create a healthy
tradition regarding the appointment, transfer and promotion of civil servants, existing civil service regulations
will be reviewed and new rules will be formulated.
2.
The provision of some essential facilities for civil servants and their dependents (like housing, health,
and education) will also be included in the Civil Service Act.
Retirement of Civil Servants
The Civil Service Act will be amended to improve retirement benefits and to recruit youths with new
ideas and new spirit after the inefficient and dissatisfied persons have been removed.
Organization and Working Procedure
Changes will made in the organization and working procedure of the civil service in order to increase
the efficiency of the personnel.
H.M.G. officers at the central and district level will be surveyed, and suggestions will be presented
concerning further simplification of work procedures and the delegation of authority. In the field of
administrative reform, necessary action will be undertaken after the study of the Administrative Survey reports.
Building construction
Construction and renewal work will be done in Hariar Bhawan to provide physical facilities for the
Administrative Training Centres.
TABLE 134
ESTIMATED EXPDENDITURE IN ADMINISTRATION REFORM
Project
Expenditure in Rs.
1. Job Classification Project
2. Administrative Survey of Offices of H.M.G.
3. Research and Administrative Project Special Class
4. Seminar of Gazetted Class I and II Officers
5. Training Project
6. Renewal, Construction Work in Harihar Bhawan
Total
2,00,000
90,000
1,00,000
75,000
18,32,000
3,00,000
Rs. 25,97,000
CHAPTER XXIX
STATISTICS
Statistical data constitute the main basis for drafting development projects. It could be said that any
attempt to prepare a plan without statistics is an exercise in impossibility. One of the main reasons, the
preceeding plans were not as practicable or successful as they should have been, was the lack of relevant
statistics. Statistics development was given its due place in the preceeding Plan periods so that such deficiencies
could be overcome and proper information regarding the state of affairs of different sectors could be obtained.
Nepal does not have a very long history of collecting and analyzing statistical data. Although the tradition of
census taking was initiated in the year 1911, the collection of data regarding agriculturel industry and other social
and economic matters was started only in the past decade. Data are already available in the following areas:
agriculture and population census of the year 1961-62, estimation of gross domestic product since the year 196465, and statistics dealing with export and import since the year 1956-57. In order to make these more effective
and intensive, the organizational structure of Central Bureau of Statistics (CBS) has been made more functionally
oriented since the last year of the Third Plan and its status has been upgraded to that of general direcorate. It has
been customary to send personnel from the center to collect data dealing with the regions. However, it was found
to be expensive, and the information collected was not very dependable. Branch offices have, therefore, been
established in all 75 districts of the country, and the practice of collecting relevant local statistical data at the
branches and then sending it to the centres for analysis has been in effect since the end of the Third Plan period.
The construction of a new building has also been completed in order to cope with the problems of space resulting
from the extension of function and organization of the Bureau.
Fourth Plan
In order to make statistical information dependable as possible and to make it available promptly, several
projects involving standardization, coordination and mechanization will be done during the Fourth Plan period. If
statistical data of a similar nature are assembled from separate institution or government offices, it is difficult to
standardize them; and those using such data may find it very confusing. Also, duplication may arise because
statistical data collected by one institution may be collected by another. Arrangements to control such duplication
will be made during the Fourth Plan.
Even if the collection of statistical data is done by other departments, computation, coordination and
standardization of such data will be done by Central Bureau of Statistics. Major undertaking of census and
surveying will be done only by CBS.
Programme
a.
The decinnial census of Nepal will be taken iin the year 1971. It will be possible to collect more
information than was possible previously and to make it confirm to international standards. Because labour
statistics have been lacking, manpower has been difficult. Necessary questions regarding labour will be included
in the census questionnaire to be used in the year 1971.
b.
Since agricultural statistics are specially important in our country, it has become necessary to have an
agricultural census taken once every decade. The first agricultural census of Nepal was taken in the year 1961
and was confined to selected villages. In order to make the census 1971 (2028) more dependable, it will be done
in the wards comprising 15 percent of the Village Panchayat of the country.
c.
Surveys regarding the population should be done every two years in order to determine periodic increase
in population and other relevant factors. This will be done in the third and fifth year of the Plan.
d.
In addition to the programmes mentioned above, the following works will be done during the Fourth
Plan period.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Industrial Census
(e)
Survey of Fishery
(f)
Family Survey
(g)
5. In order to have such data analyzed and published as fast as possible, modern computing machines and
relevant equipment will be installed n the Building of the Bureau.
TABLE 135
ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE IN STATISTICS
Project
Expenditure (Rs. in million)
1. Population Census
2. Agriculture Census
APPENDIX 1
GROWTH RATE OF G.D.P.
The accordance with the aim to increase G.D.P. as much as possible and to extend the infrastructure
required for the future development, the Plan has been formulated on the basis of those resources felt to be
available. In this process, continuing projects from preceeding Plan periods and new physical targets for different
sectors have been given due attention. Although we are not in a position to project either the amount of growth
expected as a result of the programme to be implemented during the Plan or the total investment needed, the
average actual increase in G.D.P. has been estimated at 4 per cent annually on the basis of data available at the
time of drafting of the Fourth Plan on the following assumptions.
The estimation of the actual increase in G.D.P. generated by the proposed investment has been based on
an assumed capital-output ratio. As an estimate made on such a theoretical basis is bound to contain several
short-coming, its utility is in fact debatable. If it is assumed in the context of the present economic system of
Nepal, that the data available on output and capital formation demonstrate the relation between the two correctly,
then theory would succeed in giving some numerical indication of the annual growth rate in G.D.P. and
investment required for this purpose. It would also give some information regarding periodic national
development projects, and their influence on the economic system of the country.
An estimation of G.D.P. between the years 1964-65 and 1967-68 has been made by the Central Bureau
of Statistics. Estimates of the increase in G.D.P. should be made on the basis of the year 1969-70, the final year
of the Third Plan. It is, thus necessary to have information regarding G.D.P. in the years 1968-69 and 1969-70.
On the basis of analysis of data available at C.B.S., assuming that the annual increase of 2.2 per cent between
1965-66 and 1967-68 were to remain constant, the G.D.P. for the years 1968-69 and 1969-70 has been estimated
to be 3.2 per cent. Assuming price level of the year 1964-65 to be constant, it is estimated that G.D.P. in the year
1974-75 will be Rs. 7,873 million and the increase in the period between 1964-65 and 1968-69 was Rs. 5,37.0
million.
TABLE 1
G.D.P. BASED ON THE PRICE LEVEL OF 1964-65
Fiscal Year
G.D.P.
(Rs. In million)
Increase
1964-65
5,883
1965-66
5,856
-27
1966-67
5,896
40
1967-68
6,282
386
1968-69
6,420
138
1969-70
6,561
141
Total
construction
(Price
Implements
level
Of)
Fiscal Year
Total
(1964-65)
1964-65
44
45.7
101.9
4.1
195.7
195.7
1965-66
33.7
83.9
129.5
9.6
256.7
244.4
1966-67
18.3
89.2
142.6
7.2
257.3
234.0
1967-68
16.5
112.1
145.7
12.7
297.0
255.8
112.5
340.9
519.7
33.6
19006.7
929.9
Total
2,190 million
Panchayat*
100 million
Residential Building
600 million
650 million
____________
Total:
3,530 million
A detailed description regarding these sources has been presented elsewhere, but it is estimated that Rs.
600 million needed for residential building construction will be available automatically. No consideration has
been given whether this amount will be available from financial institution or from the public sector.
From the above exercise, it is important to think about certain basic factors. Although necessary policy for
investing Rs. 3,530 million during the Fourth Plan period have been formulated, the expansion of the financial
system is expected to be quite substantial. In view of increase in credit, deficit financing through loan by the
Rastra Bank, and local expenditures to be spent from foreign aid, the purchasing power of currency will increase
at a rate greater than total investment. But this is not likely to cause an adverse effect upon the balance of
payment situation of the country. It is not improper to adopt such an expansionist policy in order to increase
development activities because there are substantial reserves of convertible foreign-exchange and Indian
currency.
APPENDIX II
CLASSIFICATION OF DEVELOPMENT EXPENDITURE
The National Planning Commission has prepared the following guideline for classification of development
expenditure. This new classification for regular and development expenditure will be followed by Ministry of
Finance and will be made applicable from the coming fiscal year 1970-71.
1.
All new investments projects except the following will be treated as developmental:
(a)
Defence
(b)
(c)
Foreign service
(d)
Investment for such projects as construction of monuments, statues, museums and parks meant
for the direct benefit of the public.
(e)
2.
Expenditure for major renewal work of continuing projects, except for the above mentioned purposes,
will be considered to be developmental.
3.
All expenditure dealing with research works, pilot studies and special surveys will be considered to be
developmental.
4.
Any programme or project whose expenditures are largely recurring, rather than in the form of
investment, will be considered to be developmental only if it has direct impact on output and
productivity.
5.
Investment in and capital loans to other government agencies and public commodity-operations will be
treated as developmental.
6.
Transfers to other agencies of HMG purposes will be considered developmental only if the end use of
the transfer coincides with the above five guidelines.
It is necessary to clarify here that neither all capital expenditure should be considered development
expenditure nor all annual expenditure regular expenditure. Whether such expenditures are to be
classified as regular or developmental expenditure depends on the type of programme or project and
their consistency with the six guidelines of the Planning Commission. From this point of view, the
following general rules have been proposed for classification of the budget.
2.
3.
All capital expenditures will be considered to be developmental expenditure, with the following
exceptions:
(a)
Constitutional organs, viz. His Majesty the King, Royal family, National Panchayat, Auditor
Generals Office, Supreme Court, Public Service Commission and Election Commission.
(b)
General Administration viz. Cabinet, Secretariat of HMG, District Administration, Police, Jails
and Miscellaneous Departments.
(c)
Revenue Administration, viz. Land Revenue, Customs, Excise, Tax,Revenue Tax Court.
(d)
(e)
Judicial Administration
(f)
Foreign Service
(g)
Defence
(h)
Facilities for sports and recreation and items of direct public consumption viz. Parks,
Playgrounds, Monuments, Temples, Museums, Zoo, Theater, Archeology etc
(i)
Central directorates established for the purpose of supervision and direction in the sectors of
economic and social services and
(j)
All recurring expenditures except the following will be considered regular expenditures.
(a)
Special kinds of health programmes having a targeted date of completion viz. Malaria
Education, Eradication of Smallpox, Tuberculosis, etc.
(b)
Family Planning
(c)
Land Reforms
(d)
Programmes dealing with special kind of survey, pilot study and research.
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
Special area development project like Jiri Multipurpose Project and Trishuli Watershed
Project.
(i)
Grants and loans made to financial institutions and development agencies like NIDC,
Agricultural Development Bank, Land Reform Saving Corporation, Agricultural Supply
Corporation and Nepal Rehabilitation Company.
In according with the above guidelines regular expenditures now included in the development budget and
development expenditures now included in the regular budget have been separated. In the present regular budget
there are comparatively few items which can be termed developmental. Nevertheless, it is suggested that such
expenditures be shifted to development side. In this manner, the following expenditures should be transferred
from regular to development.
Present Regular grant No. 27 Education
Capital grants to educational institutions, capital expenditures, scholarships, and student allowances
given in educational institutions operated by HMG.
Regular Budget allocation No. 28 Health
Capital grants to private heath institutions, capital expenditure in existing hospitals,
health centers, health posts and clinics, all expenditures for health training.
APPENDIX III
REGIONAL DEVELOPMENT PLANNING
Planning involves a judicious programming of priorities whereby the achievements of certain goals is
related to short and long term time factors. Since regions vary in resource endowment, development activities
lead to significant transformations in the spatial articulation of the economy. Any development strategy for
stimulating growth should, therefore, take full cognizance of the spatial dimension. Development is highly
competitive in its locational policies and calls for a conscious regional strategy that promotes redistribution of
resources, while maximizing economic growth and national welfare.
National development programmes as such offer little scope for analysis and action at the regional level
since the analysis relies largely on macro-economic variables and aggregate data. Also, the sectoral programme
may not be well integrated in their locational aspect. The long-term objective of planning, however, is not merely
an attainment of broad national targets, but also the development of resources in different regions in order to
share the benefits of development as widely as possible without slowing down the overall growth. Regional
development planning is a comprehensive approach towards the reconciliation of economic and social aims, as
well as a means of broadening the scope of the allocative processes of the national plan. Comprehensive regional
planning defines national policies with regard to regional economic disaggregation, as well as the integration of
local activities and actions for problem areas. Regional planning provides an important link between the microanalytical concerns at the local level and the macro-economic objectives at the national level by stressing the
coordinative relations between programmes in particular localities and new resources combination for improved
land use.
The consideration of the national objectives and regional challenges of national planning indicates a
close relationship between national and regional economic planning. Regional planning is a technique which
attempts to accelerate the attainment of the national development objectives and the collection of data for
improved planning in specific geographical areas. Regional planning techniques prevent the scattering of scarce
resources in an imbalanced manner by concentrating investment efforts in selected areas. By concentrating the
efforts in judiciously selected areas, regional planners are in a position to incorporate the exact location of
investment projects and to link the projects in a logical investment sequence. The main difference between
regional and national planning techniques, therefore, is in the degree of detailed planning. National and regional
growth and development are, therefore, complementary aspects of the same cumulative process. Regional
development policies should be considered as a tool for comprehensive development at the national level, in
which all parts of the country contribute in their own way to the attainment of national objectives such a regional
approach is particularly relevant to Nepal which exhibits a high degree of spatial diversity and a low economic
level, thereby necessitating a careful allocation of scarce resources.
1.
REGIONAL DISPARITY
The physical settings of Nepal, encompassing the plains, hills and mountains, yields three
broad geographic regions, each with its own distinctive environment. The Terai Region
(including inner Terai) refers to the low-lane lying tropical plains along the southern part of
the country. The Terai, once a harsh zone due to malaria, has since acquired greater economic
importance, because of its rich forest an and agricultural resources. Its comparative advantages
in transportation and consequent industrialization has further enhanced the regions growth
potential.
The hill or pahar Region, traversing the sup-tropical belt, has been the traditionally most highly populated zone
of the country. Subsistence agriculture is the basis of hill economy, accompanied by considerably pressure by
population on land resources. The Himalayan Region, including the temperate highlands and trans-Himalayan
Bhotea Valleys, has been a marginal area for human occupance because of its harsh environmental conditions.
Population is sparse and the main economic activities are barter trade, animals and some agriculture.
These geographic regions correspond to the altitudinally arranged ecological zones and
naturally imply inherent differences in natural endowment. The regional disparity is amply
demonstrated by the man/land ratio among the regions (Table I). The Himalayan and Hill
region converting two-thirds of the total area and supporting 60 per cent of the population
have less than a third of the total cultivated area, indicating a heavy pressure of population on
limited agricultural land.
Table 1
REGIONAL DISPARITY
Criteria
1.
Land Area (Percantage)
2.
Population, 1961 (Percantage)
3.
Population Density, 1961 (Per. Sq.
Mile)
4.
Population Increase 1952-54-1961
(percentage)
5.
Cultivated Area 1967-69 (Percentage)
6.
Food Grain (Metric Tons)
7.
Large-Scale Industry
8.
Transport
a.
All-weather roads (percentage of
mileage)
b. Number of Airports
9.
Social Services
a.
Education (High School-Coleges)
b.
Health (Centre-Hospital)
10. Number of Development Projects, 19561970 (Percentage)
*Nation-wide Projects
Mountains
and Hills
74.8
58.7
157
10.7
31.8
-2,29.869
45.4
2
150-7
70-18
14
Terai
&
Inner Terai
24.8
36.4
244
14.6
65.3
-565,852
62.5
34.4
12
124-11
24-28
28
Kathmandu
Valley
0.4
4.9
2,110
11.9
2.9
37.5
20.2
1
74-18
3-11
34
Nepal
100
100
173
14.0
12.98
3,35,983
100
100
15
348-36
97-54
22*
Another dimension to this problem is the weak link between the food-deficit Hills (where majority of the
population live) and the food-surplus Terai region. High transport cost discourage retail marketing and inter
regional trade so that the circulation of goods and services is dependent upon the large-scale mobility of
population. The traditional circulation pattern of trading with Tibet in summer, when the mountain passes
become snow free, and with India in winter, when malaria was less dangerous, has experienced fundamental
changes during the last decade due to the malaria eradication in the south and dislocation of trade in the north.
The malaria eradication programme in the Terai has had a particularly important ecological impact on the spatial
dimension of the country by strengthening the link with the south. The former two-way traffic between the north
and south has been superseded by the gradual expansion of the southern markets.
The increasing dominance of the Terai (or Indian markets) is not due to rich resources alone, but also to
the comparative advantage of the Terai in the field of development activities. In the present context, the Terai has
become an area where development efforts in the agricultural, forestry,and transport sectors have increased
rapidly. The development of transport in Terai has led to increased circulation and concomitant urbanization
associated with commerce and industry. Such an overt emphasis on the economic growth of the Terai may be
defined by saying that initial development activities should take place in the regions of greatest potential so that
the economic gains of such programme might be later utilized for use in other backward areas. But such
polarization of development effort would mean neglecting the greater part of the country. The density of
population in the Hills has reached almost a crucial level endangering the very ecological balance. The present
pattern of development offers no alternative to the further deterioration of the Hills economy to the eventual point
when it will become difficult to provide even basic services. It is indicative of the fact that in the initial stages of
development, regional inequality increases more sharply due to a number of disequilibrium effects. Again, in
countries where industrialization is in early stages, the initial establishment of major industries in certain areas
leads to a covergence of industries since these nuclei can be self-generating. This tendency is particularly striking
in the case of Kathmandu Valley which has received over one-third of all development projects since the
beginning of the planning process.
There are inherent problems in a policy of too much concentration in metropolitan Kathmandu, as well
as in emphasizing diverse development activities within the Terai Region. The Terai may be a lucrative
proposition as a newly-opened settlement area for the landless, but what of the future when this living space is
also used up? Another problem relates to land use allocation between agriculture, forestry and industry within a
limited space of the Terai. The implications of such a polarization of development can be far reaching in the
whole complex of the settlement pattern and population dynamics. If the migration of the population from the
Hills to the lower elevations continues at the present rate one inevitably foresees a rapid depopulation of the hills
and mountains, thereby contributing to even larger regional differentials. A review of development efforts now in
operation has been towards accentuating inherent natural differences through unplanned investment. The
excessive concentration of economic and social activities in a few centers implies the desire to maintain the rest
of the country as a stagnant residual and to create depressed areas on the one hand and physical urban maladies
on the other. Therefore, the need is shown for regional planning, whereby inherent disequilibrium will be
minimized by conscious spatial control of the national development programme.
II. Objectives of Regional Planning
Regional planning provides a comprehensive spatial framework within which locational decision in
particular sectors can be taken. It can thus assist in formulating national policies when they significantly affect the
regions. Regional development planning would greatly contribute to the achievement of the following main
objectives of national planning for Nepal:
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
1.
The preceeding section amply reveals the North-South dualism (Hills vs. Terai), as well as the urban-rural
dichotomy (Kathmandu vs. other districts) in terms of resources endowment and development efforts. The policy
of balanced development envisaged for the Fourth Plan does not mean pure equalization among regions. This is
neither possible due to differences in resources nor feasible in economic terms. The aim is rather towards a
greater equalization between regions compatible with socio-political needs and financial resources of the
country.
The present overt emphasis is in the development of Kathmandu Valley and the eastern Terai does not augur well
for the long-term development of the country, since the answer to the question of whether Nepals economy will
ever reach an acceptable level of development capable of continous growth will depend in large part on the sound
economic development of the hilly region which support a large part of the population. A regional approach does
not mean an equal distribution of resources in each and every region, but an initiation of comprehensive spatial
planning in representative of regions with good potential for economic growth and the sharing of benefits
accured. Such regional investment patterns could be spelled out in the form of explicit long-term plans through
regional development planning.
2.
The increasing dualism between the Mountains and Hills on the one hand and the Terai on the other is both an
economic and political reality, and it is imperative that this differential be minimized. With the exception of
Kathmandu Valley (which covers a more fraction of the hills area), development activities are most pronounced
in the peripheral Terai region. The grain surplus from this region is primarily exported to India, instead of
catering to the food-deficit hill areas. The cereal grains from the Terai should be delivered to the needy Hills, but
this is possible only if the Hills have something to offer in exchange. However, the Hills have very few surplus
products to offer because relatively few development efforts have taken place in the hill and mountain areas when
compared to those in the Terai. This is the reason why a gradual shift of investment from the Terai to the Hills
should be undertaken in order to exploit fully the potentialities of the Hills. A careful selection of development
areas in the Hills would open up diverse possibilities of developing numerous rich resources complimentary to
the Terai economy. Such a shift in development effort is also justified by the realization that a large part of the
investment made in the Terai are consumed by the Indian . economy because of the close economic relations
between the two coterminous areas. Moreover, the desirability of political integration of the North (Bhot and
Pahar) and the South (Madesh) of the country is best attained through economic circulation between these
different geographical regions.
3.
The opening of new roads supposedly implies the opening of new markets. The opening of new markets
implies increased economic activity, and hence a higher standard of living. The above statement indicates that
transport facilities are essential for further development. But it is erroneous to presume that transport facilities
alone will automatically induce economic progress. Experience has shown in Nepal that the construction of
roads should be preceeded by a through evaluation of the regional impact of the road, as well as simultaneous
planning of economic activities in the service area. The greater the time-lag between road construction and the
generation of supporting activities, the higher the economic cost of maintenance and repair.
Therefore, a crucial problem facing Nepal today is the poor position of the economy which does not
allow for the construction of major north-south roads, whereas the lack of such a circulation is weakening the
economic and political link among the regions. This realization is significant enough to arrive at the following
dual conclusion:
(i) Even though the extent of economic activities prevailing in the Hills does not economically justify the
construction of major north-south roads, the implementation of these roads cannot be postponed much longer.
(ii)
The implementation of north-south roads can greatly contribute to the further development of Nepal
only if the planning of these roads is complemented by the planning of regional economic activities in the Hills.
The timing and scheduling of the implementation of these latter activities must be related to the completion
period of the roads.
Hence, the vicious circle of no economic activity-no road-no economic activity can be broken by a
simultaneous action of road construction and the comprehensive planning of regional economic activities.
4. Elimination of Imbalances among Projects
The elimination of imbalances between various projects depends largely on the scheduling and
implementation of independent projects within a geographical location. Lack of locational considerations in
coordinating sectoral activities in Nepals past planning efforts is exemplified by the numerous instances of over
capacity and under utilization of project e.g. overburdened canals (Pokhara), under used hydro- power (Trishuli)
roads with minimal vehicular traffic (Kodari road), and intensive projects without a road link (Jiri). Imbalances
between projects resulting in waste of resources are also to be found in the institutional framework. In the
agricultural sector, for example, the branch offices of various agencies when not located together, create practical
problems for the farmer. Similarly, problem-oriented regional projects like the Rapti Project (resettlement), Jiri
Project (Agricultural extension), Trishuli Project (resources management ) have inevitably ended up with
accretion of numerous supporting activities. A comprehensive regional approach at the initial stages would have
better equipped these project to deal with totality of their service area. The feature of imbalanced capacities of
projects and programmes is primarily the result of the lack of coordination between projects at particular
localities and the paucity of regional statistical data necessary for proper project evaluation. Regional planning,
by providing horizontal spatial dimension to the vertical dimension of the sectoral programmes, would focus on
the complementarily among and between projects.
5. Analysis of Regional Economic Structure
There is a great lack of data regarding population dynamics, input-output relationships, trade patterns, savings
and capital formation, although these are essential to improve planning techniques both at the national and
regional levels. Moreover, information of national aggregates fails to provide an accurate picture of specific
regions. Each regional economy is endowed with a varying amount of physical and human resources and there is
an urgent need for evaluating these resources, as well as the market and service industry potentials for the
different regions of the country. The basic obstacles to the development and implementation of regional
programmes is the low level of regional information and statistics. Emphasis should, therefore, be placed on
diagnostic survey activities to locate and explore available resources as well as to ascertain potentials and
constraints for development. Regional planning would accelerate the process of assessing the resources and
growth potential of the regions by using regional surveys and research studies into land capability, agricultural
efficiency, accessibility, settlement pattern and industrial location. A detailed investigation is selected areas is
most relevant to Nepal where there are great variations in the land-form, land-use structure become of sharp
contrasts in regional physical complexes. Such surveys for specific areas in the process of regional development
planning would provide insight into the reality of regions and improve the process of development planning.
III. Allocation of Resources
Regional planning serves the purpose of translating the national planning objectives and package of
investment into their regional locational settings so that the different regions and sectors can develop accordingly
in order to maximize the effects of the national plans investment potential. The regional economic policy should
be much as to determine the nature of the contribution that each region would make to the totality of national
targets and to regulate the pattern of resources use according to the most pressing socio-economic priorities. In
order to achieve a more balanced growth of the nation set out in the plan objective, overt polarization of
development should be concentrated by rational regional distribution of investment to affect the growth of
different parts of the country.
Regional distribution of resources is an important aspect of over-all efficiency in allocation. It
determines the rate of growth for each particular region and hence also determines the growth of the entire nation.
The present domination of the sectoral approach should be balanced by regional approach in order to quantify the
geographical distribution of investment in consonance with the regional policy of off-setting existing disparity
among regions. The regional spatial approach would supplement considerations of the investment sectoral mix
with a corresponding locational matrix that would make more explicit the impact of specific project investment
on the regional economy and would provide a clearer framework to stimulate and analyze the desirable multipher
effects of sectoral investment. This implies a strong budgetary control for locating specific projects according to
rigorously worked-out regional norms with respect to various inputs and production. Thus, the selection of
projects should not be only from the nature of undertaking by sectors but also according to their spatial location
on the basis of socio-economic benefit evaluation. Such an approach calls for careful regional analysis in order to
establish those areas which need concentrated efforts to yield greater returns sooner as well as specific areas
which require assistance for productive undertakings. Once the pattern of public investment is properly
established, financial and fiscal inducement or restriction can provide incentives to private investment as well. It
is essential that given region for development has to be shown to contain the most vital of the complimentaries of
outlay. With this approach, regional planning defines government action more clearly by helping to determine the
spatial coordination of sectoral programmes.
IV. Regional Development Programme
The regional development strategy for Nepal envisages a series of north-south growth axes or development
corridors linking the diverse regions. The juxtaposition of a wide range of resources (the Terai, the Hills, and
Himalayas) within a common development corridor will permit economic viability and will generate greater
inter-regional circulation of goods, services and people. Comprehensive regional development programmes will
be initiated in the following four growth axes (Table 2) during the Fourth Plan:
1. Koshi Growth Axis:
Biratnagar to Hedangma
Nepalgunj to Jumla
The four growth axis outlined above offer the greatest prospects for the integration and coordination of
the different development programmes since they present both the east-west and north-south territorial
dimensions of the country. Each of the growth corridors either has a road or a road is presently being planned or
constructed. These roads will link a series of growth centers where development efforts will be concentrated in
order to achieve full economies of scale and to encourage agglomeration economies. Since these development
corridors transverse whole gamut of regional types, the growth centers at specific locations will act as marketing
and service centers for the regional population. The set of growth poles along an arterial link will induce further
growth in terms of agricultural transformation, location of industries, trade activities and social services.
The comprehensive development of selected growth centers will act as demonstration areas for formulating
development methods best suited to other areas displaying similar conditions. Thus Biratnagar, Birgunj,
Bhairahawa and Nepalgunj will exemplify development patterns for the Terai towns while Dhankuta, Palung,
Palpa, Syangja, and Dailekh will be models for hilly areas. In the Himalayan region Hedangma, Dhunche,
Jomsom and Jumla will clarify the development procedure for the remote areas. The objective of developing
growth centers is the creation of poly-functional settlements to cater to the diverse needs of the hinterland.
The most important aspect of the growth center approach is the positive nature of polarized development as it
takes place and the mechanisms whereby the growth center spreads growth to the surrounding area. That is
through the process of multiplier effects, the areas linked to the growth center will gain from the concentrated set
of economic activities. The spread effects may begin to assert themselves from these nuclei of development as the
economy fully integrates itself and commodity and factor markets become more efficient. In locating such growth
poles, emphasis should be given to those areas with maximum prospect for radial effects in the peripheral
regions. The four development corridors linking four sets of growth centers, transect Nepal approximately 80 to
100 miles apart with the assumption that their lateral impacts will meet at a certain point in time and thus cover
the entire country. Regional development is by definition a long-term problem. The process of lateral progression
will be further accelerated by inter-axial transverse connections such as the Kathmandu-Pokhara road which link
into two growth axes. Though the East-West Highway provides a common link to the four growth corridors in the
Terai, greater benefit will occur as the various corridors are similarly linked in the more populous hilly areas.
However, the main reasoning behind the development of growth axes through regional planning is to tie-in the
economy of the developing Terai with those of the hilly areas. In order to maintain and develop the economic
viability of the hills and transmit growth from one region to another, it is essential to determine and initiate those
activities in the northern regions for which there is demand in the southern regions. The best way to integrate the
national economy is to establish the nature and scope of the complimentarity of the northern and southern part of
the growth axis in terms of organic circulation in trade, labour and capital.
V. POLICY FOR PROBLEM AREAS
The development of growth axes offers a basic regional policy in order to articulate inner-regional
economic integration in the national planning strategy. However, a development policy committed to economic
growth, as well as social justice, cannot afford to wait for the development corridors to solve all the ills of the
present regional disparity. There is need for concurrent programme for the amelioration of problems of special
areas ranging from the depopulation of frontier or marginal regions to the over-congestion in the metropolitan
districts.
(a)
Remote Areas
The mountainous part of the country has limited areas for effective utilization due to high attitude and adverse
life. Most of these Himalayan districts have less than five percent of their total area under cultivation and
agriculture can thus support the sparse population for only part of the year. Again, the decline of petty trading
with Tibet, which was a major source of livelihood, has wrought immense economic hardships to these border
people. In addition to these problems, the population residing in these areas is divorced from the mainstream of
national life because of its remote location from the development centers of the country. The important preconditions for development of these depressed areas include increasing circulation with their southern regions
through transport development and the revival of trade with the Tibetan region. The concept of the four
development corridors including growth centers like Hedangma, Dhunche, Jomsom and Jumla in the Himalayan
Region would further contribute to a rational policy for developing similar areas. The immediate programmes for
the mountain areas should be in line with improving the transportation system and providing essential services.
Some aid could be given in order to permit only emigration and training of emigrants in the skills required by
expanding industries in the adjacent areas.
(b)
Metropolitan Areas
Urban areas provide another set of problems at a different level. Urbanization is an inevitable concomitant of
development since urban nuclei absorb an unusually large proportion of the savings and capital funds. That the
concentration of activities in the urban areas does not necessarily lead to desirable growth is well exemplified by
the excessive congestion and indiscriminate spawling of metropolitan Kathmandu. Physical planning for urban
areas should however be deveopled in the context of a larger regional frame-work encompassing the urban
complex within Kathmandu Valley. The physical development plan for urban Kathmandu should explore into the
possibility of involving more private investment. In the action programmes, priority should be given to the
problems of housing and sewerage, essential services like drinking water, efficient circulation and tourist and
recreational facilities in terms of immediate needs and future needs due to population growth.
(c)
Depressed Areas
Apart from the North-South (Hills vs. Terai) diversity, there are equally significant inter-regional differences
between the Eastern (Kosi), Central (Gandaki), and Western (Karnali) sectors. The Karnali sector which accounts
of the population. This sector is also deprived of the metropolitan advantages as of the Gandaki sector and those
of periodic markets, existing in the Kosisector. The low rainfall and extensive highlands contributed to Karnalis
sparse population. The terai, as well as the Hills of the far western part of the country, are therefore,
compariitively less developed than other similar areas. In order to develop the economy of the karnali sector, it
will be necessary to devise another growth axis for areas not amenable to the main Nepalgunj-Jumla axis. This
supplemental development corridor should be aligned along the proposed Dhangarhi-Dadeldhura Road as a
means of effecting economic activities to support this growth axis. This would be accompanied by a
comprehensive development of the Jogura Valley (Inner Terai) in Dadeldhura and appropriate activities in
Bajhang.
Table 2
Growth Axis
A. Biratnagar-Hedangma
Kosi or
Sector
Eastern
B. Bhairahawa-Jomosom
Gandaki or Central
Sector
C. Nepalgunj-Jumla
Karnali or Western
Sector
D. Birgunj-Kathmandu
Metropolitan
Centres
(Geographic
1. Biratnagar (Terai)
2. Dharan (Terai)
3. Dhankuta (Hill)
4. Hedangma(Mountain)
1. Bhairahawa (Terai)
2. Butwal (Terai)
3. Tansen(Hill)
4. Syangja(Hill)
5. Pokhara(Hill)
6. Tukuche(Mountainl)
1. Nepalgunj (Terai)
2. Surkhet (Inner-Terai)
3. Dailekh (Hill)
4. Jumla(Mountain)
1. Birgunj (Terai)
2. Hetauda (Inner-Terai)
3. Kathmandu Valley (Metropolitan)
4. Barbise (Hill)
5. Dhunche (Mountain)
Terai-6
Inner Terai-2
Hill-6
Metropolitan-1
Mountain- 4
Total No. of Centres-19